GENERAL ASSEMBLY OF NORTH CAROLINA
SESSION 2013
SESSION LAW 2013-360
SENATE BILL 402
AN ACT TO MAKE BASE BUDGET APPROPRIATIONS FOR CURRENT OPERATIONS OF STATE DEPARTMENTS, INSTITUTIONS, AND AGENCIES, AND FOR OTHER PURPOSES.
The General Assembly of North Carolina enacts:
PART I. INTRODUCTION AND TITLE OF ACT
SECTION 1.1. This act shall be known as the "Current Operations and Capital Improvements Appropriations Act of 2013."
SECTION 1.2. The appropriations made in this act are for maximum amounts necessary to provide the services and accomplish the purposes described in the budget. Savings shall be effected where the total amounts appropriated are not required to perform these services and accomplish these purposes and, except as allowed by the State Budget Act or this act, the savings shall revert to the appropriate fund at the end of each fiscal year.
PART II. CURRENT OPERATIONS AND EXPANSION GENERAL FUND
CURRENT OPERATIONS AND EXPANSION/GENERAL FUND
SECTION 2.1. Appropriations from the General Fund of the State for the maintenance of the State departments, institutions, and agencies, and for other purposes as enumerated, are made for the fiscal biennium ending June 30, 2015, according to the following schedule:
Current Operations – General Fund 2013‑2014 2014‑2015
EDUCATION
Community Colleges System Office 1,021,295,467 1,016,487,467
Department of Public Instruction 7,867,960,649 8,048,101,622
University of North Carolina – Board of Governors
Appalachian State University 127,908,903 127,908,903
East Carolina University Academic Affairs 220,012,450 220,615,626
Health Affairs 64,841,247 64,841,247
Elizabeth City State University 35,363,212 35,385,057
Fayetteville State University 49,336,186 49,336,186
North Carolina Agricultural and Technical State
University 96,882,428 96,882,428
North Carolina Central University 84,084,488 84,084,488
North Carolina State University
Academic Affairs 389,976,973 390,045,059
Agricultural Extension 39,859,682 39,859,682
Agricultural Research 54,911,053 54,911,053
University of North Carolina at Asheville 37,465,299 37,465,299
University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill
Academic Affairs 274,632,544 274,515,010
Health Affairs 187,260,403 190,741,444
Area Health Education Centers 42,418,348 42,418,348
University of North Carolina at Charlotte 192,697,970 192,683,456
University of North Carolina at Greensboro 153,838,192 153,783,960
University of North Carolina at Pembroke 54,175,566 54,175,566
University of North Carolina School of the Arts 31,547,460 29,146,203
University of North Carolina at Wilmington 96,484,692 96,484,692
Western Carolina University 83,140,199 83,161,081
Winston‑Salem State University 68,957,656 68,980,084
General Administration 34,752,475 34,752,475
University Institutional Programs (32,137,074) (52,671,909) Related Educational Programs 82,160,148 117,918,501
North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics 19,126,182 19,126,182
Aid to Private Colleges 93,351,588 93,351,588
Total University of North Carolina – Board of Governors 2,583,048,270 2,599,901,709
HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES
Department of Health and Human Services
Central Management and Support 73,786,129 76,301,328
Division of Aging and Adult Services 54,142,341 54,342,341
Division of Blind Services/Deaf/Hard of Hearing 8,178,618 8,178,618
Division of Child Development and Early Education 254,314,609 254,314,609
Health Service Regulation 16,396,057 16,411,479
Division of Medical Assistance 3,461,950,119 3,608,119,091
Division of Mental Health 699,535,602 704,985,988
NC Health Choice 67,949,160 57,747,933
Division of Public Health 144,154,087 141,941,587
Division of Social Services 174,608,432 176,558,432
Division of Vocation Rehabilitation 38,773,169 38,773,169
Total Health and Human Services 4,993,788,323 5,137,674,575
NATURAL AND ECONOMIC RESOURCES
Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services 115,085,702 115,409,902
Department of Commerce
Commerce 51,228,804 56,733,282
Commerce State‑Aid 21,723,226 15,624,767
Wildlife Resources Commission 12,476,588 14,476,588
Department of Environment and Natural Resources 154,037,311 157,767,236
Department of Labor 16,696,339 16,696,339
JUSTICE AND PUBLIC SAFETY
Department of Public Safety 1,716,893,395 1,690,014,006
Judicial Department 456,926,252 456,426,252
Judicial Department – Indigent Defense 115,129,423 111,357,264
Department of Justice 79,726,123 82,308,926
GENERAL GOVERNMENT
Department of Administration 67,567,025 67,047,033
Office of Administrative Hearings 5,241,643 5,027,130
Department of State Auditor 11,217,468 11,217,468
Office of State Controller 28,710,691 28,710,691
Department of Cultural Resources
Cultural Resources 63,670,145 63,008,100
Roanoke Island Commission 450,000 450,000
State Board of Elections 5,302,373 5,693,244
General Assembly 52,087,986 51,634,767
Office of the Governor
Office of the Governor 5,170,050 5,172,132
Office of State Budget and Management 7,451,706 7,534,217
OSBM – Reserve for Special Appropriations 4,912,000 1,520,000
Housing Finance Agency 8,411,632 8,411,632
Department of Insurance
Insurance 37,994,004 38,003,624
Insurance – Volunteer Safety Workers' Compensation Fund 0 0
Office of Lieutenant Governor 681,089 675,089
Department of Revenue 80,998,918 80,896,458
Department of Secretary of State 11,575,183 11,575,183
Department of State Treasurer
State Treasurer 8,137,890 7,026,305
State Treasurer – Retirement for Fire and Rescue Squad
Workers 23,179,042 23,179,042
RESERVES, ADJUSTMENTS, AND DEBT SERVICE
Salary Adjustment Reserve 7,500,000 7,500,000
State Health Plan Contribution 33,500,000 89,000,000
State Retirement System Contributions 36,000,000 36,000,000
Reserve for Future Benefit Needs 0 56,400,000
Judicial Retirement System Contributions 1,000,000 1,000,000
Severance Reserve 16,000,000 0
Statewide Compensation Study 1,000,000 0
Firemen's and Rescue Squad Workers' Pension Fund (820,000) (820,000)
Information Technology Fund 9,053,142 10,470,657
Information Technology Reserve Fund 28,000,000 31,582,485
NC Government Efficiency and Reform Project 2,000,000 2,000,000
One North Carolina Fund 9,000,000 9,000,000
Unemployment Insurance (UI) Reserve 23,800,000 13,600,000
Reserve for Escheat Fund Global TransPark Debt Repayment 27,000,000 0
Reserve for Voter ID 1,000,000 1,000,000
Reserve for Pending Legislation 4,000,000 4,500,000
Reserve for Eugenics Program 10,000,000 0
Contingency and Emergency Fund 5,000,000 5,000,000
Job Development Investment Grants (JDIG) 51,823,772 63,045,357
Debt Service
General Debt Service 707,580,634 723,721,279
Federal Reimbursement 1,616,380 1,616,380
TOTAL CURRENT OPERATIONS –
GENERAL FUND 20,602,828,645 20,990,378,208
GENERAL FUND AVAILABILITY STATEMENT
SECTION 2.2.(a) The General Fund availability used in developing the 2013‑2015 biennial budget is shown below.
FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
Unappropriated Balance Remaining from Previous Year $ 213,432,877 $ 250,510,043
Projected Overcollections FY 2012‑2013 458,483,783 0
Overcollections Due to Disputed MSA Payments 71,516,217 0
Projected Reversions FY 2012‑2013 225,000,000 0
Net Supplemental Medicaid Appropriations (S.L. 2013‑56,
as amended by Section 13 of S.L. 2013-184) (308,100,000) 0
Less Earmarkings of Year End Fund Balance 0
Savings Reserve (232,537,942) (37,122,346)
Repairs and Renovations (150,000,000) (12,751,137)
Beginning Unreserved Fund Balance 277,794,935 200,636,560
Revenues Based on Existing Tax Structure 19,628,100,000 20,549,000,000
Nontax Revenues
Investment Income 13,700,000 14,100,000
Judicial Fees 250,200,000 251,400,000
Disproportionate Share 110,000,000 109,000,000
Insurance 72,500,000 73,400,000
Other Nontax Revenues 173,000,000 175,000,000
Highway Trust Fund/Use Tax Reimbursement Transfer 0 0
Highway Fund Transfer 218,100,000 215,900,000
Subtotal Non‑tax Revenues 837,500,000 838,800,000
Total General Fund Availability $ 20,743,394,935 $ 21,588,436,560
Adjustments to Availability: 2013 Session
Reserve for Tax Simplification and Reduction Act (HB 998) (86,600,000) (437,800,000)
Repeal Certain Real Estate Conveyance Tax Earmarks 37,400,000 37,400,000
Repeal Certain Scrap Tire Disposal Tax Earmarks 3,475,291 3,475,291
Repeal Certain White Goods Management Tax Earmarks 1,217,796 1,217,796
Direct Portion of Solid Waste Disposal Tax to General Fund 2,300,000 2,300,000
Adjust Gross Premiums Tax for Volunteer Safety Workers
Worker's Compensation Fund (3,000,000) (3,000,000)
Reserve for Repeal of Education Expenses Credit (HB 269) 0 1,500,000
Extend Aviation Fuel Tax Refunds (3,186,000) 0
Tobacco Master Settlement Agreement (MSA) 137,500,000 137,500,000
MSA Disputed Payments Erroneously Paid to
Golden LEAF (S.L. 2011‑145) 24,639,357 0
Repeal North Carolina Public Campaign Fund 3,500,000 0
Transfer from NC Flex FICA Fund Balance 6,000,000 0
Transfer from E‑Commerce Reserve Fund Balance 5,111,585 6,000,000
Transfer from Misdemeanant Confinement Fund 1,000,000 1,000,000
Transfer from Separate Insurance Benefits Plan for
Reimbursement of Premiums Paid for State Law
Enforcement Officers 16,510,611 16,510,611
Increase Lobbyist Fees 400,000 400,000
Extend Local Government Hold Harmless (7,850,000) 0
Certificate of Need for Certain Replacement Equipment (150,513) (150,513)
Adjust Transfer from Insurance Regulatory Fund (560,589) (560,589)
Adjust Transfer from Treasurer's Office 175,215 175,215
Subtotal Adjustments to Availability: 2013 Session 137,882,753 (234,032,189)
Revised General Fund Availability 20,881,277,688 21,354,404,371
Less General Fund Appropriations (20,630,767,645) (20,998,801,208)
Unappropriated Balance Remaining $ 250,510,043 $ 355,603,163
SECTION 2.2.(b) In addition to funds transferred pursuant to G.S. 105‑164.44D, the sum of two hundred eighteen million one hundred thousand dollars ($218,100,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of two hundred fifteen million nine hundred thousand dollars ($215,900,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be transferred from the Highway Fund to the General Fund.
SECTION 2.2.(c) Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 143C‑4‑3, the State Controller shall transfer a total of one hundred fifty million dollars ($150,000,000) from the unreserved fund balance to the Repairs and Renovations Reserve on June 30, 2013, and a total of twelve million seven hundred fifty‑one thousand one hundred thirty‑seven dollars ($12,751,137) to the Repairs and Renovations Reserve on June 30, 2014. This subsection becomes effective June 30, 2013. Funds transferred under this section to the Repairs and Renovations Reserve are appropriated for the 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 fiscal years and shall be used in accordance with G.S. 143C‑4‑3.
SECTION 2.2.(d) Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑4‑2, the State Controller shall transfer a total of two hundred thirty‑two million five hundred thirty‑seven thousand nine hundred forty‑two dollars ($232,537,942) from the unreserved fund balance to the Savings Reserve Account on June 30, 2013, and the sum of thirty‑seven million one hundred twenty‑two thousand three hundred forty‑six dollars ($37,122,346) from the unreserved fund balance to the Savings Reserve Account on June 30, 2014. Neither of these transfers is an "appropriation made by law," as that phrase is used in Section 7(1) of Article V of the North Carolina Constitution. This subsection becomes effective June 30, 2013.
SECTION 2.2.(e) Notwithstanding any other provision of law to the contrary, effective July 1, 2013, the following amounts shall be transferred to the State Controller to be deposited in the appropriate budget code as determined by the State Controller. These funds shall be used to support the General Fund appropriations as specified in this act for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the 2014‑2015 fiscal year.
Budget Fund FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
Code Code Description Amount Amount
24100 2514 E‑Commerce Fund $ 5,111,585 $ 6,000,000
24500 2225 Misdemeanant Confinement Fund 1,000,000 1,000,000
24160 2000 NC FICA Account 6,000,000 0
68025 6101 NC Public Campaign Finance Fund 3,500,000 0
73429 7429 Separate Insurance Benefits Plan $ 16,510,611 $ 16,510,611
PART III. CURRENT OPERATIONS/HIGHWAY FUND
CURRENT OPERATIONS AND EXPANSION/HIGHWAY FUND
SECTION 3.1. Appropriations from the State Highway Fund for the maintenance and operation of the Department of Transportation and for other purposes as enumerated are made for the fiscal biennium ending June 30, 2015, according to the following schedule:
Current Operations – Highway Fund 2013‑2014 2014‑2015
Department of Transportation
Administration $ 91,066,219 $ 94,975,916
Division of Highways
Administration 35,139,990 35,139,990
Construction 61,669,922 46,859,878
Maintenance 1,120,543,988 1,022,097,721
Planning and Research 4,055,402 4,055,402
OSHA Program 365,337 365,337
Ferry Operations 40,935,538 39,785,538
State Aid to Municipalities 142,102,740 136,874,010
Intermodal Divisions
Public Transportation 85,244,235 85,244,235
Aviation 28,744,510 22,244,510
Rail 40,142,294 24,692,294
Bicycle and Pedestrian 751,066 751,066
Governor's Highway Safety 284,932 284,932
Division of Motor Vehicles 118,994,643 119,532,589
Other State Agencies, Reserves, Transfers 260,693,983 263,469,382
Capital Improvements 18,055,500 19,937,700
Total Highway Fund Appropriations $ 2,048,790,299 $ 1,916,310,500
HIGHWAY FUND/AVAILABILITY STATEMENT
SECTION 3.2. The Highway Fund availability used in developing the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennial budget is shown below:
Highway Fund Availability Statement 2013‑2014 2014‑2015
Unreserved Fund Balance $ 72,214,149 $ 0
Estimated Revenue 1,937,200,000 1,892,400,000
Adjustment to Revenue Availability:
Adjustment to Emission Inspection Fees 23,600,000 21,600,000
Adjustment to Technology Improvement Account Fees 634,000 634,000
Motor Fuel Tax
(Shallow Draft Navigation Channel Dredging Fund) (2,280,350) (2,193,500)
Motor Fuel Tax (37.5 cents per gallon cap) (1,837,500) 0
Electric Vehicle Registration Fee 60,000 120,000
North Carolina Railroad Company Dividend Payments 19,200,000 3,750,000
Total Highway Fund Availability $ 2,048,790,299 $ 1,916,310,500
Unappropriated Balance 0 0
PART IV. HIGHWAY TRUST FUND APPROPRIATIONS
HIGHWAY TRUST FUND APPROPRIATIONS
SECTION 4.1. Appropriations from the State Highway Trust Fund for the maintenance and operation of the Department of Transportation and for other purposes as enumerated are made for the fiscal biennium ending June 30, 2015, according to the following schedule:
Current Operations – Highway Trust Fund 2013‑2014 2014‑2015
Program Administration $ 45,590,880 $ 45,590,880
Aid to Municipalities 0 0
Intrastate 0 0
Secondary Roads 0 0
Urban Loops 0 0
Mobility Fund 0 0
Turnpike Authority 49,000,000 49,000,000
Transfer to General Fund 0 0
Transfer to Highway Fund 400,000 400,000
Debt Service 79,170,090 60,307,448
Strategic Prioritization Funding Plan
for Transportation Investments 930,926,530 950,101,672
Total Highway Trust Fund Appropriations $ 1,105,087,500 $ 1,105,400,000
HIGHWAY TRUST FUND AVAILABILITY STATEMENT
SECTION 4.2. The Highway Trust Fund availability used in developing the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennial budget is shown below:
Highway Trust Fund Availability 2013‑2014 2014‑2015
Unreserved Fund Balance $ 0 $ 0
Estimated Revenue 1,105,700,000 1,105,400,000
Adjustment to Revenue Availability
Motor Fuel Tax (37.5 cents per gallon cap) (612,500) 0
Total Highway Trust Fund Availability $ 1,105,087,500 $ 1,105,400,000
Unappropriated Balance $ 0 $ 0
PART V. OTHER APPROPRIATIONS
SECTION 5.1.(a) Expenditures of cash balances, federal funds, departmental receipts, grants, and gifts from the General Fund, Special Revenue Fund, Enterprise Fund, Internal Service Fund, and Trust and Agency Fund are appropriated and authorized for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium as follows:
(1) For all budget codes listed in "The State of North Carolina Recommended Continuation Budget and Fund Purpose Statements, 2013‑2015" and in the Budget Support Document, cash balances and receipts are appropriated up to the amounts specified, as adjusted by the General Assembly, for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the 2014‑2015 fiscal year. Funds may be expended only for the programs, purposes, objects, and line items or as otherwise authorized by the General Assembly. Expansion budget funds listed in those documents are appropriated only as otherwise provided in this act.
(2) Notwithstanding the provisions of subdivision (1) of this subsection:
a. Any receipts that are required to be used to pay debt service requirements for various outstanding bond issues and certificates of participation are appropriated up to the actual amounts received for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the 2014‑2015 fiscal year and shall be used only to pay debt service requirements.
b. Other funds, cash balances, and receipts of funds that meet the definition issued by the Governmental Accounting Standards Board of a trust or agency fund are appropriated for and in the amounts required to meet the legal requirements of the trust agreement for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the 2014‑2015 fiscal year.
SECTION 5.1.(b) Receipts collected in a fiscal year in excess of the amounts authorized by this section shall remain unexpended and unencumbered until appropriated by the General Assembly in a subsequent fiscal year, unless the expenditure of overrealized receipts in the fiscal year in which the receipts were collected is authorized by the State Budget Act. Overrealized receipts are appropriated up to the amounts necessary to implement this subsection.
SECTION 5.1.(c) Notwithstanding subsections (a) and (b) of this section, there is appropriated from the Reserve for Reimbursements to Local Governments and Shared Tax Revenues for each fiscal year an amount equal to the amount of the distributions required by law to be made from that reserve for that fiscal year.
SECTION 5.1.(d) The Office of State Budget and Management, the Office of the State Controller, the Department of Revenue, and the Fiscal Research Division shall jointly study the Reserve for Reimbursements to Local Governments and Shared Tax Revenues (Budget Code 24705) within the Department of Revenue and shall determine the best manner in which to budget the funds deposited into and expended from this fund. When conducting this study, the Office of State Budget and Management, the Office of the State Controller, the Department of Revenue, and the Fiscal Research Division shall jointly determine if any statutory or other changes are needed in order to ensure that these funds are properly accounted for and budgeted in a manner consistent with the North Carolina Constitution. No later than May 1, 2014, the Office of State Budget and Management, the Office of the State Controller, the Department of Revenue, and the Fiscal Research Division shall report the results of this study, including their findings, recommendations, and any legislative proposals, to the Chairs of the Senate Appropriations/Base Budget Committee and of the House Appropriations Committee.
SECTION 5.1.(e) Subdivisions (2) through (4) of subsection (d) of Section 5.1 of S.L. 2011‑145, as enacted by Section 5.1 of S.L. 2012‑142, are repealed. This subsection becomes effective on June 30, 2013.
OTHER RECEIPTS FROM PENDING GRANT AWARDS
SECTION 5.2.(a) Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, State agencies may, with approval of the Director of the Budget, spend funds received from grants awarded subsequent to the enactment of this act for grant awards that are for less than two million five hundred thousand dollars ($2,500,000), do not require State matching funds, and will not be used for a capital project. State agencies shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations within 30 days of receipt of such funds.
State agencies may spend all other funds from grants awarded after the enactment of this act only with approval of the Director of the Budget and after consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations.
SECTION 5.2.(b) The Office of State Budget and Management shall work with the recipient State agencies to budget grant awards according to the annual program needs and within the parameters of the respective granting entities. Depending on the nature of the award, additional State personnel may be employed on a time‑limited basis. Funds received from such grants are hereby appropriated and shall be incorporated into the authorized budget of the recipient State agency.
SECTION 5.2.(c) Notwithstanding the provisions of this section, no State agency may accept a grant not anticipated in this act if acceptance of the grant would obligate the State to make future expenditures relating to the program receiving the grant or would otherwise result in a financial obligation as a consequence of accepting the grant funds.
CIVIL PENALTY AND FORFEITURE FUND
SECTION 5.3.(a) Appropriations are made from the Civil Penalty and Forfeiture Fund for the fiscal biennium ending June 30, 2015, as follows:
FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
School Technology Fund $ 18,000,000 $ 18,000,000
State Public School Fund $163,392,921 $120,362,790
Total Appropriation $181,392,921 $138,362,790
SECTION 5.3.(b) Excess receipts realized in the Civil Penalty and Forfeiture Fund in the 2012‑2013 fiscal year are hereby appropriated to the State Public School Fund for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year.
SECTION 5.3.(c) Excess receipts realized in the Civil Penalty and Forfeiture Fund in the 2013‑2014 fiscal year shall be allocated to the School Technology Fund for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year.
INDIAN GAMING EDUCATION REVENUE FUND
SECTION 5.4.(a) There is appropriated from the Indian Gaming Education Revenue Fund to the Department of Public Instruction, School Technology Fund, the sum of three million dollars ($3,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of three million five hundred thousand dollars ($3,500,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year.
SECTION 5.4.(b) G.S. 143C‑9‑7 does not apply to the use of these funds for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium.
PART VI. GENERAL PROVISIONS
CONTINGENCY AND EMERGENCY FUND LIMITATION
SECTION 6.1. For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium and notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 143C‑4‑4(b), funds appropriated to the Contingency and Emergency Fund may be used only for expenditures required (i) by a court or Industrial Commission order or (ii) to respond to events as authorized under G.S. 166A‑19.40(a) of the North Carolina Emergency Management Act. These funds shall not be used for other statutorily authorized purposes or for any other contingencies and emergencies.
ESTABLISHING OR INCREASING FEES UNDER THIS ACT
SECTION 6.2.(a) Notwithstanding G.S. 12‑3.1, an agency is not required to consult with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to establishing or increasing a fee to the level authorized or anticipated in this act.
SECTION 6.2.(b) Notwithstanding G.S. 150B‑21.1A(a), an agency may adopt an emergency rule in accordance with G.S. 150B‑21.1A to establish or increase a fee as authorized by this act if the adoption of a rule would otherwise be required under Article 2A of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes.
GLOBAL TRANSPARK LOAN REPAYMENT
SECTION 6.3.(a) The Office of State Budget and Management shall transfer funds from the Reserve for Global TransPark Loan Repayment to the Escheat Fund as payment‑in‑full for the outstanding loan from the Escheat Fund to the Global TransPark Authority originally authorized under G.S. 63A‑4(a)(22) and G.S. 147‑69.2(b)(11).
SECTION 6.3.(b) G.S. 63A‑4(a)(22) is repealed.
SECTION 6.3.(c) G.S. 147‑69.2(b)(11) is repealed.
SECTION 6.4.(a) Sections 2(a) and 2(b) of S.L. 1999‑2 are repealed.
SECTION 6.4.(b) Section 6 of S.L. 1999‑2, as amended by Section 6.11(d) of Session Law 2011‑145 and Section 7(b) of Session Law 2011‑391, reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 6.(a) Except
as provided in subsection (b) of this section, it is the intent of the General
Assembly that the The funds under the Master Settlement Agreement,
which is incorporated into the Consent Decree, be allocated as follows:Decree,
shall be credited to the Settlement Reserve Fund.
(1) Fifty percent
(50%) to the nonprofit corporation as provided by the Consent Decree.
(2) Fifty percent
(50%) shall be allocated as follows:
a. Debt service
as authorized by the State Capital Facilities Act of 2004, Part 1 of S.L. 2004‑179
and S.L. 2004‑124. As soon as practicable after the beginning of each
fiscal year, the State Treasurer shall estimate and transfer to Budget Code
69430 the amount of debt service anticipated to be paid during the fiscal year
for special indebtedness authorized by the State Capital Facilities Act of
2004.
b. The sum of
eight million dollars ($8,000,000) is credited to Budget Code 69430 and shall
be transferred to the University Cancer Research Fund in accordance with G.S. 116‑29.1.
c. The balance
remaining to be credited to the State General Fund to be used for the following
purposes:
1. The benefit of
tobacco producers, tobacco allotment holders, and persons engaged in tobacco‑related
businesses. To carry out this purpose, funds may provide direct and indirect
financial assistance, to the extent allowed by law, to (i) indemnify tobacco
producers, allotment holders, and persons engaged in tobacco‑related
businesses from the adverse economic effects of the Master Settlement
Agreement, (ii) compensate tobacco producers and allotment holders for the
economic loss resulting from lost quota, and (iii) revitalize tobacco dependent
communities.
2. The benefit of
health to fund programs and initiatives that include research, education,
prevention, and treatment of health problems in North Carolina and to increase
the capacity of communities to respond to the public's health needs through
programs such as Health Choice and the State's Medicaid program.
(b) Any monies paid into
the North Carolina State Specific Account from the Disputed Payments Account on
account of the Non‑Participating Manufacturers that would have been
transferred to The Golden L.E.A.F. (Long‑Term Economic Advancement
Foundation), Inc., or to the trust funds established in accordance with
subdivision (a)(2) of this section Inc., shall be deposited in the
Settlement Reserve Fund and transferred to nontax Budget Code 19878Fund."
SECTION 6.4.(c) The Attorney General shall take all necessary actions to notify the court in the action entitled State of North Carolina v. Philip Morris Incorporated, et al., 98 CVS 14377, in the General Court of Justice, Superior Court Division, Wake County, North Carolina, and the administrators of the State Specific Account established under the Master Settlement Agreement of this action by the General Assembly regarding redirection of payments set forth in subsections (a) and (b) of this section.
SECTION 6.4.(d) G.S. 116‑29.1(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) The General
Assembly finds that it is imperative that the State provide a minimum of fifty
million dollars ($50,000,000) each calendar year to the University Cancer
Research Fund; therefore, effective Effective July 1 of each
calendar year:year,
(1) Of the funds
credited to Budget Code 69430 in the Department of State Treasurer, the sum of
eight million dollars ($8,000,000) is transferred from Budget Code 69430 to the
University Cancer Research Fund and appropriated for this purpose.
(2) The the
funds remitted to the University Cancer Research Fund by the Secretary of
Revenue from the tax on tobacco products other than cigarettes pursuant to
G.S. 105‑113.40A isare appropriated for this purpose.
(3) An amount
equal to the difference between (i) fifty million dollars ($50,000,000) and
(ii) the amounts appropriated pursuant to subdivisions (1) and (2) of this
subsection is appropriated from the General Fund for this purpose."
SECTION 6.4.(e) G.S. 143C‑9‑3 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑9‑3. Settlement Reserve Fund.
(a) The "Settlement
Reserve Fund" is established as a restricted reserve in the General
Fund. Except as otherwise provided in this section, funds shall be expended
from the Settlement Reserve Fund only by specific appropriation by the General
Assembly.Fund to receive proceeds from tobacco litigation settlement
agreements or final orders or judgments of a court in litigation between
tobacco companies and the states. Funds credited to the Settlement Reserve Fund
each fiscal year shall be included in General Fund availability as nontax
revenue for the next fiscal year.
(b), (c) Repealed by Session Laws 2011‑145, s. 6.11(i), effective July 1, 2011.
(d) Unless prohibited by federal law, federal funds provided to the State by block grant or otherwise as part of federal legislation implementing a settlement between United States tobacco companies and the states shall be credited to the Settlement Reserve Fund. Unless otherwise encumbered or distributed under a settlement agreement or final order or judgment of the court, funds paid to the State or a State agency pursuant to a tobacco litigation settlement agreement, or a final order or judgment of a court in litigation between tobacco companies and the states, shall be credited to the Settlement Reserve Fund."
GOVERNMENT EFFICIENCY AND REFORM
SECTION 6.5.(a) The Office of State Budget and Management shall contract for a Government Efficiency and Reform review and analysis of the executive branch of State government, which shall be known as NC GEAR. The purpose of the review and analysis is to evaluate the efficiency and effectiveness of State government and to identify specific strategies for making State government more efficient and effective. The review and analysis may examine entire departments, agencies, institutions, or similar programs in different departments. The review and analysis shall include an examination of the efficiency and effectiveness of major management policies, practices, and functions pertaining to the following areas:
(1) The statutory authority, funding sources, and functions of each department, agency, institution, or program.
(2) The organizational structure and staffing patterns in place to perform these functions and whether they are appropriate based on comparative data and other reasonable staffing criteria.
(3) The measurement of each reviewed program's outcomes, overall performance, and success in accomplishing its mandated or stated mission and subsequent goals, considering the resources provided to the program.
(4) State and local responsibilities for providing government services and funding for those services, and whether these responsibilities should be reallocated.
(5) Personnel systems operations and management.
(6) State purchasing operations and management.
(7) Information technology and telecommunications systems policy, organization, and management.
(8) The identification of opportunities to reduce fragmentation, duplication, and related or overlapping services or activities through restructuring of departmental organizations and streamlining programs.
SECTION 6.5.(b) All executive branch departments, agencies, boards, commissions, authorities, and institutions in the executive branch of State government, including receipt‑supported agencies, and all non‑State entities receiving State funds shall be subject to review and analysis. The chief administrative officer of each entity shall ensure full cooperation with the Office of State Budget and Management and provide timely responses to the Office of State Budget and Management's request for information under the provisions of G.S. 143C‑2‑1(b).
SECTION 6.5.(c) The Office of State Budget and Management will work collaboratively with the Office of State Auditor to develop the review, analysis, and findings needed to produce a final report and recommendations to the Governor and General Assembly.
SECTION 6.5.(d) The contracting provisions of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes and related State purchasing and budget regulations do not apply to NC GEAR; however, the Office of State Budget and Management shall report all external contracts for consultants or professional services within 30 days of their execution to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Fiscal Research Division, the President Pro Tempore of the Senate, and the Speaker of the House of Representatives.
SECTION 6.5.(e) The Office of State Budget and Management shall submit an interim report of the NC GEAR's analysis, findings, and recommendations to the Governor, the President Pro Tempore of the Senate, the Speaker of the House of Representatives, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Program Evaluation Division by February 15, 2014, and a final report by February 15, 2015.
SECTION 6.5.(f) Funds appropriated for NC GEAR shall be used to contract with consultants and other experts and to pay for travel, postage, printing, planning, and other related costs as needed to accomplish the objectives specified for the project. Funds appropriated for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium for NC GEAR shall not revert at the end of each fiscal year but shall remain available for expenditure for the project.
EXPENDITURES OF FUNDS IN RESERVES LIMITED
SECTION 6.6. All funds appropriated by this act into reserves may be expended only for the purposes for which the reserves were established.
SECTION 6.7. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, the Office of State Budget and Management may, after reporting to the Fiscal Research Division, adjust the authorized budget by making transfers among purposes or programs for the purpose of consolidating budget and fund codes or eliminating inactive budget and fund codes. The Office of State Budget and Management shall change the authorized budget to reflect these adjustments.
NORTH CAROLINA STATE LOTTERY COMMISSION CONTRACTS
SECTION 6.8. G.S. 18C‑151(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) Except as
otherwise specifically provided in this subsection for contracts for the
purchase of services, apparatus, supplies, materials, or equipment, Article 8
of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes, including the provisions relating to
minority participation goals, shall apply to contracts entered into by the
Commission. If this subsection and Article 8 of Chapter 143 are in conflict,
the provisions of this subsection shall control. In recognition of the
particularly sensitive nature of the Lottery and the competence, quality of
product, experience, and timeliness, fairness, and integrity in the operation
and administration of the Lottery and maximization of the objective of raising
revenues, a contract for the purchase of services, apparatus, supplies,
materials, or equipment requiring an estimated aggregate expenditure of ninety
thousand dollars ($90,000)three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000)
or more may be awarded by the Commission only after the following have
occurred:
…."
PROVISION OF ANONYMOUS TAX RETURN DATA TO STATE BUDGET DIRECTOR
SECTION 6.9. G.S. 105‑259(b) is amended by adding the following new subdivision to read:
"(b) Disclosure Prohibited. – An officer, an employee, or an agent of the State who has access to tax information in the course of service to or employment by the State may not disclose the information to any other person except as provided in this subsection. Standards used or to be used for the selection of returns for examination and data used or to be used for determining the standards may not be disclosed for any purpose. All other tax information may be disclosed only if the disclosure is made for one of the following purposes:
…
(44) To furnish the State Budget Director or the Director's designee a sample of tax returns or other tax information from which taxpayers' names and identification numbers have been removed that is suitable in character, composition, and size for statistical analyses by the Office of State Budget and Management."
EXEMPTIONS FROM MANAGEMENT FLEXIBILITY REDUCTIONS
SECTION 6.10. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, expansion funds appropriated for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium to State agencies as defined by G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(24) shall not be used to offset management flexibility adjustments in this act.
REVISE PUBLIC SCHOOL BUILDING CAPITAL FUND/ APPROPRIATE EDUCATION LOTTERY FUNDS
SECTION 6.11.(a) G.S. 115C‑546.1(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) There is created
the Public School Building Capital Fund. The Fund shall be used to assist county
governments in meeting their public school building capital needs and their
equipment needs under their local school technology plans.needs."
SECTION 6.11.(b) G.S. 115C‑546.2 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑546.2. Allocations from the Fund; uses; expenditures; reversion to General Fund; matching requirements.
...
(b) Counties shall use
monies in the Fund previously credited to the Fund by the Secretary
of Revenue pursuant to G.S. 115C‑546.1(b) for capital outlay
projects including the planning, construction, reconstruction, enlargement,
improvement, repair, or renovation of public school buildings and for the
purchase of land for public school buildings; for equipment to implement a
local school technology plan that is approved pursuant to G.S. 115C‑102.6C;
plan; or for both. Monies used to implement a local school
technology plan shall be transferred to the State School Technology Fund and
allocated by that Fund to the local school administrative unit for equipment.
As used in this section, "public school buildings" only includes facilities for individual schools that are used for instructional and related purposes and does not include centralized administration, maintenance, or other facilities.
In the event a county finds that it does not need all or part of the funds allocated to it for capital outlay projects including the planning, construction, reconstruction, enlargement, improvement, repair, or renovation of public school buildings, for the purchase of land for public school buildings, or for equipment to implement a local school technology plan, the unneeded funds allocated to that county may be used to retire any indebtedness incurred by the county for public school facilities.
In the event a county finds that its public school building needs and its school technology needs can be met in a more timely fashion through the allocation of financial resources previously allocated for purposes other than school building needs or school technology needs and not restricted for use in meeting public school building needs or school technology needs, the county commissioners may, with the concurrence of the affected local Board of Education, use those financial resources to meet school building needs and school technology needs and may allocate the funds it receives under this Article for purposes other than school building needs or school technology needs to the extent that financial resources were redirected from such purposes. The concurrence described herein shall be secured in advance of the allocation of the previously unrestricted financial resources and shall be on a form prescribed by the Local Government Commission.
(c) Monies previously
credited to the Fund by the Secretary of Revenue pursuant to G.S. 115C‑546.1(b)
for capital projects shall be matched on the basis of one dollar of local
funds for every three dollars of State funds. Monies Such monies in
the Fund transferred to the State Technology Fund do not require a local match.
Revenue received from local sales and use taxes that is restricted for public school capital outlay purposes pursuant to G.S. 105‑502 or G.S. 105‑487 may be used to meet the local matching requirement. Funds expended by a county after July 1, 1986, for land acquisition, engineering fees, architectural fees, or other directly related costs for a public school building capital project that was not completed prior to July 1, 1987, may be used to meet the local match requirement.
(d) If funds are
appropriated from the Education Lottery Fund to the Public School Building
Capital Fund, such funds shall be allocated for school capital construction
projects on a per average daily membership basis according to the average daily
membership for the budget year as determined and certified by the State Board
of Education.Monies transferred into the Fund in accordance with Chapter
18C of the General Statutes shall be allocated for capital projects for school
construction projects as follows:
(1) A sum equal to
sixty‑five percent (65%) of those monies transferred in accordance with G.S. 18C‑164
shall be allocated on a per average daily membership basis according to the
average daily membership for the budget year as determined and certified by the
State Board of Education.
(2) A sum equal to
thirty‑five percent (35%) of those monies transferred in accordance with G.S. 18C‑164
shall be allocated to those local school administrative units located in whole
or part in counties in which the effective county tax rate as a percentage of
the State average effective tax rate is greater than one hundred percent
(100%), with the following definitions applying to this subdivision:
a. "Effective
county tax rate" means the actual county rate for the previous fiscal
year, including any countywide supplemental taxes levied for the benefit of
public schools, multiplied by a three‑year weighted average of the most
recent annual sales assessment ratio studies.
b. "State
average effective tax rate" means the average effective county tax rates
for all counties.
c. "Sales
assessment ratio studies" means sales assessment ratio studies performed
by the Department of Revenue under G.S. 105‑289(h).
(3) No county shall have to provide matching funds required under subsection (c) of this section.
(4) A county may use monies in this Fund to pay for school construction projects in local school administrative units and to retire indebtedness incurred for school construction projects.
(5) A county may not use monies in this Fund to pay for school technology needs.
(e) The State Board of Education may use up to one million five hundred thousand dollars ($1,500,000) each year of monies in the Fund to support positions in the Department of Public Instruction's Support Services Division."
SECTION 6.11.(c) G.S. 18C‑164 reads as rewritten:
"§ 18C‑164. Transfer of net revenues.
(a) The funds remaining in the North Carolina State Lottery Fund after receipt of all revenues to the Lottery Fund and after accrual of all obligations of the Commission for prizes and expenses shall be considered to be the net revenues of the North Carolina State Lottery Fund. The net revenues of the North Carolina State Lottery Fund shall be transferred four times a year to the Education Lottery Fund, which shall be created in the State treasury.
(b) From the Education
Lottery Fund, the Commission Office of State Budget and Management shall
transfer a sum equal to five percent (5%) of the net revenue of the prior year
to the Education Lottery Reserve Fund. A special revenue fund for this purpose
shall be established in the State treasury to be known as the Education Lottery
Reserve Fund, and that fund shall be capped at fifty million dollars
($50,000,000). Monies in the Education Lottery Reserve Fund may be appropriated
only as provided in subsection (e) of this section.
(c) The Commission shall
distribute The General Assembly shall appropriate the remaining net
revenue of the Education Lottery Fund, as follows, in the following manner:Fund
annually in the Current Operations Appropriations Act for education‑related
purposes, based upon estimates of lottery net revenue to the Education Lottery
Fund provided by the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal
Research Division of the Legislative Services Commission.
(1) A sum equal to
fifty percent (50%) to support reduction of class size in early grades to class
size allotments not exceeding 1:18 in order to eliminate achievement gaps and
to support academic prekindergarten programs for at‑risk four‑year‑olds
who would otherwise not be served in a high‑quality education program in
order to help those four‑year‑olds be prepared developmentally to
succeed in school.
(2) A sum equal to
forty percent (40%) to the Public School Building Capital Fund in accordance
with G.S. 115C‑546.2.
(3) A sum equal to
ten percent (10%) to the State Educational Assistance Authority to fund college
and university scholarships in accordance with Article 35A of Chapter 115C of
the General Statutes.
(d) Of the sums
transferred under subsection (c) of this section, the General Assembly shall
appropriate the funds annually based upon estimates of lottery net revenue to
the Education Lottery Fund provided by the Office of State Budget and
Management and the Fiscal Research Division of the North Carolina General
Assembly.
(e) If the actual net
revenues are less than the appropriation for that given year, then the Governor
may transfer from the Education Lottery Reserve Fund an amount sufficient to
equal the appropriation by the General Assembly. If the monies available in
the Education Lottery Reserve Fund are insufficient to reach a full appropriation,
the Governor shall transfer monies in order of priority, to the following:
(1) To support
academic prekindergarten programs for at‑risk four‑year‑olds
who would otherwise not be served in a high‑quality education program in
order to help those four‑year‑olds be prepared developmentally to
succeed in school.
(2) To reduce
class size.
(3) To provide
financial aid for needy students to attend college.
(4) To the Public
School Building Capital Fund to be spent in accordance with this section.
(f) If the actual Actual
net revenues exceed in excess of the amounts appropriated in that
fiscal year, the excess net revenues a fiscal year shall remain in
the Education Lottery Fund, and then be transferred as follows: Fund.
(1) Fifty percent
(50%) to the Public School Building Capital Fund to be spent in accordance with
this section.
(2) Fifty percent
(50%) to the State Educational Assistance Authority to be spent in accordance
with this section."
SECTION 6.11.(d) G.S. 115C‑499.3(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Subject to the
maximum amounts provided in this section, the Authority shall have the power to
determine the actual scholarship amounts disbursed to students in any given
year based on the amount of net income available under Chapter 18C of the
General Statutes. funds appropriated from the Education Lottery Fund. If
the net income available is not sufficient to fully fund the scholarships to
the maximum amount, all scholarships shall be reduced equally, to the extent
practicable, so that every eligible applicant shall receive a proportionate
scholarship amount."
SECTION 6.11.(e) The appropriations made from the Education Lottery Fund for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium are as follows:
FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
Classroom Teachers $ 220,643,188 $ 220,643,188
Prekindergarten Program 75,535,709 75,535,709
Public School Building Capital Fund 100,000,000 100,000,000
Scholarships for Needy Students 30,450,000 30,450,000
UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid 10,744,733 10,744,733
UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid Forward Funding Reserve 32,530,359 19,130,728
Digital Learning 11,928,735 11,928,735
TOTAL APPROPRIATION $ 481,832,724 $ 468,433,093
SECTION 6.11.(f) Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164, the Office of State Budget and Management shall not transfer funds to the Education Lottery Reserve Fund for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year.
SECTION 6.11.(g) Funds appropriated for Digital Learning pursuant to subsection (e) of this section shall be used to support grants to local education agencies (LEAs) for (i) delivering educator professional development focused on using digital and other instructional technologies to provide high‑quality, integrated digital teaching and learning to all students and (ii) acquiring quality digital content to enhance instruction.
Up to one million dollars ($1,000,000) may be used by the Department of Public Instruction to (i) develop a plan to transition from funding for textbooks, both traditional and digital, to funding for digital materials, including textbooks and instructional resources and (ii) provide educational resources that remain current, are aligned with curriculum, and are effective for all learners by 2017. The plan shall also include an inventory of the infrastructure needed to support robust digital learning in public schools.
SECTION 6.11.(h) Subsection (c) of this section becomes effective June 30, 2013.
SECTION 6.12.(a) G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(19) reads as rewritten:
"(19) Nontax revenue. –
Revenue that is not a tax proceed or a departmental receipt and that is
required by statute to be credited to the General Fund.a fund."
SECTION 6.12.(b) G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(30) reads as rewritten:
"(30) Unreserved fund
balance. – The available General Fund cash balance effective June 30
after excluding documented encumbrances, unearned revenue, federal grants, statutory
requirements, and other legal obligations to General Fund a fund's cash
balance as determined by the State Controller. Beginning unreserved fund
balance equals ending unreserved fund balance from the prior fiscal year."
SECTION 6.12.(c) G.S. 143C‑1‑3(c) reads as rewritten:
"(c) Notwithstanding
subsections (a) and (b) of this section, funds established for The University
of North Carolina and its constituent institutions pursuant to the following
statutes are exempt from Chapter 143C of the General Statutes and shall be
accounted for as provided by those statutes, except that the provisions of
Article 8 of Chapter 143C of the General Statutes shall apply to the funds:
G.S. 116‑35, 116‑36, 116‑36.1, 116‑36.2, 116‑36.4,
116‑36.5, 116‑36.6, 116‑44.4, 116‑68, 116‑220, 116‑235,
116‑238.116‑235."
SECTION 6.12.(d) Article 1 of Chapter 143C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 143C‑1‑5. Chapter is applicable to The University of North Carolina.
Except as expressly provided in G.S. 143C‑1‑3(c) or otherwise expressly provided by law, The University of North Carolina shall be subject to the provisions of this Chapter in the same manner and to the same degree as other State agencies."
SECTION 6.12.(e) G.S. 143C‑3‑5(e) reads as rewritten:
"(e) Revenue Availability
Estimates. – The recommended Current Operations Appropriations Act shall
contain a statement showing the estimates of General Fund availability, Highway
Fund availability, and Highway Trust Fund availability upon which the
Recommended State Budget is based."
SECTION 6.12.(f) G.S. 143C‑9‑6 reads as rewritten:
"§
143C‑9‑6. JDIG Reserve Fund.Reserve.
(a) The State Controller
shall establish a reserve in the General Fund to be known as the JDIG Reserve.
Funds from the JDIG Reserve shall not be expended or transferred except
in accordance with G.S. 143B‑437.63.
(b) It is the intent of the General Assembly to appropriate funds annually to the JDIG Reserve established in this section in amounts sufficient to meet the anticipated cash requirements for each fiscal year of the Job Development Investment Grant Program established pursuant to G.S. 143B‑437.52."
SECTION 6.12.(g) G.S. 143C‑9‑8(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) The State
Controller shall establish a reserve in the General Fund to be known as the One
North Carolina Fund Reserve. Funds from the One North Carolina Fund Reserve
shall not be expended or transferred except in accordance with
G.S. 143B‑437.75."
SUBSTANTIVE CHANGES
SECTION 6.12.(h) G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d) is amended by adding the following new subdivisions to read:
"(1a) Authorized budget. – The certified budget with changes authorized by the Director of the Budget through authority granted in G.S. 143C‑6‑4 or other statutes.
(1b) Availability. – The total anticipated cash available within a fund for appropriation purposes, including unreserved fund balance and all revenue and receipts anticipated in a fiscal year.
...
(7a) Continuation budget. – That part of the Recommended State Budget necessary to continue the same level of services in the next biennium as is provided in the current fiscal year, including (i) mandated Social Security rate adjustments; (ii) annualization of programs and positions; (iii) enrollment adjustments for public schools and Medicaid; (iv) reductions to adjust for items funded with nonrecurring funds during the prior fiscal biennium; (v) increases to adjust for nonrecurring reductions during the prior fiscal biennium; and (vi) if deemed necessary by the Director, other adjustments such as inflation, building reserves, and equipment replacement."
SECTION 6.12.(i) G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(7) reads as rewritten:
"(7) Certified budget. –
The budget as enacted by the General Assembly including adjustments made for
(i) distributions to State agencies from statewide reserves appropriated by the
General Assembly, (ii) distributions of reserves appropriated to a specific
agency by the General Assembly, and (iii) organizational or budget changes directed
mandated by the General Assembly but left to the Director to
carry out.Assembly."
SECTION 6.12.(j) G.S. 143C‑3‑3 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑3‑3. Budget requests from State agencies in the executive branch.
…
(b) University of North
Carolina System Request. – Notwithstanding subsections (c), (d), and (e) of
this section, pursuant to the requirement in G.S. 116‑11
that the Board of Governors shall prepare a unified budget request
for all of the constituent institutions of The University of North Carolina, including
repairs and renovations, capital fund requests, and information technology.technology
requests shall comply with subsections (c), (d), and (e) of this section.
…
(e) Information Technology Request. – In addition to any other information requested by the Director, any State agency requesting significant State resources, as defined by the Director, for the purpose of acquiring or maintaining information technology shall accompany that request with all of the following:
(1) A statement of its needs for information technology and related resources, including expected improvements to programmatic or business operations, together with a review and evaluation of that statement prepared by the State Chief Information Officer.
(2) A statement setting forth the requirements for State resources, together with an evaluation of those requirements by the State Chief Information Officer that takes into consideration the State's current technology, the opportunities for technology sharing, the requirements of Article 3D of Chapter 147 of the General Statutes, and any other factors relevant to the analysis.
(3) A statement by the State Chief Information Officer that sets forth viable alternatives, if any, for meeting the agency needs in an economical and efficient manner.
(4) In the case of an acquisition, an explanation of the method by which the acquisition is to be financed.
This subsection shall not apply to
requests submitted by the General Assembly,Assembly or the
Administrative Office of the Courts, or The University of North Carolina.Courts."
SECTION 6.12.(k) G.S. 143C‑3‑5 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑3‑5. Budget recommendations and budget message.
…
(b) Odd‑Numbered Fiscal
Years. – In odd‑numbered years the budget recommendations shall
include the following components:
(1) A Recommended State
Budget setting forth goals for improving the State with recommended expenditure
requirements, funding sources, and performance information for each State
government program and for each proposed capital improvement. The Recommended
State Budget may be presented in a format chosen by the Director, except that
the Recommended State Budget shall clearly distinguish program continuation
requirements, program reductions, program eliminations, program expansions, and
new programs, and shall explain all proposed capital improvements in the
context of the Six‑Year Capital Improvements Plan and as required by
G.S. 143C‑8‑6. The Director shall include as continuation
requirements the amounts the Director proposes to fund for the enrollment
increases in public schools, community colleges, and the university system.
(1a) The Governor's Recommended State Budget shall include a continuation budget, which shall be presented in the budget support document pursuant to subdivision (2) of this subsection.
…
(5) A list of budget adjustments made during the prior fiscal year pursuant to G.S. 143C‑6‑4 that are included in the proposed continuation budget for the upcoming fiscal year.
(c) Even‑Numbered Fiscal
Years. – In even‑numbered years, the Governor may recommend changes
in the enacted budget for the second year of the biennium. These
recommendations shall be presented as amendments to the enacted budget and
shall be incorporated in a recommended Current Operations Appropriation Act and
a recommended Capital Improvements Appropriations Act as necessary. Any
recommended changes shall clearly distinguish program reductions, program
eliminations, program expansions, and new programs, and shall explain all
proposed capital improvements in the context of the Six‑Year Capital
Improvements Plan and as required by G.S. 143C‑8‑6. The
Governor shall provide sufficient supporting documentation and accounting
detail, consistent with that required by G.S. 143C‑3‑5(b),
corresponding to the recommended amendments to the enacted budget.
(d) Funds Included in
Budget. – Consistent with requirements of the North Carolina Constitution,
Article 5, Section 7(1), the Governor's Recommended State Budget, together with
the Budget Support Document, shall include recommended expenditures of State
funds from all Governmental and Proprietary Funds, as those funds are described
in G.S. 143C‑1‑3. G.S. 143C‑1‑3,
and all funds established for The University of North Carolina and its
constituent institutions that are subject to this Chapter. Except where
provided otherwise by federal law, funds received from the federal government
become State funds when deposited in the State treasury and shall be classified
and accounted for in the Governor's budget recommendations no differently than
funds from other sources.
…."
SECTION 6.12.(l) G.S. 143C‑4‑3 reads as rewritten:
"§
143C‑4‑3. Repairs and Renovations Reserve Account.Reserve.
(a) Creation and Source of
Funds. – The Repairs and Renovations Reserve Account is established as a
reserve in the General Fund. The State Controller shall reserve to the Repairs
and Renovations Reserve Account one‑fourth of any unreserved fund
balance, as determined on a cash basis, remaining in the General Fund at the
end of each fiscal year.
(b) Use of Funds. – The
funds in the Repairs and Renovations Reserve Account shall be used only
for the repair and renovation of State facilities and related infrastructure
that are supported from the General Fund. Funds from the Repairs and
Renovations Reserve Account shall be used only for the following types
of projects:
(1) Roof repairs and replacements;
(2) Structural repairs;
(3) Repairs and renovations to meet federal and State standards;
(4) Repairs to electrical, plumbing, and heating, ventilating, and air‑conditioning systems;
(5) Improvements to meet the requirements of the Americans with Disabilities Act, 42 U.S.C. § 12101, et seq., as amended;
(6) Improvements to meet fire safety needs;
(7) Improvements to existing facilities for energy efficiency;
(8) Improvements to remove asbestos, lead paint, and other contaminants, including the removal and replacement of underground storage tanks;
(9) Improvements and renovations to improve use of existing space;
(10) Historical restoration;
(11) Improvements to roads, walks, drives, utilities infrastructure; and
(12) Drainage and landscape improvements.
Funds from the Repairs and
Renovations Reserve Account shall not be used for new construction or
the expansion of the building area (sq. ft.) of an existing facility unless
required in order to comply with federal or State codes or standards.
(c) Use of Funds. – Funds
Available Only Upon Appropriation. – Funds reserved to the Repairs and
Renovations Reserve Account shall be available for expenditure only upon
an act of appropriation by the General Assembly.
(d) Board of Governors
May Allocate Allocation and Reallocation of Funds to for Particular
Projects. – Any funds in the Reserve for Repairs and Renovations Reserve
that are allocated to the Board of Governors of The University of North
Carolina or to the Office of State Budget and Management may be
allocated or reallocated by the Board those agencies for repairs
and renovations projects so long as (i) any project that receives an
allocation or reallocation satisfies the requirements of subsection (b) of this
section unless the Board determines that sufficient funds are not available
from other sources and that conditions warrant General Fund assistance and (ii)
the allocation or reallocation is in accordance with guidelines developed in
The University of North Carolina Funding Allocation Model for Reserve for
Repairs and Renovations, as approved by the Board of Governors of The
University of North Carolina. The Board of Governors shall report to the Joint
Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on the allocation or
reallocation of funds pursuant to this section within 60 days of any allocation
or reallocation under this subsection.all of the following conditions
are satisfied:
(1) Any project that receives an allocation or reallocation satisfies the requirements of subsection (b) of this section.
(2) If the allocation or reallocation of funds from one project to another under this section is two million five hundred thousand dollars ($2,500,000) or more for a particular project, the Office of State Budget and Management or the Board of Governors, as appropriate, consults with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to the expenditure or reallocation.(3) If the allocation or reallocation of funds from one project to another under this section is less than two million five hundred thousand dollars ($2,500,000) for a particular project, the allocation or reallocation of funds is reported to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations within 60 days of the expenditure or reallocation.
(e) Office of
State Budget and Management May Allocate Funds to Particular Projects. – Any
funds in the Reserve for Repairs and Renovations that are allocated to the
Office of State Budget and Management may be allocated or reallocated by the
State Budget Office for repairs and renovations projects so long as any project
that receives an allocation or reallocation satisfies the requirements of
subsection (b) of this section. The Office of State Budget and Management shall
consult with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior
to the allocation of these funds. The State Budget Office shall report to the
Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on the reallocation of
funds pursuant to this section within 60 days of any reallocation under this
subsection."
SECTION 6.12.(m) G.S. 143C‑6‑1 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑6‑1. Budget enacted by the General Assembly; certified budgets of State agencies.
…
(b) Departmental Receipts. – Departmental receipts collected to support a program or purpose shall be credited to the fund from which appropriations have been made to support that program or purpose. A State agency shall expend departmental receipts first, including receipts in excess of the amount of receipts budgeted in the certified budget for the program or purpose, and shall expend other funds appropriated for the purpose or program only to the extent that receipts are insufficient to meet the costs anticipated in the certified budget.
Except as authorized in G.S. 143C‑6‑4, excess departmental receipts shall not be used to increase expenditures for a purpose or program.
(c) Certification of the
Budget. – The Director of the Budget shall certify to each State agency the
amount appropriated to it for each program and each object from all governmental
and proprietary funds. funds included in the budget as defined in G.S. 143C‑3‑5(d).
The certified budget for each State agency shall reflect the total of all
appropriations enacted for each State agency by the General Assembly in the
Current Operations Appropriations Act, the Capital Improvements Appropriations
Act, and any other act affecting the State budget. The certified budget for
each State agency shall follow the format of the Budget Support Document as
modified to reflect changes enacted by the General Assembly."
SECTION 6.12.(n) G.S. 143C‑6‑4 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑6‑4. Budget Adjustments Authorized.
(a) Findings. – The General
Assembly recognizes that even the most thorough budget deliberations may be affected
by unforeseeable events. Underevents; therefore, under the limited
circumstances set forth in this section, the Director may is
authorized to adjust the enacted budget by making transfers among lines of
expenditure, purposes, or programs or by increasing expenditures funded by
departmental receipts. Under no circumstances, however, shall total General
Fund expenditures for a State department exceed the amount appropriated to that
department from the General Fund for the fiscal year.
(b) Adjustments to the Certified
Budget.Budget Adjustments. – Notwithstanding the provisions of
G.S. 143C‑6‑1, a State agency may, with approval of the
Director of the Budget, spend more than was authorized appropriated in
the certified budget by adjusting the authorized budget for all of the
following:
(1) Line items within programs. – An object or line item within a purpose or program so long as the total amount expended for the purpose or program is no more than was authorized in the certified budget for the purpose or program.
(2) Responses to extraordinary events. – A purpose or program if the overexpenditure of the purpose or program is:
a. Required by a court or Industrial Commission order;
b. Authorized under G.S. 166A‑19.40(a) of the North Carolina Emergency Management Act; or
c. Required to call out the North Carolina National Guard.
(3) Responses to unforeseen
circumstances. – A purpose or program not subject to the provisions of
subdivision (b)(2) of this subsection, but only in accord with the following
restrictions: (i) the subsection, if each of the following conditions is
satisfied:
a. The overexpenditure
is required to continue the purpose or programs due to complications or changes
in circumstances that could not have been foreseen when the budget for the fiscal
period was enacted, (ii) the enacted.b. The scope of
the purpose or program is not increased, (iii) theincreased.
c. The
overexpenditure is authorized on a nonrecurring basis, and (iv) under no
circumstances shall the total requirements for a State department exceed the
department's certified budget for the fiscal year by more than three percent
(3%) without prior consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on
Governmental Operations one‑time nonrecurring basis for one year
only, unless the overexpenditure is the result of (i) salary adjustments
authorized by law or (ii) the establishment of time‑limited positions
funded with agency receipts.
(b1) If the overexpenditure would cause a department's total requirements for a fund to exceed the department's certified budget for a fiscal year for that fund by more than three percent (3%), the Director shall consult with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to authorizing the overexpenditure.
(b2) Subsection (b) of this section shall not be construed to authorize budget adjustments that cause General Fund expenditures, excluding expenditures from General Fund receipts, to exceed General Fund appropriations for a department.
…."
SECTION 6.12.(o) G.S. 143C‑6‑21 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑6‑21. Payments to nonprofits.
Except as otherwise provided by
law, an annual appropriation of one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000) or less
to or for the use of a nonprofit corporation shall may be made in
a single annual payment. payment, in the discretion of the Director
of the Budget. An annual appropriation of more than one hundred thousand
dollars ($100,000) to or for the use of a nonprofit corporation shall be made
in quarterly or monthly payments, in the discretion of the Director of the
Budget."
SECTION 6.12.(p) G.S. 143C‑7‑2(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) Plans Submitted
and Reviewed. – The Secretary of each State agency that receives and
administers federal Block Grant funds shall prepare and submit the agency's
Block Grant plans to the Director of the Budget. The Director of the Budget
shall submit the Block Grant plans to the Fiscal Research Division of the
General Assembly not later than February 28 of each odd‑numbered calendar
year and not later than April 30 of each even‑numbered calendar year.the
General Assembly as part of the Recommended State Budget submitted pursuant to G.S. 143C‑3‑5."
SECTION 6.12.(q) G.S. 143C‑8‑2 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143C‑8‑2. Capital facilities inventory.
(a) The Department of Administration shall develop and maintain an automated inventory of all facilities owned by State agencies pursuant to G.S. 143‑341(4). The inventory shall include the location, occupying agency, ownership, size, description, condition assessment, maintenance record, parking and employee facilities, and other information to determine maintenance needs and prepare life‑cycle cost evaluations of each facility listed in the inventory. The Department of Administration shall update and publish the inventory at least once every three years. The Department shall also record in the inventory acquisitions of new facilities and significant changes in existing facilities as they occur.
(b) No later than October 1 of each even‑numbered year, the Department of Administration shall provide a summary of the information maintained in the inventory described in subsection (a) of this section to the Fiscal Research Division of the Legislative Services Commission. This summary shall include all of the following:
(1) A summary of the number, type, square footage or acreage, and condition of facilities allocated to or owned by each State agency.
(2) A summary of the geographical distribution of State facilities.
(3) An estimate of the percentage increase or decrease of square footage or acreage allocated to or owned by each State agency since the last report was submitted pursuant to this subsection.
(4) Any other information requested by the Fiscal Research Division."
SECTION 6.12.(r) G.S. 143C‑9‑7(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Funds Upon
appropriation by the General Assembly, funds received in the Indian Gaming
Education Revenue Fund are hereby appropriated as received to the State
Public School Fund for quarterly allotmentshall be allocated quarterly
by the State Board of Education to local school administrative units, charter
schools, and regional schools on the basis of allotted average daily
membership. The funds allotted by the State Board of Education pursuant to this
section shall be nonreverting. Funds received pursuant to this section by local
school administrative units shall be expended for classroom teachers, teacher
assistants, classroom materials or supplies, or textbooks."
CAP STATE FUNDED PORTION OF NONPROFIT SALARIES
SECTION 6.14. No more than one hundred twenty thousand dollars ($120,000) in State funds may be used for the annual salary of any individual employee of a nonprofit organization receiving State funds. For the purposes of this section, the term "State funds" means funds as defined in G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(25) and any interest earnings that accrue from those funds.
SECTION 6.15.(a) No State funds shall be used by a non‑State entity to pay for lobbying or lobbyists.
SECTION 6.15.(b) For the purposes of this section, the following definitions apply:
(1) Lobbying. – As defined by G.S. 120C‑100(a)(9).
(2) Lobbyist. – As defined by G.S. 120C‑100(a)(10).
(3) Non‑State entity. – As defined by G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(18).
(4) State funds. – As defined by G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(25) and interest earnings that accrue from those funds.
SECTION 6.16. Section 3(b) of S.L. 2012‑74 reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 3.(b) An interstate passenger air carrier is allowed a refund of the sales and use tax paid by it on fuel in excess of one million two hundred fifty thousand dollars ($1,250,000) for the period January 1, 2011, through June 30, 2011. The State portion of the refund is payable in two installments. The first installment, payable in fiscal year 2012‑2013, may not exceed three million one hundred fifty thousand dollars ($3,150,000). The remainder of the refund is payable in fiscal year 2013‑2014. The amount of sales and use tax paid does not include a refund allowed to the interstate passenger air carrier under G.S. 105‑164.14(a). A request for a refund must be in writing and must include any information and documentation required by the Secretary. The request for a refund is due before October 1, 2012. A refund applied for after the due date is barred."
RESTORE LOCAL GOVERNMENT HOLD HARMLESS FOR REPEALED REIMBURSEMENTS
SECTION 6.17. G.S. 105‑521 reads as rewritten:
"§ 105‑521. Transitional local government hold harmless for repealed reimbursements.
(a) Definitions. – The following definitions apply in this section:
(1) Local government. – A county or municipality that received a distribution of local sales taxes in the most recent fiscal year for which a local sales tax share has been calculated.
(2) Local sales tax share. – A local government's percentage share of the two‑cent (2¢) sales taxes distributed during the most recent fiscal year for which data are available.
(3) Repealed reimbursement amount. – The total amount a local government would have been entitled to receive during the 2002‑2003 fiscal year under G.S. 105‑164.44C, 105‑275.1, 105‑275.2, 105‑277.001, and 105‑277.1A, if the Governor had not withheld any distributions under those sections.
(3a) Replacement revenue. – The sum of the following:
a. Fifty percent (50%) of the amount of sales and use tax revenue distributed under Article 40 of this Chapter, other than revenue from the sale of food that is subject to local tax but is exempt from State tax under G.S. 105‑164.13B.
b. Twenty‑five percent (25%) of the amount of sales and use tax revenue distributed under Article 39 of this Chapter or under Chapter 1096 of the 1967 Session Laws, other than revenue from the sale of food that is subject to local tax but is exempt from State tax under G.S. 105‑164.13B.
(4) Two‑cent (2¢) sales taxes. – The first one‑cent (1¢) sales and use tax authorized in Article 39 of this Chapter and in Chapter 1096 of the 1967 Session Laws, the first one‑half cent (1/2¢) local sales and use tax authorized in Article 40 of this Chapter, and the second one‑half cent (1/2¢) local sales and use tax authorized in Article 42 of this Chapter.
(b) Distributions. – On or
before August 15, 2008, and every August 15 through August 15, 2012, September
15, 2013, the Secretary must multiply each local government's local sales
tax share by the estimated amount of replacement revenue that all local
governments are expected to receive during the current fiscal year. If the
resulting amount is less than one hundred percent (100%) of the local
government's repealed reimbursement amount, the Secretary must pay the local
government fifty percent (50%) of the difference, but not less than one
hundred dollars ($100.00).fifty dollars ($50.00).
On or before May 1 of each
fiscal year through May 1, 2012, August 15, 2013, the Department of
Revenue and the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly must each
submit to the Secretary and to the General Assembly a final projection of the
estimated amount of replacement revenue that all local governments would be
expected to receive during the upcoming fiscal year. If, after May 1 and before
a distribution is made, a law is enacted that would affect the projection, an
updated projection must be submitted as soon as practicable. If the Secretary
does not use the lower of the two final projections to make the calculation
required by this subsection, the Secretary must report the reasons for this
decision to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations within
60 days after receiving the projections.
(c) Source of Funds. – The Secretary must draw the funds distributed under this section from sales and use tax collections under Article 5 of this Chapter.
(d) Reports. – The
Secretary must report to the Revenue Laws Study Committee by January 31,
2004, and each January 31 through January 31, 2013, January 31, 2014, the
amount distributed under this section for the current fiscal year."
EUGENICS COMPENSATION PROGRAM
SECTION 6.18.(a) Article 9 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new Part to read:
"Part 30. Eugenics Asexualization and Sterilization Compensation Program.
"§ 143B‑426.50. Definitions.
As used in this Part, the following definitions apply:
(1) Claimant. – An individual on whose behalf a claim is made for compensation as a qualified recipient under this Part. An individual must be alive on June 30, 2013, in order to be a claimant.
(2) Commission. – The North Carolina Industrial Commission.
(3) Involuntarily. – In the case of:
a. A minor child, either with or without the consent of the minor child's parent, guardian, or other person standing in loco parentis.
b. An incompetent adult, with or without the consent of the incompetent adult's guardian or pursuant to a valid court order.
c. A competent adult, without the adult's informed consent, with the presumption being that the adult gave informed consent.
(4) Office. – The Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims.
(5) Qualified recipient. – An individual who was asexualized involuntarily or sterilized involuntarily under the authority of the Eugenics Board of North Carolina in accordance with Chapter 224 of the Public Laws of 1933 or Chapter 221 of the Public Laws of 1937.
"§ 143B‑426.51. Compensation payments.
(a) A claimant determined to be a qualified recipient under this Part shall receive lump‑sum compensation in the amount determined by this subsection from funds appropriated to the Department of State Treasurer for these purposes. Except as provided by the succeeding sentence, the amount of compensation for each qualified recipient is the sum of ten million dollars ($10,000,000) divided by the total number of qualified recipients, and all such payments shall be made on June 30, 2015. The State Treasurer shall reduce the ten million dollars ($10,000,000) by holding out a pro‑rata amount per claimant for any cases in which there has not been a final determination of the claim on June 30, 2015. Payments made to persons determined to be qualified claimants after that date shall be made upon such determination, and if after final adjudication of all claims there remains a balance from the funds held out, they shall be paid pro‑rata to all qualified claimants.
(a1) If any claimant shall die during the pendency of a claim, or after being determined to be a qualified recipient, any payment shall be made to the estate of the decedent.
(b) A qualified recipient may assign compensation received pursuant to subsection (a) of this section to a trust established for the benefit of the qualified recipient.
"§ 143B‑426.52. Claims for compensation for asexualization or sterilization.
(a) An individual shall be entitled to compensation as provided for in this Part if a claim is submitted on behalf of that individual in accordance with this Part on or before June 30, 2014, and that individual is subsequently determined by a preponderance of the evidence to be a qualified recipient, except that any competent adult who gave consent is not a qualified recipient unless that individual can show by a preponderance of the evidence that the consent was not informed.
(b) A claim under this section shall be submitted to the Office. The claim shall be in a form and supported by appropriate documentation and information, as required by the Commission. A claim may be submitted on behalf of a claimant by a person lawfully authorized to act on the individual's or the individual's estate's behalf.
(c) The Commission shall determine the eligibility of a claimant to receive the compensation authorized by this Part in accordance with G.S. 143B‑426.53. The Commission shall notify the claimant in writing of the Commission's determination regarding the claimant's eligibility.
(d) The Commission shall adopt rules for the determination of eligibility and the processing of claims.
"§ 143B‑426.53. Industrial Commission determination.
(a) The Commission shall determine whether a claimant is eligible for compensation as a qualified recipient under this Part. The Commission shall have all powers and authority granted under Article 31 of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes with regard to claims filed pursuant to this Part.
(b) A deputy commissioner shall be assigned by the Commission to make initial determinations of eligibility for compensation under this Part. The deputy commissioner shall review the claim and supporting documentation submitted on behalf of a claimant and shall make a determination of eligibility. In any case where the claimant was a competent adult when asexualized or sterilized, the burden is on the claimant to rebut the presumption that the claimant gave informed consent. If the claim is not approved, the deputy commissioner shall set forth in writing the reasons for the disapproval and notify the claimant.
(c) A claimant whose claim is not approved under subsection (b) of this section may submit to the Commission additional documentation in support of the individual's claim and request a redetermination by the deputy commissioner.
(d) A claimant whose claim is not approved under subsection (b) or (c) of this section shall have the right to request a hearing before the deputy commissioner. The hearing shall be conducted in accordance with rules of the Commission. For claimants who are residents of this State, at the request of the claimant, the hearing shall be held in the county of residence of the claimant. For claimants who are not residents of this State, the hearing shall be held in Wake County or at a location of mutual convenience as determined by the deputy commissioner. The claimant shall have the right to be represented, including the right to be represented by counsel, present evidence, and call witnesses. The deputy commissioner who hears the claim shall issue a written decision of eligibility which shall be sent to the claimant.
(e) Upon the issuance of a decision by the deputy commissioner under subsection (d) of this section, the claimant may file notice of appeal with the Commission within 30 days of the date notice of the deputy commissioner's decision is given. Such appeal shall be heard by the Commission, sitting as the full Commission, on the basis of the record in the matter and upon oral argument. The full Commission may amend, set aside, or strike out the decision of the deputy commissioner and may issue its own findings of fact, conclusions of law, and decision. The Commission shall notify all parties concerned in writing of its decision.
(f) A claimant may appeal the decision of the full Commission to the Court of Appeals within 30 days of the date notice of the decision of the full Commission is given. Appeals under this section shall be in accordance with the procedures set forth in G.S. 143‑293 and G.S. 143‑294.
(g) If at any stage of the proceedings the claimant is determined to be a qualified recipient, the Commission shall give notice to the claimant and to the Office of the State Treasurer, and the State Treasurer shall make payment of compensation to the qualified recipient or a trust specified under G.S. 143B‑426.51(b).
(h) Decisions and determinations by the Commission favorable to the claimant shall be final and not subject to appeal by the State.
(i) Costs under this section shall be taxed to the State.
"§ 143B‑426.54. Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims.
(a) There is created in the Department of Administration the Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims.
(b) At the request of a claimant or a claimant's legal representative, the Office shall assist an individual who may be a qualified recipient to determine whether the individual qualifies for compensation under this Part. The Office may assist an individual filing a claim under this Part and collect documentation in support of the claim. With the claimant's consent, the Office may represent and advocate for the claimant before the Commission and may assist the claimant with any good‑faith further appeal of an adverse decision on a claim.
(c) The Office shall plan and implement an outreach program to attempt to notify individuals who may be possible qualified recipients.
"§ 143B‑426.55. Confidentiality.
Records of all inquiries of eligibility, claims, and payments under this Part shall be confidential and not public records under Chapter 132 of the General Statutes.
"§ 143B‑426.56. Compensation excluded as income, resources, or assets.
(a) Any payment made under this section shall not be considered income or assets for purposes of determining the eligibility for, or the amount of, any benefits or assistance under any State or local program financed in whole or in part with State funds.
(b) Pursuant to G.S. 108A‑26.1, the Department of Health and Human Services shall do the following:
(1) Provide income, resource, and asset disregard to an applicant for, or recipient of, public assistance who receives compensation under this Part. The amount of the income, resource, and asset disregard shall be equal to the total compensation paid to the individual from the Eugenics Sterilization Compensation Fund.
(2) Provide resource protection by reducing any subsequent recovery by the State under G.S. 108A‑70.5 from a deceased recipient's estate for payment of Medicaid‑paid services by the amount of resource disregard given under subdivision (1) of this subsection.
(3) Adopt rules to implement the provisions of subdivisions (1) and (2) of this subsection.
"§ 143B‑426.57. Limitation of liability.
Nothing in this Part shall revive or extend any statute of limitations that may otherwise have expired prior to July 1, 2013. The State's liability arising from any cause of action related to any asexualization or sterilization performed pursuant to an order of the Eugenics Board of North Carolina shall be limited to the compensation authorized by this Part."
SECTION 6.18.(b) If House Bill 998 becomes law, then G.S. 105‑153.5(b), as enacted by House Bill 998, reads as rewritten:
"§ 105‑153.5. Modifications to adjusted gross income.
…
(b) Other Deductions. – In calculating North Carolina taxable income, a taxpayer may deduct from the taxpayer's adjusted gross income any of the following items that are included in the taxpayer's adjusted gross income:
…
(9) The amount paid to the taxpayer during the taxable year from the Eugenics Sterilization Compensation Fund as compensation to a qualified recipient under the Eugenics Asexualization and Sterilization Compensation Program under Part 30 of Article 9 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes. This subdivision expires for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2016."
SECTION 6.18.(c) G.S. 132‑1.23 reads as rewritten:
"§ 132‑1.23. Eugenics program records.
(a) Records in the custody
of the State, including those in the custody of the North CarolinaOffice
of Justice for Sterilization FoundationVictims, concerning
the North CarolinaEugenics Board of North Carolina's program are
confidential and are not public records to the extent they concern:records,
including the records identifying (i) personsindividuals impacted
by the program, (ii) persons individuals, or their guardians or
authorized agents agents, inquiring about the impact of the
program on them,the individuals, or (iii) persons individuals,
or their guardians or authorized agents agents, inquiring
about the potential impact of the program on others.
(b) Notwithstanding
subsection (a) of this section, a person an individual impacted
by the program may obtain that person's individual records under the
program, and a guardian or authorized agent of that person may also obtain
them.program, or a guardian or authorized agent of that individual, may
obtain that individual's records under the program upon execution of a proper release
authorization.
(c) Notwithstanding subsections (a) and (b) of this section, minutes or reports of the Eugenics Board of North Carolina, for which identifying information of the individuals impacted by the program have been redacted, may be released to any person. As used in this subsection, "identifying information" shall include the name, street address, birth day and month, and any other information the State believes may lead to the identity of any individual impacted by the program, or of any relative of an individual impacted by the program."
SECTION 6.18.(d) There is established the Eugenics Sterilization Compensation Fund. The Fund shall be designated a special fund and shall be used to pay the compensation authorized under Part 30 of Article 9 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes. The Fund shall be administered by the Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims established in G.S. 143B‑426.54. Monies in the Fund shall not be expended or transferred except in accordance with Part 30 of Article 9 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes. Monies in the Fund shall remain until all claims timely filed with the Industrial Commission as prescribed in this act have been finally adjudicated and all qualified recipients who timely submit claims are paid. The Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims and the Fund are subject to the oversight of the State Auditor pursuant to Article 5A of Chapter 147 of the General Statutes.
SECTION 6.18.(e) The Department of Health and Human Services shall submit to the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services by August 1, 2013, a State Plan Amendment for the Medical Assistance Program and a State Plan Amendment for the Children's Health Insurance Program to allow for income, resource, and asset disregard for compensation payments under Part 30 of Article 9 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes, the Eugenics Asexualization and Sterilization Compensation Program, as enacted by this act.
SECTION 6.18.(f) Of the funds appropriated to the Eugenics Sterilization Compensation Fund, the sum of one hundred twenty‑three thousand seven hundred forty‑eight dollars ($123,748) shall be transferred to the Office of Justice for Sterilization Victims to pay the continued operations of the Justice for Sterilization Victims Foundation for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year.
SECTION 6.18.(g) Subsection (b) of this section becomes effective for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2015. Subsections (e) and (g) of this section are effective when this act becomes law. The remainder of this section becomes effective July 1, 2013. Except for the provisions of subsections (b) and (c) of this section, and the final adjudication of any claims under subsection (a) of this section that are pending on June 30, 2015, this section expires June 30, 2015.
PART VII. INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY
SECTION 7.1. The availability used to support appropriations made in this act from the Information Technology Fund established in G.S. 147‑33.72H is as follows:
FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
General Fund Appropriation for IT Fund $6,053,142 $6,055,342
General Fund Appropriation for
Government Data Analytics Center $3,000,000 $4,417,515
Interest $2,200 $2,200
IT Fund Balance, June 30 $0 $0
Total Funds Available $9,055,342 $10,475,057
Appropriations are made from the Information Technology Fund for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium as follows:
Information Technology Operations
Criminal Justice Information Network $189,563 $189,563
Center for Geographic Information and Analysis $495,338 $495,338
Enterprise Security Risk Management $864,148 $864,148
Enterprise Project Management Office $1,473,285 $1,473,285
Architecture and Engineering $851,986 $851,986
State Web Site $224,741 $224,741
Enterprise Licenses $33,000 $33,000
Subtotal Information Technology Operations $4,132,061 $4,132,061
Information Technology Projects
Government Data Analytics Center $3,000,000 $4,417,515 IT Consolidation $1,021,081 $1,021,081
Electronic Forms/Digital Signatures $900,000 $900,000
Subtotal Information Technology Projects $4,921,081 $6,338,596
Total $9,053,142 $10,470,657
Unless a change is approved by the State Chief Information Officer after consultation with the Office of State Budget and Management, funds appropriated to the Information Technology Fund shall be spent only as specified in this section. Changes shall not result in any degradation to the information technology operations or projects listed in this section for which the funds were originally appropriated.
Any changes to the specified uses shall be reported in writing to the Chairs of the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Chair and Cochair of the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY INTERNAL SERVICE FUND
SECTION 7.2.(a) G.S. 147‑33.88 reads as rewritten:
"§ 147‑33.88. Information technology budget development and reports.
(a) The Office shall
develop an annual budget for review and approval by the Office of State Budget
and Management prior to April 1 of each year.The Office of Information
Technology Services (ITS) shall develop an annual budget for review and
approval by the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM) in accordance with
a schedule prescribed by the Director of the Office of State Budget and
Management. The approved Information Technology Internal Service Fund budget
shall be included in the Governor's budget recommendations to the General
Assembly.
The Office of State Budget and Management shall ensure that State agencies have an opportunity to adjust their budgets based on any rate changes proposed by the Office of Information Technology Services and approved by the Office of State Budget and Management.
(b) The Office shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the Office's Internal Service Fund on a quarterly basis, no later than the first day of the second month following the end of the quarter. The report shall include current cash balances, line‑item detail on expenditures from the previous quarter, and anticipated expenditures and revenues. The Office shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on expenditures for the upcoming quarter, projected year‑end balance, and the status report on personnel position changes including new positions created and existing positions eliminated. The Office spending reports shall comply with the State Accounting System object codes."
SECTION 7.2.(b) IT Internal Service Fund. – For each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, receipts for the IT Internal Service Fund shall not exceed one hundred ninety million dollars ($190,000,000), excluding a 60‑day balance for contingencies. Rates approved by the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM) to support the IT Internal Service Fund shall be based on this fund limit. In the event the Fund exceeds the required limit, rates shall be adjusted within 30 days. In the event that an increase in receipts for the IT Internal Service Fund is required, the Office of Information Technology services may only implement the increase after consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations.
SECTION 7.2.(c) Rate Setting. – By October 31, 2013, the State Chief Information Officer shall establish consistent, fully transparent, easily understandable rates that reflect industry standards for each service for which any agency is charged. A report explaining the rate structure shall be submitted to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Chairs of the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division. An interim report shall be submitted by July 30, 2013. Overhead charges to agencies shall be consistently applied and shall reflect industry standards for the particular service. Rate increases shall require the approval of OSBM and consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations. Rate reductions may be implemented following notification of OSBM.
SECTION 7.2.(d) Agency Billing and Payments. – The State Chief Information Officer shall ensure that bills from the Office of Information Technology Services are easily understandable and fully transparent. If a State agency fails to pay its IT Internal Service Fund bill within 30 days of receipt, the Office of State Budget and Management may transfer funds from the agency to fully or partially cover the cost of the bill from that agency to the IT Internal Service Fund, following notification of the affected agency.
SECTION 7.2.(e) Unspecified Uses. – Any uses of the IT Internal Service Fund not specifically related to the operation of the Office of Information Technology Services, to include any transfers to other State agencies, shall immediately be reported to the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division with a detailed explanation as to why it was necessary to use the Fund. The State Chief Information Officer may use the IT Internal Service Fund, and any other available resources, to accelerate desktop remediation and associated software upgrades, if it is in the State's best interest.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY RESERVE FUND
SECTION 7.3.(a) Funds in the Reserve for Information Technology for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year consist of the sum of twenty‑eight million dollars ($28,000,000) appropriated from the General Fund. Funds in the Reserve for Information Technology for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year consist of the sum of thirty‑one million five hundred eighty‑two thousand four hundred eighty‑five dollars ($31,582,485) appropriated from the General Fund.
SECTION 7.3.(b) The Information Technology Reserve Fund shall be established in the Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO). It shall be interest‑bearing and nonreverting. The State CIO shall follow established procedures for project approval. Appropriations are made from the Information Technology Reserve Fund for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium as follows:
FY 2013‑2014 FY 2014‑2015
Prepare/Focus $ 250,000 $ 0
Plan 1,570,806 2,239,512
Build 1,507,353 2,882,254
Remediation 1,100,000 600,000
Security 1,571,394 392,788
Network Simplification 0 4,832,485
Desktop Remediation 17,000,000 13,300,000
Desktop Software Licenses 4,015,000 2,300,000
Operate 985,447 685,446
Customer Data 0 1,000,000
Secure Sign‑On 0 3,350,000
Innovation Center 0 0
SECTION 7.3.(c) By September 15, 2013, the State Chief Information Officer shall provide a time line for completing initiatives included in the IT Reserve Fund to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division. The time line shall include the dates for completion of a strategic plan, an enterprise architecture, a new business case methodology, and implementation of a new project management process. Not later than the dates specified in the time line, each of these documents shall be submitted to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY OPERATIONS
SECTION 7.4.(a) Server Inventory. – The State Chief Information Officer (State CIO) shall develop an inventory of servers and server locations in State agencies. Based on this inventory, the State CIO shall develop a plan to consolidate agency servers in State‑owned data centers. By November 1, 2013, the State CIO shall provide a written plan for accomplishing this to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.4.(b) Hosting/Backups. – The State CIO shall identify information technology applications that are hosted by vendors that are not backed up on State‑owned infrastructure. The State CIO shall work with impacted State agencies to develop a plan to ensure that any State agency application hosted by a vendor is backed up on State‑owned infrastructure. By January 1, 2014, the State CIO shall provide a plan for accomplishing this to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.4.(c) Restructuring Plan. – The State CIO shall conduct a comprehensive review of the State's overall information technology operations, including the efficacy of existing exemptions and exceptions from unified State IT governance. Based upon this analysis, the State CIO shall develop a plan to restructure the State's IT operations for the most effective and efficient utilization of resources and capabilities. The plan shall include identifying, documenting, and providing a framework for developing and implementing the education and training required for all State information technology personnel, including information technology contracting professionals. Each State agency, department, and institution, and The University of North Carolina, shall (i) cooperate fully with the Office of the State CIO during the review and assessment phase of restructuring plan development and (ii) provide to the State CIO all information needed to carry out the purposes of this subsection. By May 1, 2014, the State CIO shall present the plan to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, along with any recommended legislative proposals for implementation to be considered for introduction during the 2014 Regular Session of the 2013 General Assembly.
SECTION 7.4.(e) Telecommunications Service Clarification. – G.S. 105‑164.13(54) reads as rewritten:
"The sale at retail and the use, storage, or consumption in this State of the following tangible personal property, digital property, and services are specifically exempted from the tax imposed by this Article:
…
(54) The following telecommunications services and charges:
a. Telecommunications service that is a component part of or is integrated into a telecommunications service that is resold. This exemption does not apply to service purchased by a pay telephone provider who uses the service to provide pay telephone service. Examples of services that are resold include carrier charges for access to an intrastate or interstate interexchange network, interconnection charges paid by a provider of mobile telecommunications service, and charges for the sale of unbundled network elements. An unbundled network element is a network element, as defined in 47 U.S.C. § 153(29), to which access is provided on an unbundled basis pursuant to 47 U.S.C. § 251(c)(3).
b. Pay telephone service.
c. 911 charges imposed under G.S. 62A‑43 and remitted to the 911 Fund under that section.
d. Charges for telecommunications service made by a hotel, motel, or another entity whose gross receipts are taxable under G.S. 105‑164.4(a)(3) when the charges are incidental to the occupancy of the entity's accommodations.
e. Telecommunications
service purchased or provided by a State agency or a unit of local
government for the North Carolina Information Highway State Network or
another data network owned or leased by the State or unit of local
government."
STATEWIDE INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY PROCUREMENT
SECTION 7.5. Statewide information technology procurement shall be funded through fees charged to agencies using the services of the Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office. The Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall provide to the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM) a fee schedule to allow cost recovery. If an agency fails to pay for services within 30 days of billing, OSBM shall transfer the unpaid amount to the State Information Technology Procurement Office, following notification of the affected agency.
PUBLIC SCHOOL PROCUREMENT OF INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY
SECTION 7.6.(a) The State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall work with the North Carolina Department of Public Instruction (DPI) and the Governor's Education Council to implement public school cooperative purchasing agreements for the procurement of information technology (IT) goods and services to support public schools. For purposes of this section, the phrase "public school cooperative purchasing agreement" means an agreement implemented pursuant to this section and available for local school administrative units, regional schools, charter schools, or some combination thereof, providing for collaborative or collective purchases of information technology goods and services in order to leverage economies of scale and to reduce costs.
SECTION 7.6.(b) Each public school cooperative purchasing agreement shall be based on a defined statewide information technology need to support education in the public schools. Each public school cooperative purchasing agreement shall allow for equal access to technology tools and services and shall provide a standard competitive cost throughout North Carolina for each tool or service. Public school cooperative purchasing agreements shall follow State information technology procurement laws, rules, and procedures.
SECTION 7.6.(c) By October 1, 2013, and quarterly thereafter, the Office of the State CIO and DPI shall report on the establishment of public school cooperative purchasing agreements, savings resulting from the establishment of the agreements, and any issues impacting the establishment of the agreements. The reports shall be made to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY CONTRACTS
SECTION 7.7.(a) SCIO Review. – The State Chief Information Officer (State CIO) shall review all State information technology (IT) contracts and shall develop a plan to consolidate duplicate IT contracts and multiple IT contracts with the same vendor.
SECTION 7.7.(b) Bulk Purchasing. – The State CIO shall develop a plan to modify bulk purchasing contracts, while maintaining economies of scale, to provide agencies with the option of purchasing equipment on an "as‑needed" basis. By December 15, 2013, the State CIO shall provide the plan to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division. The State CIO may modify the plan based upon input from the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and, following the review, shall begin implementation of the plan.
SECTION 7.7.(c) Sole Sourcing, Extensions, and Expansions Limited. – State IT contracts, including sole sourcing, extensions of the period of performance, or expansion of the scope of existing contracts, must receive the prior approval of the State CIO who may grant a specific exception. The State CIO shall immediately report any exceptions granted to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall explain the reasons why the exception was deemed to be appropriate.
SECTION 7.7.(d) G.S. 147‑33.72C(e) reads as rewritten:
"(e) Performance
Contracting. – All contracts between a State agency and a private party for
information technology projects shall include provisions for vendor performance
review and accountability. The State CIO may require that these contract
provisions require a performance bond, include monetary penalties penalties,
or require other performance assurance measures for projects that are not
completed or performed within the specified time period or that involve
costs in excess of those specified in the contract. The State CIO may utilize
cost‑savings realized on government vendor partnerships, as defined in G.S. 143‑135.9,
as performance incentives for an information technology project vendor.require
contract provisions requiring a vendor to provide a performance bond."
SECTION 7.7.(e) Enterprise Contracts. – The State CIO shall consult participating agency chief information officers and obtain approval from the Office of State Budget and Management prior to the initiation of any enterprise project or contract and shall ensure that enterprise project and contract costs are allocated to participating agencies in an equitable manner. Enterprise agreements shall not exceed the participating State agencies' ability to financially support the contracts.
The State CIO shall not enter into any enterprise information technology contracts without obtaining written agreements from participating State agencies regarding the apportionment of the contract cost. State agencies agreeing to participate in a contract shall:
(1) Ensure that sufficient funds are budgeted to support their agreed shares of enterprise contracts throughout the life of the contract.
(2) Transfer the required funding to the Information Technology Internal Service Fund in sufficient time for the Office of Information Technology Services to meet vendor contract requirements.
SECTION 7.7.(f) Three‑Year Contracts. – Notwithstanding the cash management provisions of G.S. 147‑86.11, the Office of Information Technology Services may procure information technology goods and services for periods up to a total of three years where the terms of the procurement contracts require payment of all or a portion of the contract price at the beginning of the contract agreement. All of the following conditions shall be met before payment for these agreements may be disbursed:
(1) Any advance payment can be accomplished within the IT Internal Service Fund budget.
(2) The State Controller receives conclusive evidence that the proposed agreement would be more cost‑effective than a multiyear agreement that complies with G.S. 147‑86.11.
(3) The procurement complies in all other aspects with applicable statutes and rules.
(4) The proposed agreement contains contract terms that protect the financial interest of the State against contractor nonperformance or insolvency through the creation of escrow accounts for funds, source codes, or both, or by any other reasonable means that have legally binding effect.
The Office of State Budget and Management shall ensure the savings from any authorized agreement shall be included in the IT Internal Service Fund rate calculations before approving annual proposed rates. Any savings resulting from the agreements shall be returned to agencies included in the contract in the form of reduced rates. Beginning October 1, 2013, ITS shall submit a quarterly written report of any authorizations granted under this section to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY PERSONAL SERVICES CONTRACT REQUIREMENTS
SECTION 7.8. Notwithstanding any provision of law to the contrary, no contract for information technology personal services, or that provides personnel to perform information technology functions, may be established or renewed without written approval from the Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office and the Office of State Budget and Management. To facilitate compliance with this requirement, the Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office shall develop and document the following:
(1) Standards for determining whether it is more appropriate for an agency to hire an employee or use the services of a vendor.
(2) A process to monitor all State agency personal services contracts, as well as any other State contracts providing personnel to perform information technology functions.
(3) A process for obtaining approval of contractor positions.
The Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office shall review current personal services contracts and determine if each contractor is performing a function that could more appropriately be performed by a State employee. Where the determination is made that a State employee should be performing the function, the Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office shall work with the impacted agency and the Office of State Personnel to identify or create the position.
Beginning October 1, 2013, the Statewide Information Technology Procurement Office shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on its progress toward standardizing information technology personal services contracts. In addition, the report shall include detailed information on the number of personal service contractors in each State agency, the cost for each, and the comparable cost (including benefits) of a State employee serving in that capacity rather than a contractor.
PREVENT DUPLICATION OF INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY CAPABILITIES
SECTION 7.9.(a) The Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall develop a plan and adopt measures to prevent the duplication of information technology capabilities and resources across State agencies. When multiple agencies require the same, or substantially similar, information technology capabilities, the State CIO shall designate one State agency as the lead to coordinate and manage the capability for all State agencies, with the State CIO maintaining oversight of the effort. By October 1, 2013, the State CIO shall provide this plan to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.9.(b) The Office of the State Chief Information Officer shall do all of the following to carry out the purposes of this section:
(1) Review all current and future information technology projects to determine whether the capabilities required for each project already exist in a planned, ongoing, or completed information technology project developed by another State agency. For projects where the capability already exists, the Office of the State CIO shall assist the agency with implementing the existing capability.
(2) Identify existing projects that can best support a specific information technology capability for multiple agencies and work to transition all agencies requiring the specific capability to the identified projects.
(3) When State agencies request approval for new projects, determine if the information technology project can be implemented using an existing application, or if the new project has the potential to support multiple agencies' requirements.
(4) Provide quarterly reports on progress toward eliminating duplication to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
(5) Ensure that contracts for information technology allow the addition of other agencies' requirements within the terms of the existing contracts.
SECTION 7.9.(c) All State agencies shall coordinate any Geographic Information System (GIS) initiatives through the Center for Geographic Information and Analysis (CGIA) in the Office of Information Technology Services, as well as the Office of the State CIO, to ensure that existing capabilities are not being duplicated. The CGIA shall monitor and approve all new GIS‑related information technology projects and expansion budget requests. By January 1 of each year, the CGIA shall submit a written report on GIS duplication to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
The CGIA shall conduct a review of all GIS applications in State agencies, identify instances of duplication for existing applications, and develop a plan for consolidating duplicative projects. By November 1, 2013, the CGIA shall provide a report on the review to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
GOVERNMENT DATA ANALYTICS/DATA SHARING
SECTION 7.10.(a) G.S. 20‑7(b2) reads as rewritten:
"(b2) Disclosure of Social Security Number. – The social security number of an applicant is not a public record. The Division may not disclose an applicant's social security number except as allowed under federal law. A violation of the disclosure restrictions is punishable as provided in 42 U.S.C. § 408, as amended.
In accordance with 42 U.S.C. 405 and 42 U.S.C. 666, as amended, the Division may disclose a social security number obtained under subsection (b1) of this section only as follows:
(1) For the purpose of administering the driver's license laws.
(2) To the Department of Health and Human Services, Child Support Enforcement Program for the purpose of establishing paternity or child support or enforcing a child support order.
(3) To the Department of Revenue for the purpose of verifying taxpayer identity.
(4) To the Office of Indigent Defense Services of the Judicial Department for the purpose of verifying the identity of a represented client and enforcing a court order to pay for the legal services rendered.
(5) To each county jury commission for the purpose of verifying the identity of deceased persons whose names should be removed from jury lists.
(6) To the Office of the State Controller for the purposes of G.S. 143B‑426.38A."
SECTION 7.10.(b) G.S. 20‑43(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) All records of the
Division, other than those declared by law to be confidential for the use of
the Division, shall be open to public inspection during office hours in
accordance with G.S. 20‑43.1. A photographic image or signature
recorded in any format by the Division for a drivers license or a special
identification card is confidential and shall not be released except for law
enforcement purposes. A photographic image recorded in any format by the
Division for a drivers license or a special identification card is confidential
and shall not be released except for law enforcement purposes or to the Office
of the State Controller for the purposes of G.S. 143B‑426.38A."
SECTION 7.10.(c) G.S. 105‑259(b) is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(44) To furnish tax information to the Office of the State Controller under G.S. 143B‑426.38A. The use and reporting of individual data may be restricted to only those activities specifically allowed by law when potential fraud or other illegal activity is indicated."
"§ 143B‑426.38A. Government Data Analytics Center; State data‑sharing requirements.
(a) State Government Data Analytics. – The State shall initiate across State agencies, departments, and institutions a data integration and data‑sharing initiative that is not intended to replace transactional systems but is instead intended to leverage the data from those systems for enterprise‑level State business intelligence.
(1) Creation of initiative. – In carrying out the purposes of this section, the Office of the State Controller shall conduct an ongoing, comprehensive evaluation of State data analytics projects and plans in order to identify data integration and business intelligence opportunities that will generate greater efficiencies in, and improved service delivery by, State agencies, departments, and institutions. The State Controller and State CIO shall continue to utilize public‑private partnerships and existing data integration and analytics contracts and licenses as appropriate to continue the implementation of the initiative.
(2) Application to State government. – The initiative shall include all State agencies, departments, and institutions, including The University of North Carolina.
(3) Governance. – The State Controller shall lead the initiative established pursuant to this section. The Chief Justice of the North Carolina Supreme Court and the Legislative Services Commission each shall designate an officer or agency to advise and assist the State Controller with respect to implementation of the initiative in their respective branches of government. The judicial and legislative branches shall fully cooperate in the initiative mandated by this section in the same manner as is required of State agencies.
(b) Government Data Analytics Center. –
(1) GDAC established. – There is established in the Office of the State Controller the Government Data Analytics Center (GDAC). GDAC shall assume the work, purpose, and resources of the current data integration effort in the Office of the State Controller and shall otherwise advise and assist the State Controller in the management of the initiative. The State Controller shall make any organizational changes necessary to maximize the effectiveness and efficiency of GDAC.
(2) Powers and duties of the GDAC. – The State Controller shall, through the GDAC, do all of the following:
a. Continue and coordinate ongoing enterprise data integration efforts, including:
1. The deployment, support, technology improvements, and expansion for the Criminal Justice Law Enforcement Automated Data System (CJLEADS).
2. The pilot and subsequent phase initiative for the North Carolina Financial Accountability and Compliance Technology System (NCFACTS).
3. Individual‑level student data and workforce data from all levels of education and the State workforce.
4. Other capabilities developed as part of the initiative.
b. Identify technologies currently used in North Carolina that have the capability to support the initiative.
c. Identify other technologies, especially those with unique capabilities, that could support the State's business intelligence effort.
d. Compare capabilities and costs across State agencies.
e. Ensure implementation is properly supported across State agencies.
f. Ensure that data integration and sharing is performed in a manner that preserves data privacy and security in transferring, storing, and accessing data, as appropriate.
g. Immediately seek any waivers and enter into any written agreements that may be required by State or federal law to effectuate data sharing and to carry out the purposes of this section.
h. Coordinate data requirements and usage for State business intelligence applications in a manner that (i) limits impacts on participating State agencies as those agencies provide data and business knowledge expertise and (ii) assists in defining business rules so the data can be properly used.
i. Recommend the most cost‑effective and reliable long‑term hosting solution for enterprise‑level State business intelligence as well as data integration, notwithstanding Section 6A.2(f) of S.L. 2011‑145.
(c) Implementation of the Enterprise‑Level Business Intelligence Initiative. –
(1) Phases of the initiative. – The initiative shall cycle through these phases on an ongoing basis:
a. Phase I requirements. – In the first phase, the State Controller through GDAC shall:
1. Inventory existing State agency business intelligence projects, both completed and under development.
2. Develop a plan of action that does all of the following:
I. Defines the program requirements, objectives, and end state of the initiative.
II. Prioritizes projects and stages of implementation in a detailed plan and benchmarked time line.
III. Includes the effective coordination of all of the State's current data integration initiatives.
IV. Utilizes a common approach that establishes standards for business intelligence initiatives for all State agencies and prevents the development of projects that do not meet the established standards.
V. Determines costs associated with the development efforts and identifies potential sources of funding.
VI. Includes a privacy framework for business intelligence consisting of adequate access controls and end user security requirements.
VII. Estimates expected savings.
3. Inventory existing external data sources that are purchased by State agencies to determine whether consolidation of licenses is appropriate for the enterprise.
4. Determine whether current, ongoing projects support the enterprise‑level objectives.
5. Determine whether current applications are scalable or are applicable for multiple State agencies or both.
b. Phase II requirements. – In the second phase, the State Controller through the GDAC shall:
1. Identify redundancies and recommend to the State CIO any projects that should be discontinued.
2. Determine where gaps exist in current or potential capabilities.
c. Phase III requirements. – In the third phase:
1. The State Controller through GDAC shall incorporate or consolidate existing projects, as appropriate.
2. The State Controller shall, notwithstanding G.S. 147‑33.76 or any rules adopted pursuant thereto, eliminate redundant business intelligence projects, applications, software, and licensing.
3. The State Controller through GDAC shall complete all necessary steps to ensure data integration in a manner that adequately protects privacy.
(2) Project management. – The State CIO shall ensure that all current and new business intelligence/data analytics projects are in compliance with all State laws, policies, and rules pertaining to information technology procurement, project management, and project funding and that they include quantifiable and verifiable savings to the State. The State CIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology on projects that are not achieving projected savings. The report shall include a proposed corrective action plan for the project.
The Office of the State CIO, with the assistance of the Office of State Budget and Management, shall identify potential funding sources for expansion of existing projects or development of new projects. No GDAC project shall be initiated, extended, or expanded:
a. Without the specific approval of the General Assembly unless the project can be implemented within funds appropriated for GDAC projects.
b. Without prior consultation to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and a report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology if the project can be implemented within funds appropriated for GDAC projects.
(d) Funding. – The Office of the State Controller, with the support of the Office of State Budget and Management, shall identify and make all efforts to secure any matching funds or other resources to assist in funding this initiative. Savings resulting from the cancellation of projects, software, and licensing, as well as any other savings from the initiative, shall be returned to the General Fund and shall remain unexpended and unencumbered until appropriated by the General Assembly in a subsequent fiscal year. It is the intent of the General Assembly that expansion of the initiative in subsequent fiscal years be funded with these savings and that the General Assembly appropriate funds for projects in accordance with the priorities identified by the Office of the State Controller in Phase I of the initiative.
(d1) Appropriations. – Of the funds appropriated to the Information Technology Fund, the sum of three million dollars ($3,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of four million four hundred seventeen thousand five hundred fifteen dollars ($4,417,515) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used to support the GDAC and NCFACTS. Of these funds, the sum of one million four hundred seventeen thousand five hundred fifteen dollars ($1,417,515) shall be used in each fiscal year of the 2013‑2015 biennium for OSC internal costs. For fiscal year 2014‑2015, of the funds generated by GDAC and NCFACTS projects and returned to the General Fund, the sum of up to five million dollars ($5,000,000) is appropriated to fund GDAC and NCFACTS, to include vendor payments. Prioritization for the expenditure of these funds shall be for State costs associated with GDAC first, then vendor costs second. Funds in the 2013‑2015 fiscal year budgets for GDAC and NCFACTS shall be used solely to support the continuation for these priority project areas.
(e) Reporting. – The Office of the State Controller shall:
(1) Submit and present quarterly reports on the implementation of Phase I of the initiative and the plan developed as part of that phase to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Appropriations and Senate Base Budget/Appropriations Committees, to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, and to the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly. The State Controller shall submit a report prior to implementing any improvements, expending funding for expansion of existing business intelligence efforts, or establishing other projects as a result of its evaluations, and quarterly thereafter, a written report detailing progress on, and identifying any issues associated with, State business intelligence efforts.
(2) Report the following information as needed:
a. Any failure of a State agency to provide information requested pursuant to this section. The failure shall be reported to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Appropriations and Senate Base Budget/Appropriations Committees.
b. Any additional information to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology that is requested by those entities.
(f) Data Sharing. –
(1) General duties of all State agencies. – The head of each State agency, department, and institution shall do all of the following:
a. Grant the Office of the State Controller access to all information required to develop and support State business intelligence applications pursuant to this section. The State Controller and the GDAC shall take all necessary actions and precautions, including training, certifications, background checks, and governance policy and procedure, to ensure the security, integrity, and privacy of the data in accordance with State and federal law and as may be required by contract.
b. Provide complete information on the State agency's information technology, operational, and security requirements.
c. Provide information on all of the State agency's information technology activities relevant to the State business intelligence effort.
d. Forecast the State agency's projected future business intelligence information technology needs and capabilities.
e. Ensure that the State agency's future information technology initiatives coordinate efforts with the GDAC to include planning and development of data interfaces to incorporate data into the initiative and to ensure the ability to leverage analytics capabilities.
f. Provide technical and business resources to participate in the initiative by providing, upon request and in a timely and responsive manner, complete and accurate data, business rules and policies, and support.
g. Identify potential resources for deploying business intelligence in their respective State agencies and as part of the enterprise‑level effort.
h. Immediately seek any waivers and enter into any written agreements that may be required by State or federal law to effectuate data sharing and to carry out the purposes of this section, as appropriate.
(2) Specific requirements. – The State Controller and the GDAC shall enhance the State's business intelligence through the collection and analysis of data relating to workers' compensation claims for the purpose of preventing and detecting fraud, as follows:
a. The North Carolina Industrial Commission shall release to GDAC, or otherwise provide electronic access to, all data requested by GDAC relating to workers' compensation insurance coverage, claims, appeals, compliance, and enforcement under Chapter 97 of the General Statutes.
b. The North Carolina Rate Bureau (Bureau) shall release to GDAC, or otherwise provide electronic access to, all data requested by GDAC relating to workers' compensation insurance coverage, claims, business ratings, and premiums under Chapter 58 of the General Statutes. The Bureau shall be immune from civil liability for releasing information pursuant to this subsection, even if the information is erroneous, provided the Bureau acted in good faith and without malicious or willful intent to harm in releasing the information.
c. The Department of Commerce, Division of Employment Security (DES), shall release to GDAC, or otherwise provide access to, all data requested by GDAC relating to unemployment insurance coverage, claims, and business reporting under Chapter 96 of the General Statutes.
d. The Department of Labor shall release to GDAC, or otherwise provide access to, all data requested by GDAC relating to safety inspections, wage and hour complaints, and enforcement activities under Chapter 95 of the General Statutes.
e. The Department of Revenue shall release to GDAC, or otherwise provide access to, all data requested by GDAC relating to the registration and address information of active businesses, business tax reporting, and aggregate federal tax Form 1099 data for comparison with information from DES, the Rate Bureau, and the Department of the Secretary of State for the evaluation of business reporting. Additionally, the Department of Revenue shall furnish to the GDAC, upon request, other tax information, provided that the information furnished does not impair or violate any information‑sharing agreements between the Department and the United States Internal Revenue Service. Notwithstanding any other provision of law, a determination of whether furnishing the information requested by GDAC would impair or violate any information‑sharing agreements between the Department of Revenue and the United States Internal Revenue Service shall be within the sole discretion of the State Chief Information Officer. The Department of Revenue and the Office of the State Controller shall work jointly to assure that the evaluation of tax information pursuant to this subdivision is performed in accordance with applicable federal law.
(3) All information shared with GDAC and the State Controller under this subdivision is protected from release and disclosure in the same manner as any other information is protected under this section.
(g) Provisions on Privacy and Confidentiality of Information. –
(1) Status with respect to certain information. – The State Controller and the GDAC shall be deemed to be all of the following for the purposes of this section:
a. With respect to criminal information, and to the extent allowed by federal law, a criminal justice agency (CJA), as defined under Criminal Justice Information Services (CJIS) Security Policy. The State CJIS Systems Agency (CSA) shall ensure that CJLEADS receives access to federal criminal information deemed to be essential in managing CJLEADS to support criminal justice professionals.
b. With respect to health information covered under the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (HIPAA), as amended, and to the extent allowed by federal law:
1. A business associate with access to protected health information acting on behalf of the State's covered entities in support of data integration, analysis, and business intelligence.
2. Authorized to access and view individually identifiable health information, provided that the access is essential to the enterprise fraud, waste, and improper payment detection program or required for future initiatives having specific definable need for the data.
c. Authorized to access all State and federal data, including revenue and labor information, deemed to be essential to the enterprise fraud, waste, and improper payment detection program or future initiatives having specific definable need for the data.
d. Authorized to develop agreements with the federal government to access data deemed to be essential to the enterprise fraud, waste, and improper payment detection program or future initiatives having specific definable need for such data.
(2) Release of information. – The following limitations apply to (i) the release of information compiled as part of the initiative, (ii) data from State agencies that is incorporated into the initiative, and (iii) data released as part of the implementation of the initiative:
a. Information compiled as part of the initiative. – Notwithstanding the provisions of Chapter 132 of the General Statutes, information compiled by the State Controller and the GDAC related to the initiative may be released as a public record only if the State Controller, in that officer's sole discretion, finds that the release of information is in the best interest of the general public and is not in violation of law or contract.
b. Data from State agencies. – Any data that is not classified as a public record under G.S. 132‑1 shall not be deemed a public record when incorporated into the data resources comprising the initiative. To maintain confidentiality requirements attached to the information provided to the State Controller and GDAC, each source agency providing data shall be the sole custodian of the data for the purpose of any request for inspection or copies of the data under Chapter 132 of the General Statutes.
c. Data released as part of implementation. – Information released to persons engaged in implementing the State's business intelligence strategy under this section that is used for purposes other than official State business is not a public record pursuant to Chapter 132 of the General Statutes.
d. Data from North Carolina Rate Bureau. – Notwithstanding any other provision of this section, any data released by or obtained from the North Carolina Rate Bureau under this initiative relating to workers' compensation insurance claims, business ratings, or premiums are not public records and public disclosure of such data, in whole or in part, by the GDAC or State Controller, or by any State agency, is prohibited."
SECTION 7.10.(e) G.S. 143B‑426.39 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(17) Coordinate data integration and data sharing pursuant to G.S. 143B‑426.38A across State agencies, departments, and institutions to support the State's enterprise‑level business intelligence initiative."
SECTION 7.10.(g) Effective July 1, 2014, the GDAC and all of its programs are hereby transferred to the Office of the SCIO. This transfer shall have all of the elements of a Type I transfer, as defined in G.S. 143A‑6. The Office of State Budget and Management shall determine the personnel, property, unexpended balances of appropriations, allocations, or other funds, including the functions of budgeting and purchasing, to be included in the transfer.
SECTION 7.10.(i) This section is effective when it becomes law.
STATE INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY DATA ARCHIVING
SECTION 7.11.(a) The State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall investigate the feasibility of creating an enterprise data archiving system for State agencies that will (i) allow for the effective management of data from multiple sources; (ii) provide for efficient, timely responses to discovery requests and investigations; and (iii) ensure real-time State agency access to and use of archived files. The system shall be financed only by savings accrued as a result of the project.
SECTION 7.11.(b) By December 1, 2013, the State CIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the results of the feasibility assessment.
SECTION 7.11.(c) Subsequent to making the report required by this section, and only if the State CIO has developed a business case that is validated by the Office of State Budget and Management, then the State CIO may initiate the development of an enterprise data archiving system.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY/PRIVACY PROTECTION OF CITIZEN DATA
SECTION 7.12. The Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology (the Committee), in collaboration with the State Chief Information Officer (CIO), shall study establishing State requirements to safeguard the personal data of individuals collected and managed by all branches of State government. The study shall be conducted with the participation and assistance of agency CIOs selected jointly by the Committee and State CIO. The Committee may report any legislative proposals to the 2014 Regular Session of the 2013 General Assembly.
STATE INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY INNOVATION CENTER
SECTION 7.13. The State Chief Information Officer (CIO) may operate a State Information Technology Innovation Center (Center) to develop and demonstrate technology solutions with potential benefit to the State and its citizens. The Center may facilitate the piloting of potential solutions to State technology requirements. In operating the Center, the State CIO shall ensure that all State laws, rules, and policies are followed. Vendor participation in the Center shall not be construed to (i) create any type of preferred status for vendors or (ii) abrogate the requirement that the State CIO ensure that agency and statewide requirements for information technology support (including those for the Office of the State CIO and the Office of Information Technology Services) are awarded based on a competitive process that follows information technology procurement guidelines. Beginning July 1, 2013, the State CIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology on a quarterly basis on initiatives being developed and implemented within the Center, as well as on the sources and amounts of resources used to support the Center.
SECTION 7.14.(a) Effective August 1, 2013, the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall oversee the development and implementation of the enterprise grants management system. The State CIO shall review progress on the implementation of the enterprise grants management system and update the plan for its development and implementation. This plan shall include an updated inventory of current agency grants management systems and a detailed process for consolidating grants management within the State, to include a time line for implementation. By October 1, 2013, the State CIO shall provide the updated plan to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.14.(b) There is established a Grants Management Oversight Committee to coordinate the development of an enterprise grants management system. The Committee shall be chaired by the State Chief Information Officer. Committee membership shall include the Director of the Office of State Budget and Management, the State Auditor, the Department of Transportation Chief Information Officer, and the State Controller. The State Auditor shall serve as a nonvoting member. The Committee shall:
(1) Establish priorities for moving agencies to the enterprise system.
(2) Establish priorities for development and implementation of system capabilities.
(3) Define system requirements.
(4) Approve plans associated with system development and implementation.
(5) Review costs and approve funding sources for system development and implementation.
(6) Ensure any system benefits are realistic and realized.
SECTION 7.14.(c) Beginning September 1, 2013, the Office of the State CIO shall report quarterly to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the status of the system, including the following information:
(1) Agencies currently participating in the system.
(2) Specific requirements for each agency project included in the system development.
(3) Cost and funding sources for each agency participating in the system.
(4) Status of each agency project included in the system.
(5) Comparison of the status of each project to the project's time line, with an explanation of any differences.
(6) Detailed descriptions of milestones completed that quarter and to be completed the next quarter.
(7) Any changes in project cost for any participating agency, the reason for the change, and the source of funding, if there is a cost increase.
(8) Actual project expenditures by agency, to date, and during that quarter.
(9) Any potential funding shortfalls, and their impact.
(10) Any issues identified during the quarter, with a corrective action plan and a time line for resolving each issue.
(11) Impact of any issues on schedule or cost.
(12) Any changes to agency projects, or the system as a whole.
(13) Any change requests and their costs.
ENTERPRISE ELECTRONIC FORMS AND DIGITAL SIGNATURES
SECTION 7.15.(a) The State's enterprise electronic forms and digital signatures project shall be transferred from the Office of the State Controller to the Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) as a Type I transfer, as defined in G.S. 143A‑6. The State CIO shall continue the planning, development, and implementation of a coordinated enterprise electronic forms and digital signatures capability, as well as the use of digital certificates. As part of the process, the Office of the State CIO shall include the capability to allow one‑time data entry for multiple applications.
SECTION 7.15.(b) The State CIO shall continue to integrate executive branch agencies developing, or identifying the need to develop, electronic forms or digital signatures projects, or both. The State CIO shall also review existing electronic forms and digital signatures capabilities and develop a plan to consolidate them. The State CIO may consolidate current agency electronic forms and digital signature capabilities, and cancel ongoing projects, and may redirect the resources associated with the capabilities and projects to the enterprise electronic forms and digital signatures project. Beginning November 1, 2013, the State CIO shall submit quarterly reports on the status of the project to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.16.(a) The Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) shall develop an implementation plan for establishing a statewide motor fleet management system. The plan shall consider consolidating individual agency and institution motor fleet management systems and include an implementation time line, a cost estimate, and a continuing funding strategy to create and operate a statewide fleet management information system to which all State agencies and institutions would be required to provide vehicle identification, utilization, and direct cost data. In formulating an implementation plan, the Office of the State Chief Information Officer shall do the following:
(1) Consult with State agencies that own vehicles.
(2) Review the existing fleet management information systems used by State agencies.
(3) Examine fleet management information systems used by other state governments.
(4) Determine whether the State should (i) expand a fleet management information system currently used by a State agency for statewide use, (ii) develop a new in‑house system, or (iii) purchase a new system from an outside vendor.
(5) Determine fees or other methods to pay the initial and ongoing costs for the system.
SECTION 7.16.(b) The Office of State Budget and Management shall assist and advise the Office of the State Chief Information Officer in developing the implementation plan and work with State agencies and institutions to identify funding from current and proposed projects and applications that could be used to support the development and implementation of the statewide motor fleet management system. The Office of State Controller shall assist and advise the Office of the State Chief Information Officer in developing the implementation plan for the statewide motor fleet management information system, including how the system interfaces with the statewide accounting system.
SECTION 7.16.(c) Beginning October 1, 2013, the State CIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the implementation plan for the statewide motor fleet management information system including progress toward the development of the enterprise system, the associated costs, identified sources of funding, and any issues associated with the project.
SECTION 7.16.(d) The State CIO shall also study the feasibility of implementing a tracking system for State vehicles, based on recommendations from the Program Evaluation Division, and report the results of the study to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Program Evaluation Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division by November 15, 2013.
SECTION 7.16.(e) Until July 1, 2015, no State or local governmental entity or officer may procure or operate an unmanned aircraft system or disclose personal information about any person acquired through the operation of an unmanned aircraft system unless the State CIO approves an exception specifically granting disclosure, use, or purchase. Any exceptions to the prohibition in this subsection shall be reported immediately to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division. The following definitions apply in this section:
(1) "Unmanned aircraft" means an aircraft that is operated without the possibility of human intervention from within or on the aircraft.
(2) "Unmanned aircraft system" means an unmanned aircraft and associated elements, including communication links and components that control the unmanned aircraft that are required for the pilot in command to operate safely and efficiently in the national airspace system.
SECTION 7.16.(f) If the State Chief Information Officer determines that there is a requirement for unmanned aircraft systems for use by State or local agencies, planning may begin for the possible development, implementation, and operation of an unmanned aircraft system program within the State of North Carolina. This planning effort shall be accomplished in coordination with the Chief Information Officer for the Department of Transportation and the DOT Aviation Division Director. If the State CIO decides to plan for an unmanned aircraft system program, a proposal for the implementation of the program shall be provided by March 1, 2014, to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Transportation Legislative Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division. At a minimum, the proposal shall include the following:
(1) Governance structure to include the appropriate use at each level of government.
(2) Guidelines for program implementation to include limitations on unmanned aircraft system use.
(3) Potential participants.
(4) Costs associated with establishing a program.
(5) Potential sources of funding.
(6) Issues associated with establishing a program to include limitations on entities that may already have purchased unmanned aircraft systems.
(7) Recommendations for legislative proposals.
TAX INFORMATION MANAGEMENT SYSTEM/ADDITIONAL PUBLIC‑PRIVATE PARTNERSHIP AUTHORIZED
SECTION 7.17.(a) Additional Public‑Private Partnership. – The Secretary of Revenue may enter into an additional public‑private arrangement in order to expand the implementation of the Tax Information Management System (TIMS). All such arrangements will terminate June 30, 2018. The public‑private arrangement may include terms necessary to implement additional revenue‑increasing or cost‑savings components if all of the following conditions are met:
(1) The funding of the project under the arrangement comes from revenue generated by or cost-savings resulting from the project.
(2) The funding of the project is dependent on increased revenue or cost‑savings streams that are different from the existing benefits stream for the implementation of TIMS.
(3) The project involves additional identified initiatives that will be integrated into the TIMS solution.
SECTION 7.17.(b) Contracts. – Work under an additional public‑private arrangement that is authorized by this section may be contracted by requests for proposals, modifications to the existing contracts, purchases using existing contracts, or other related contract vehicles.
SECTION 7.17.(c) Management/Performance Measurement. – The Secretary of Revenue shall follow the existing model for public‑private arrangement oversight and shall establish a measurement process to determine the increased revenue or cost-savings attributed to the additional public‑private arrangement authorized by this section. To accomplish this, the Secretary shall consult subject matter experts in the Department of Revenue, in other governmental units, and in the private sector, as necessary. At a minimum, the measurement process shall include all of the following:
(1) Calculation of a revenue baseline against which the increased revenue attributable to the project is measured and a cost‑basis baseline against which the cost-savings resulting from the project are measured.
(2) Periodic evaluation to determine whether the baselines need to be modified based on significant measurable changes in the economic environment.
(3) Monthly calculation of increased revenue and cost-savings attributable to contracts executed under this section.
SECTION 7.17.(d) Funding. – Of funds generated from increased revenues or cost-savings, as compared to the baselines established by subdivision (1) of subsection (c) of this section, in the General Fund, the Highway Fund, and that State portion of the Unauthorized Substance Tax collections of the Special Revenue Fund, the sum of up to a total of sixteen million dollars ($16,000,000) may be authorized by the Office of State Budget and Management to make purchases related to the implementation of the additional public‑private arrangement authorized by this section, including payments for services from non‑State entities.
SECTION 7.17.(e) Internal Costs. – For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium the Department of Revenue may retain an additional sum of eight million eight hundred seventy‑four thousand three hundred nineteen dollars ($8,874,319) from benefits generated for the General Fund since the beginning of the public‑private partnership described under Section 6A.5(a) of S.L. 2011‑145. These funds shall be used as payment of internal costs for the fiscal biennium, and such funds are hereby appropriated for this purpose.
SECTION 7.17.(f) Expert Counsel Required. – Notwithstanding G.S. 114‑2.3, the Department of Revenue shall engage the services of private counsel with the pertinent information technology and computer law expertise to negotiate and review contracts associated with an additional public‑private arrangement authorized under this section.
SECTION 7.17.(g) Oversight Committee. – The Oversight Committee established under Section 6A.5(c) of S.L. 2011‑145 shall have the same responsibilities and duties with respect to an additional public‑private arrangement authorized by this section as it does with respect to public‑private arrangements to implement TIMS and the additional Planning and Design Project (PDP) components.
SECTION 7.17.(h) Reporting. – Beginning August 1, 2013, and quarterly thereafter, the Department of Revenue shall submit detailed written reports to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Appropriations Committee, to the Chairs of the Senate Committee on Appropriations/Base Budget, to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, and to the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly. The report shall include an explanation of all of the following:
(1) Details of each public‑private contract.
(2) The benefits from each contract.
(3) A comprehensive forecast of the benefits of using public‑private agreements to implement TIMS, the additional PDP components, and additional components authorized by this section, including cost-savings and the acceleration of the project time line.
(4) Any issues associated with the operation of the public‑private partnership.
SECTION 7.17.(i) Information Technology Project Oversight. – In addition to the oversight provided by the Oversight Committee established in Section 6A.5(c) of S.L. 2011‑145, the additional public‑private arrangement authorized by this section shall be subject to existing State information technology project oversight laws and statutes, and the project management shall comply with all statutory requirements and other criteria established by the State Chief Information Officer and the Office of State Budget and Management for information technology projects. The State Chief Information Officer and the Office of State Budget and Management shall immediately report any failure to do so to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Committees on Appropriations, and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.17.(j) Section 6A.5(c) of S.L. 2011‑145, as amended by Section 6A.3(j) of S.L. 2012‑142, reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 6A.5.(c) There is established within the Department of Revenue the Oversight Committee for reviewing and approving the benefits measurement methodology and calculation process. The Oversight Committee shall review and approve in writing all contracts, including change orders, amendments to contracts, and addendums to contracts, before they are executed under this section. This shall include (i) details of each public‑private contract, (ii) the benefits from each contract, and (iii) a comprehensive forecast of the benefits of using public‑private agreements to implement TIMS and the additional PDP components, including the measurement process established for the Secretary of Revenue. The Oversight Committee shall approve all of the fund transfers for this project. Within five days of entering into a contract, the Department shall provide copies of each contract and all associated information to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Committees on Appropriations, and the Fiscal Research Division.
The members of the Committee shall include the following:
(1) The State Budget
Director;Director of the Office of State Budget and Management;
(2) The Secretary of the Department of Revenue;
(3) The State Chief Information Officer;
(4) Two persons appointed by the Governor;
(5) One member of the general public having expertise in information technology appointed by the General Assembly upon the recommendation of the Speaker of the House of Representatives; and
(6) One member of the general public having expertise in economic and revenue forecasting appointed by the General Assembly upon recommendation of the President Pro Tempore of the Senate.
The State Budget Director shall serve as chair of the Committee. The Committee shall set its meeting schedule and adopt its rules of operation by majority vote. A majority of the members constitutes a quorum. Vacancies shall be filled by the appointing authority. Administrative support staff shall be provided by the Department of Revenue. Members of the Committee shall receive reimbursements for subsistence and travel expenses as provided by Chapter 138 of the General Statutes. The Committee shall terminate on June 30, 2018.
The Department shall provide copies of the minutes of each meeting and all associated information to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Chairs of the House of Representatives Appropriations Committee, the Chairs of the Senate Committee on Appropriations/Base Budget, and the Fiscal Research Division."
USE OF MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS DEVICES
SECTION 7.18.(a) By October 1, 2013, every State agency shall submit to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division a copy of the agency policy on the use of mobile communications devices. This reporting requirement is continuous such that any time a change is made to an existing policy, the agency shall submit an update immediately.
SECTION 7.18.(b) Beginning October 1, 2013, each State agency shall submit a quarterly report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Office of the State Chief Information Officer (CIO) on the use of mobile electronic communications devices within the agency. The report shall include the following information:
(1) The total number of devices issued by the agency.
(2) The total cost of mobile devices issued by the agency.
(3) The number and cost of new devices issued since the last report.
(4) The contracts used to obtain the devices.
SECTION 7.18.(c) The Office of the State Chief Information Officer shall review current enterprise, and any individual agency mobile electronic communications contracts, to develop a plan to consolidate the contracts. By October 1, 2013, the Office of the State CIO shall submit a report on progress toward consolidating State agency mobile communications device contracts to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 7.18.(d) The Office of the State CIO shall develop a policy for implementing a "bring your own device" plan for State employees. By September 1, 2013, the State CIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on how the plan is to be implemented, as well as on potential issues and costs. Following consultation with the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the State CIO may implement the "bring your own device" plan.
NEXT GENERATION SECURE DRIVER LICENSE SYSTEM
SECTION 7.19.(a) By August 1, 2013, the Chief Information Officer of the Department of Transportation shall provide a detailed report on the status of the Next Generation Secure Driver License System (NGSDLS) to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Transportation Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division. At a minimum, the report on the NGSDLS shall include the following information:
(1) Original project scope, deliverables, and milestones, including descriptions of any subsequent modifications and basis for each.
(2) Contractual status and amendments.
(3) Initial and current estimated costs for system development, implementation, and maintenance.
(4) Remaining deliverables and cost to complete by phase.
(5) Any issues, including vendor performance, identified during project development and implementation and planned corrective actions for each issue.
(6) Programmatic impacts for Division of Motor Vehicles driver license services.
(7) Requirements and costs to implement a process to allow persons who are homebound to apply for or renew a special photo identification card, with a color photo, and similar in size, shape, design, and background to a drivers license, by means other than personal appearance.
SECTION 7.19.(b) In the event of any changes in the NGSDLS project status occurring after submission of the report required by subsection (a) of this section, the Chief Information Officer of the Department of Transportation shall ensure that the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Transportation Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division are notified immediately of the changes.
STATE TITLING AND REGISTRATION SYSTEM/STATE AUTOMATED DRIVER LICENSE SYSTEM/LIABILITY INSURANCE TRACKING AND ENFORCEMENT SYSTEM
SECTION 7.20.(a) The Chief Information Officer of the Department of Transportation shall continue the replacement of the State Titling and Registration System (STARS), the State Automated Driver License System (SADLS), and the Liability Insurance Tracking and Enforcement System (LITES).
SECTION 7.20.(b) By August 1, 2013, and quarterly thereafter, the Chief Information Officer of the Department of Transportation shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Transportation Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division on the status of each of the projects listed in subsection (a) of this section. At a minimum, the report shall include the following information for each project:
(1) Project scope, milestones, and anticipated business process improvements.
(2) Estimated development, implementation, and maintenance costs.
(3) Project status, including any modifications to the project scope or revisions to baseline cost estimates.
(4) Project accomplishments and changes in status for the previous quarter.
(5) Actual costs incurred, by purpose and funding source, for the previous quarter.
(6) Remaining cost to complete by project phase for the next two fiscal years.
(7) Any issues, including vendor performance, identified during project development and implementation and planned corrective actions.
GDAC/LOCAL GOVERNMENTS/OPTIONAL COLLECTION AGREEMENTS
SECTION 7.21.(a) A city or county may enter into an interagency agreement with the Department of Revenue and the Government Data Analytics Center (GDAC) to manage the collection of outstanding unpaid parking fines and penalties. The scope and manner of such collections services shall be determined by the agreement. A county or city that exercises the option to enter into such an arrangement may agree to the following, which are required terms in the agreement with the Department of Revenue and the GDAC:
(1) That the city or county agrees to:
a. Comply with State and federal law regarding data sharing, as appropriate.
b. Provide for technical and business resources to support the analytics development.
c. Provide for timely and responsive access to complete and accurate data, business rules, policies, and technical support.
(2) That the GDAC be given access to all required information necessary to develop and support analytics allowing the identification of the owners of vehicles with associated unpaid parking fines and penalties.
SECTION 7.21.(b) In carrying out the purposes of this section and the agreements made under its provisions, the State Controller and the GDAC shall:
(1) Ensure the security, integrity, and privacy of the data in accordance with State and federal law and as may be required by contract.
(2) Leverage enterprise data sources, as allowed by State and federal law, and GDAC governance agreements, to provide analytics to integrate and match data to identify owner information associated with vehicles with unpaid parking fines and penalties.
(3) Provide access to analytics reporting and information to the participating city or municipality and the Department of Revenue.
(4) Provide data to the Department of Revenue for use in the withholding of tax refunds of persons that have unpaid parking fines and penalties.
SECTION 7.21.(c) The Department of Transportation, Division of Motor Vehicles, shall provide the GDAC with access to historical and current information required to identify owners associated with vehicles with unpaid parking fines and penalties.
SECTION 7.21.(d) The Department of Revenue shall (i) receive data from the GDAC associated with persons that have unpaid parking fines and penalties; (ii) withhold tax refunds for the purpose of the collection of those fines and penalties as allowed by law; and (iii) from the withholdings, pay to the appropriate city or county the amounts due.
SECTION 7.21.(e) Any fee imposed by the Department of Revenue or the GDAC to cover the administrative costs of withholding for the collection of unpaid parking fines and penalties shall be borne by the city or county and shall be negotiated as part of the agreements authorized by this section.
SECTION 7.22. The State Chief Information Officer (SCIO) shall develop a plan to implement an electronic portal that makes obtaining information, conducting online transactions, and communicating with State agencies more convenient for members of the public. The SCIO shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology on the details of the plan prior to implementation. The plan shall contain all of the following:
(1) A detailed description for development and implementation of the portal, to include a list of anticipated applications to be implemented during the State fiscal years of 2013‑2017.
(2) A description of how the portal will be implemented, including the use of outside vendors, detailed information on vendor participation, and potential costs.
(3) Detailed information on the anticipated total cost of ownership of the portal and any applications proposed for implementation during the State fiscal years of 2013‑2017, including the amount of any payments to be made to any vendors supporting the project for each application and the portal as a whole.
(4) A funding model that limits the costs to the State.
(5) If outsourced, a detailed, fully executable plan to return portal operations to the State, with associated costs and a detailed analysis that demonstrates that it is more cost‑effective to use a vendor than to develop an application internally.
(6) A provision requiring that any fees to support the operation of the portal must be authorized by the General Assembly.
PART VIII. PUBLIC SCHOOLS
FUNDS FOR CHILDREN WITH DISABILITIES
SECTION 8.1. The State Board of Education shall allocate additional funds for children with disabilities on the basis of three thousand seven hundred forty‑three dollars and forty‑eight cents ($3,743.48) per child. Each local school administrative unit shall receive funds for the lesser of (i) all children who are identified as children with disabilities or (ii) twelve and one‑half percent (12.5%) of its 2013‑2014 allocated average daily membership in the local school administrative unit. The dollar amounts allocated under this section for children with disabilities shall also adjust in accordance with legislative salary increments, retirement rate adjustments, and health benefit adjustments for personnel who serve children with disabilities.
FUNDS FOR ACADEMICALLY GIFTED CHILDREN
SECTION 8.2. The State Board of Education shall allocate additional funds for academically or intellectually gifted children on the basis of one thousand two hundred thirty‑three dollars and one cent ($1,233.01) per child for fiscal year 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015. A local school administrative unit shall receive funds for a maximum of four percent (4%) of its 2013‑2014 allocated average daily membership, regardless of the number of children identified as academically or intellectually gifted in the unit. The dollar amounts allocated under this section for academically or intellectually gifted children shall also adjust in accordance with legislative salary increments, retirement rate adjustments, and health benefit adjustments for personnel who serve academically or intellectually gifted children.
USE OF SUPPLEMENTAL FUNDING IN LOW‑WEALTH COUNTIES
SECTION 8.3.(a) Use of Funds for Supplemental Funding. – All funds received pursuant to this section shall be used only (i) to provide instructional positions, instructional support positions, teacher assistant positions, clerical positions, school computer technicians, instructional supplies and equipment, staff development, and textbooks and (ii) for salary supplements for instructional personnel and instructional support personnel. Local boards of education are encouraged to use at least twenty‑five percent (25%) of the funds received pursuant to this section to improve the academic performance of children who are performing at Level I or II on either reading or mathematics end‑of‑grade tests in grades three through eight.
SECTION 8.3.(b) Definitions. – As used in this section, the following definitions apply:
(1) "Anticipated county property tax revenue availability" means the county‑adjusted property tax base multiplied by the effective State average tax rate.
(2) "Anticipated total county revenue availability" means the sum of the following:
a. Anticipated county property tax revenue availability.
b. Local sales and use taxes received by the county that are levied under Chapter 1096 of the 1967 Session Laws or under Subchapter VIII of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes.
c. Sales tax hold harmless reimbursement received by the county under G.S. 105‑521.
d. Fines and forfeitures deposited in the county school fund for the most recent year for which data are available.
(3) "Anticipated total county revenue availability per student" means the anticipated total county revenue availability for the county divided by the average daily membership of the county.
(4) "Anticipated State average revenue availability per student" means the sum of all anticipated total county revenue availability divided by the average daily membership for the State.
(5) "Average daily membership" means average daily membership as defined in the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual, adopted by the State Board of Education. If a county contains only part of a local school administrative unit, the average daily membership of that county includes all students who reside within the county and attend that local school administrative unit.
(6) "County‑adjusted property tax base" shall be computed as follows:
a. Subtract the present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland in the county, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2, from the total assessed real property valuation of the county.
b. Adjust the resulting amount by multiplying by a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies.
c. Add to the resulting amount the following:
1. Present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2.
2. Value of property of public service companies, determined in accordance with Article 23 of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes.
3. Personal property value for the county.
(7) "County‑adjusted property tax base per square mile" means the county‑adjusted property tax base divided by the number of square miles of land area in the county.
(8) "County wealth as a percentage of State average wealth" shall be computed as follows:
a. Compute the percentage that the county per capita income is of the State per capita income and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of five‑tenths.
b. Compute the percentage that the anticipated total county revenue availability per student is of the anticipated State average revenue availability per student and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of four‑tenths.
c. Compute the percentage that the county‑adjusted property tax base per square mile is of the State‑adjusted property tax base per square mile and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of one‑tenth.
d. Add the three weighted percentages to derive the county wealth as a percentage of the State average wealth.
(9) "Effective county tax rate" means the actual county tax rate multiplied by a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies.
(10) "Effective State average tax rate" means the average of effective county tax rates for all counties.
(11) "Local current expense funds" means the most recent county current expense appropriations to public schools, as reported by local boards of education in the audit report filed with the Secretary of the Local Government Commission pursuant to G.S. 115C‑447.
(12) "Per capita income" means the average for the most recent three years for which data are available of the per capita income according to the most recent report of the United States Department of Commerce, Bureau of Economic Analysis, including any reported modifications for prior years as outlined in the most recent report.
(13) "Sales assessment ratio studies" means sales assessment ratio studies performed by the Department of Revenue under G.S. 105‑289(h).
(14) "State average current expense appropriations per student" means the most recent State total of county current expense appropriations to public schools, as reported by local boards of education in the audit report filed with the Secretary of the Local Government Commission pursuant to G.S. 115C‑447.
(15) "State average adjusted property tax base per square mile" means the sum of the county‑adjusted property tax bases for all counties divided by the number of square miles of land area in the State.
(16) "Supplant" means to decrease local per student current expense appropriations from one fiscal year to the next fiscal year.
(17) "Weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies" means the weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies in the most recent years for which county current expense appropriations and adjusted property tax valuations are available. If real property in a county has been revalued one year prior to the most recent sales assessment ratio study, a weighted average of the two most recent sales assessment ratios shall be used. If property has been revalued the year of the most recent sales assessment ratio study, the sales assessment ratio for the year of revaluation shall be used.
SECTION 8.3.(c) Eligibility for Funds. – Except as provided in subsection (g) of this section, the State Board of Education shall allocate these funds to local school administrative units located in whole or in part in counties in which the county wealth as a percentage of the State average wealth is less than one hundred percent (100%).
SECTION 8.3.(d) Allocation of Funds. – Except as provided in subsection (f) of this section, the amount received per average daily membership for a county shall be the difference between the State average current expense appropriations per student and the current expense appropriations per student that the county could provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools. (To derive the current expense appropriations per student that the county could be able to provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools, multiply the county's wealth as a percentage of State average wealth by the State average current expense appropriations per student.) The funds for the local school administrative units located in whole or in part in the county shall be allocated to each local school administrative unit located in whole or in part in the county based on the average daily membership of the county's students in the school units. If the funds appropriated for supplemental funding are not adequate to fund the formula fully, each local school administrative unit shall receive a pro rata share of the funds appropriated for supplemental funding.
SECTION 8.3.(e) Formula for Distribution of Supplemental Funding Pursuant to This Section Only. – The formula in this section is solely a basis for distribution of supplemental funding for low‑wealth counties and is not intended to reflect any measure of the adequacy of the educational program or funding for public schools. The formula is also not intended to reflect any commitment by the General Assembly to appropriate any additional supplemental funds for low‑wealth counties.
SECTION 8.3.(f) Minimum Effort Required. – A county that (i) maintains an effective county tax rate that is at least one hundred percent (100%) of the effective State average tax rate in the most recent year for which data are available or (ii) maintains a county appropriation per student to the school local current expense fund of at least one hundred percent (100%) of the current expense appropriations per student to the school local current expense fund that the county could provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools shall receive full funding under this section. A county that maintains a county appropriation per student to the school local current expense fund of less than one hundred percent (100%) of the current expense appropriations per student to the school local current expense fund that the county could provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools shall receive funding under this section at the same percentage that the county's appropriation per student to the school local current expense fund is of the current expense appropriations per student to the school local current expense fund that the county could provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools.
SECTION 8.3.(g) Nonsupplant Requirement. – A county in which a local school administrative unit receives funds under this section shall use the funds to supplement local current expense funds and shall not supplant local current expense funds. For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall not allocate funds under this section to a county found to have used these funds to supplant local per student current expense funds. The State Board of Education shall make a finding that a county has used these funds to supplant local current expense funds in the prior year, or the year for which the most recent data are available, if all of the following criteria apply:
(1) The current expense appropriation per student of the county for the current year is less than ninety‑five percent (95%) of the average of local expenditures per student for the three prior fiscal years.
(2) The county cannot show (i) that it has remedied the deficiency in funding or (ii) that extraordinary circumstances caused the county to supplant local current expense funds with funds allocated under this section.
The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to implement the requirements of this subsection.
SECTION 8.3.(h) Counties Containing a Base of the Armed Forces. – Notwithstanding any other provision of this section, for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, counties containing a base of the Armed Forces of the United States that have an average daily membership of more than 23,000 students shall receive the same amount of supplemental funding for low-wealth counties as received in the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.
SECTION 8.3.(i) Funds for EVAAS Data. – Notwithstanding the requirements of subsection (a) of this section, local school administrative units may utilize funds allocated under this section to purchase services that allow for extraction of data from the Education Value‑Added Assessment System (EVAAS).
SECTION 8.3.(j) Reports. – For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall report to the Fiscal Research Division prior to May 1 of each year if it determines that counties have supplanted funds.
SECTION 8.3.(k) Department of Revenue Reports. – The Department of Revenue shall provide to the Department of Public Instruction a preliminary report for the current fiscal year of the assessed value of the property tax base for each county prior to March 1 of each year and a final report prior to May 1 of each year. The reports shall include for each county the annual sales assessment ratio and the taxable values of (i) total real property, (ii) the portion of total real property represented by the present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2, (iii) property of public service companies determined in accordance with Article 23 of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes, and (iv) personal property.
SMALL SCHOOL SYSTEM SUPPLEMENTAL FUNDING
SECTION 8.4.(a) Funds for Small School Systems for the 2013-2014 Fiscal Year. – Except as provided in subsection (g) of this section, the State Board of Education shall allocate funds appropriated for small school system supplemental funding for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year (i) to each county school administrative unit with an average daily membership of fewer than 3,175 students and (ii) to each county school administrative unit with an average daily membership from 3,175 to 4,000 students if the county in which the local school administrative unit is located has a county‑adjusted property tax base per student that is below the State‑adjusted property tax base per student and if the total average daily membership of all local school administrative units located within the county is from 3,239 to 4,080 students. The allocation formula shall do all of the following:
(1) Round all fractions of positions to the next whole position.
(2) Provide five and one‑half additional regular classroom teachers in counties in which the average daily membership per square mile is greater than four and provide seven additional regular classroom teachers in counties in which the average daily membership per square mile is four or fewer.
(3) Provide additional program enhancement teachers adequate to offer the standard course of study.
(4) Change the duty‑free period allocation to one teacher assistant per 400 average daily membership.
(5) Provide a base for the consolidated funds allotment of at least seven hundred seventeen thousand three hundred sixty dollars ($717,360), excluding textbooks, for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year.
(6) Allot vocational education funds for grade six as well as for grades seven through 12. If funds appropriated for each fiscal year for small school system supplemental funding are not adequate to fully fund the program, the State Board of Education shall reduce the amount allocated to each county school administrative unit on a pro rata basis. This formula is solely a basis for distribution of supplemental funding for certain county school administrative units and is not intended to reflect any measure of the adequacy of the educational program or funding for public schools. The formula also is not intended to reflect any commitment by the General Assembly to appropriate any additional supplemental funds for such county administrative units.
SECTION 8.4.(b) Phase‑Out Provisions for the 2013-2014 Fiscal Year. – If a local school administrative unit becomes ineligible for funding under the formula in subsection (a) of this section in the 2013-2014 fiscal year because of (i) an increase in the population of the county in which the local school administrative unit is located or (ii) an increase in the county‑adjusted property tax base per student of the county in which the local school administrative unit is located, funding for that unit shall be continued for the 2013-2014 fiscal year.
SECTION 8.4.(c) Eligibility for Funds for Small School Systems for the 2014‑2015 Fiscal Year. – For the 2014-2015 fiscal year, if the total average daily membership of all local school administrative units located in the county is less than 3,200, the county school administrative unit within that county shall be eligible for small school system supplemental funding.
(1) A per student funding factor, equal to the product of the following:
a. One, minus the local school administrative unit's average daily membership divided by the maximum small school system average daily membership.
b. The maximum small school system dollars per student.
(2) The average daily membership of the eligible county school administrative unit.
SECTION 8.4.(e) Phase‑Out Provisions for the 2014-2015 Fiscal Year. – If a local school administrative unit becomes ineligible for funding under the formula in subsection (d) of this section in the 2014-2015 fiscal year, funding for that unit shall be phased out over a five‑year period. Funding for such local administrative units shall be reduced in equal increments in each of the five years after the local administrative unit becomes ineligible. Funding shall be eliminated in the fifth fiscal year after the local administrative unit becomes ineligible.
Allotments for eligible local school administrative units shall not be reduced by more than twenty percent (20%) of the amount received in fiscal year 2013‑2014 in any fiscal year.
SECTION 8.4.(f) Maximum Allotments for the 2014-2015 Fiscal Year. – For the 2014‑2015 fiscal year, the maximum small school system dollars per student shall be two thousand ninety‑four dollars ($2,094).
SECTION 8.4.(g) Nonsupplant Requirement for the 2013-2015 Fiscal Biennium. – A county in which a local school administrative unit receives funds under this section shall use the funds to supplement local current expense funds and shall not supplant local current expense funds. For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall not allocate funds under this section to a county found to have used these funds to supplant local per student current expense funds. The State Board of Education shall make a finding that a county has used these funds to supplant local current expense funds in the prior year, or the year for which the most recent data are available, if all of the following criteria apply:
(1) The current expense appropriation per student of the county for the current year is less than ninety‑five percent (95%) of the average of local expenditures per student for the three prior fiscal years.
(2) The county cannot show (i) that it has remedied the deficiency in funding or (ii) that extraordinary circumstances caused the county to supplant local current expense funds with funds allocated under this section.
The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to implement the requirements of this subsection.
SECTION 8.4.(h) Definitions. – As used in this section, the following definitions apply for the 2013-2014 fiscal year:
(1) "Average daily membership" means within two percent (2%) of the average daily membership as defined in the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual adopted by the State Board of Education.
(2) "County‑adjusted property tax base per student" means the total assessed property valuation for each county, adjusted using a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies, divided by the total number of students in average daily membership who reside within the county.
(3) "Sales assessment ratio studies" means sales assessment ratio studies performed by the Department of Revenue under G.S. 105‑289(h).
(4) "State‑adjusted property tax base per student" means the sum of all county‑adjusted property tax bases divided by the total number of students in average daily membership who reside within the State.
(5) "Weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies" means the weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies in the most recent years for which county current expense appropriations and adjusted property tax valuations are available. If real property in a county has been revalued one year prior to the most recent sales assessment ratio study, a weighted average of the two most recent sales assessment ratios shall be used. If property has been revalued during the year of the most recent sales assessment ratio study, the sales assessment ratio for the year of revaluation shall be used.
SECTION 8.4.(i) Reports. – For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall report to the Fiscal Research Division prior to May 1 of each fiscal year if it determines that counties have supplanted funds.
SECTION 8.4.(j) Use of Funds. – Local boards of education are encouraged to use at least twenty percent (20%) of the funds they receive pursuant to this section to improve the academic performance of children who are performing at Level I or II on either reading or mathematics end‑of‑grade tests in grades three through eight.
DISADVANTAGED STUDENT SUPPLEMENTAL FUNDING (DSSF)
SECTION 8.5.(a) Funds appropriated for disadvantaged student supplemental funding shall be used, consistent with the policies and procedures adopted by the State Board of Education, only to:
(1) Provide instructional positions or instructional support positions and/or professional development;
(2) Provide intensive in‑school and/or after‑school remediation;
(3) Purchase diagnostic software and progress‑monitoring tools; and
(4) Provide funds for teacher bonuses and supplements. The State Board of Education shall set a maximum percentage of the funds that may be used for this purpose.
The State Board of Education may require local school administrative units receiving funding under the Disadvantaged Student Supplemental Fund to purchase the Education Value‑Added Assessment System (EVAAS) in order to provide in‑depth analysis of student performance and help identify strategies for improving student achievement. This data shall be used exclusively for instructional and curriculum decisions made in the best interest of children and for professional development for their teachers and administrators.
SECTION 8.5.(b) Funds appropriated to a local school administrative unit for disadvantaged student supplemental funding (DSSF) shall be allotted based on (i) the unit's eligible DSSF population and (ii) the difference between a teacher‑to‑student ratio of 1:21 and the following teacher‑to‑student ratios:
(1) For counties with wealth greater than ninety percent (90%) of the statewide average, a ratio of 1:19.9.
(2) For counties with wealth not less than eighty percent (80%) and not greater than ninety percent (90%) of the statewide average, a ratio of 1:19.4.
(3) For counties with wealth less than eighty percent (80%) of the statewide average, a ratio of 1:19.1.
(4) For local school administrative units receiving DSSF funds in fiscal year 2005‑2006, a ratio of 1:16. These local school administrative units shall receive no less than the DSSF amount allotted in fiscal year 2006‑2007.
For the purpose of this subsection, wealth shall be calculated under the low‑wealth supplemental formula as provided for in this act.
SECTION 8.5.(c) If a local school administrative unit's wealth increases to a level that adversely affects the unit's disadvantaged student supplemental funding (DSSF) allotment ratio, the DSSF allotment for that unit shall be maintained at the prior year level for one additional fiscal year.
BUDGET REDUCTIONS/DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC INSTRUCTION
SECTION 8.6. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, the Department of Public Instruction may, after consultation with the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division, reorganize, if necessary, to implement the budget reductions set out in this act. Consultation shall occur prior to requesting budgetary and personnel changes through the budget revision process. The Department shall provide a current organization chart in the consultation process and shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on any reorganization.
SECTION 8.7. The State Board of Education may expend up to five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000) each year for the 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 fiscal years from unexpended funds for licensed employees' salaries to pay expenses related to litigation.
UNIFORM EDUCATION REPORTING SYSTEM (UERS) FUNDS
SECTION 8.8.(a) Funds appropriated for the Uniform Education Reporting System (UERS) shall not revert at the end of the 2012‑2013 fiscal year. Funds appropriated for UERS for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium shall not revert at the end of each fiscal year but shall remain available until expended.
SECTION 8.8.(b) This section becomes effective June 30, 2013.
REVISE NC VIRTUAL PUBLIC SCHOOLS (NCVPS) COST CALCULATION DATE
SECTION 8.9.(a) Section 7.22(d)(6) of S.L. 2011‑145 is repealed.
SECTION 8.9.(b) In implementing the allotment formula for the North Carolina Virtual Public Schools (NCVPS) program, the State Board of Education shall calculate, no later than February 28 of each year, the actual instructional cost for each local school administrative unit and charter school based upon actual NCVPS enrollment as of that date.
NC CENTER FOR THE ADVANCEMENT OF TEACHING
SECTION 8.10. It is the intent of the General Assembly to systematically review the North Carolina Center for the Advancement of Teaching (NCCAT). This review is intended to assist the General Assembly in determining whether to continue, reduce, or eliminate funding for the program. NCCAT shall report the following information to the Fiscal Research Division no later than February 1, 2014:
(1) A description of the program's mission, goals, and objectives.
(2) An examination of the program's governance structure and an assessment of whether the existing governance structure adequately supports the program's mission, goals, and objectives.
(3) The extent to which NCCAT's fund, agency, division, and program objectives complement General Assembly policies in the areas of digital learning and early grades literacy.
(4) Performance measures for determining whether the program is meeting its mission, goals, and objectives.
(5) Recommendations for statutory, budgetary, or administrative changes needed to improve the efficiency and effectiveness of the program.
SECTION 8.11.(a) G.S. 115C‑249 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑249. Purchase and maintenance of school buses, materials and supplies.
(a) To the extent that the funds shall be made available to it for such purpose, a local board of education is authorized to purchase from time to time such additional school buses and service vehicles or replacements for school buses and service vehicles, as may be deemed by such board to be necessary for the safe and efficient transportation of pupils enrolled in the schools within such local school administrative unit. Any school bus so purchased shall be constructed and equipped as prescribed by the provisions of this Article and by the regulations of the State Board of Education issued pursuant thereto. Any school bus so purchased that is capable of operating on diesel fuel shall be capable of operating on diesel fuel with a minimum biodiesel concentration of B‑20, as defined in G.S. 143‑58.4. At least two percent (2%) of the total volume of fuel purchased annually by local school districts statewide for use in school bus diesel engine motor vehicles shall be biodiesel fuel of a minimum blend of B‑20, to the extent that biodiesel blend is available and compatible with the technology of the vehicles or equipment used.
(b) The tax‑levying authorities of any county are hereby authorized to make provision from time to time in the capital outlay budget of the county for the purchase of such school buses or service vehicles.
(c) Any funds appropriated from time to time by the General Assembly for the purchase of school buses or service vehicles shall be allocated by the State Board of Education to the respective local boards of education in accordance with the requirements of such boards as determined by the State Board of Education, and thereupon shall be paid over to the respective local boards of education in accordance with such allocation.
(c1) In determining which school buses in the statewide fleet are to be replaced with State funds in a given year, the State Board of Education shall give highest priority to safety concerns.
A bus is eligible for replacement with State funds based on its age and mileage when it is either 20 years old by model year or has been operated for 250,000 miles, except as follows:
(1) A bus that has been operated for less than 150,000 miles is not eligible for replacement regardless of its model year.
(2) A bus that is less than 15 years old by model year is not eligible for replacement until the bus has been operated for 300,000 miles.
(c2) The State Board of Education may authorize the replacement of up to 30 buses each year due to safety concerns regarding the bus or mechanical or structural problems that would place an undue burden on a local school administrative unit.
(c3) A local school administrative unit shall receive an incentive payment of two thousand dollars ($2,000) at the beginning of each school year for each bus that it continues to operate although the bus is eligible for replacement, until the bus is 23 years old by model year. The local school administrative unit may use these bonus funds for the additional maintenance costs of operating buses with higher mileage or for any other school purpose.
(d) The title to any additional or replacement school bus or service vehicle purchased pursuant to the provisions of this section, shall be taken in the name of the board of education of such local school administrative unit, and such bus shall in all respects be maintained and operated pursuant to the provisions of this Article in the same manner as any other public school bus.
(e) It shall be the duty of the county board of education to provide adequate buildings and equipment for the storage and maintenance of all school buses and service vehicles owned or operated by the board of education of any local school administrative unit in such county. It shall be the duty of the tax‑levying authorities of such county to provide in its capital outlay budget for the construction or acquisition of such buildings and equipment as may be required for this purpose.
(f) In the event of the damage or destruction of any school bus or service vehicle by fire, collision, or otherwise, the board of education of the local school administrative unit which shall own or operate such bus or service vehicle may apply to the State Board of Education for funds with which to replace it. If the State Board of Education finds that such bus or service vehicle has been destroyed or damaged to the extent that it cannot be made suitable for further use, and if the State Board of Education finds that the replacement of such bus or service vehicle is necessary in order to enable such local school administrative unit to operate properly its school bus transportation system, the State Board of Education shall allot to the board of education of such local school administrative unit from the funds now held by the State Board of Education for the replacement of school buses or service vehicles, or from funds hereafter appropriated by the General Assembly for that purpose, a sum sufficient to purchase a new school bus or service vehicle to be used as a replacement for such damaged or destroyed bus or service vehicle and upon such allocation such sum shall be paid over to or for the account of the board of education of such local school administrative unit for such purpose.
(g) Repealed by Session Laws 2003‑147, s. 3, effective for a local school administrative unit when the unit is certified as being E‑Procurement compliant, or April 1, 2004, whichever occurs first.
(h) Appropriations by the General Assembly for the purchase of public school buses shall not revert to the General Fund. Any unexpended portion of those appropriations shall at the end of each fiscal year be transferred to a reserve account and be held, together with any other funds appropriated for the purpose, for the purchase of public school buses."
SECTION 8.11.(b) For the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium only, State funds shall be used, at the request of the local school administrative unit, to replace (i) all buses that are 20 years old by model year and (ii) all other buses eligible for replacement under G.S. 115C‑249, as rewritten by subsection (a) of this section.
EVAAS SCHOOL PERFORMANCE GRADES
SECTION 8.13. The State Board of Education shall not be subject to the requirements of Section 7.7(c) of this act for the development of school performance scores and grades in accordance with G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1.
SECTION 8.14. G.S. 115C‑105.25 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑105.25. Budget flexibility.
(a) Consistent with improving student performance, a local board shall provide maximum flexibility to schools in the use of funds to enable the schools to accomplish their goals.
(b) Subject to the following limitations, local boards of education may transfer and may approve transfers of funds between funding allotment categories:
(1) In accordance
with a school improvement plan accepted under G.S. 115C‑105.27,
State funds allocated for teacher assistants may be transferred only for
personnel (i) to serve students only in kindergarten through third grade, or
(ii) to serve students primarily in kindergarten through third grade when the
personnel are assigned to an elementary school to serve the whole school. Funds
allocated for teacher assistants may be transferred to reduce class size or to
reduce the student‑teacher ratio in kindergarten through third grade so
long as the affected teacher assistant positions are not filled when the plan
is amended or approved by the building‑level staff entitled to vote on
the plan or the affected teacher assistant positions are not expected to be
filled on the date the plan is to be implemented. Any State funds appropriated
for teacher assistants that were converted to certificated teachers before July
1, 1995, in accordance with Section 1 of Chapter 986 of the 1991 Session Laws,
as rewritten by Chapter 103 of the 1993 Session Laws, may continue to be used
for certificated teachers.
(1a) Funds for children with disabilities, career and technical education, and other purposes may be transferred only as permitted by federal law and the conditions of federal grants or as provided through any rules that the State Board of Education adopts to ensure compliance with federal regulations.
(2) In accordance
with a school improvement plan accepted under G.S. 115C‑105.27, (i)
State funds allocated for classroom materials/instructional supplies/equipment
may be transferred only for the purchase of textbooks; (ii) State funds
allocated for textbooks may be transferred only for the purchase of
instructional supplies, instructional equipment, or other classroom materials;
and (iii) State funds allocated for noninstructional support personnel may be
transferred only for teacher positions.
(2a) Up to three
percent (3%) of State funds allocated for noninstructional support personnel
may be transferred for staff development.
(3) No funds shall be transferred into the central office administration allotment category.
(4) Funds
allocated for children with disabilities, for students with limited English
proficiency, and for driver's education shall not be transferred.
(5) Funds
allocated for classroom teachers may be transferred only for teachers of
exceptional children, for teachers of at‑risk students, and for
authorized purposes under the textbooks allotment category and the classroom
materials/instructional supplies/equipment allotment category.
(5a) Positions allocated for classroom teachers may be converted to dollar equivalents to contract for visiting international exchange teachers. These positions shall be converted at the statewide average salary for classroom teachers, including benefits. The converted funds shall be used only to cover the costs associated with bringing visiting international exchange teachers to the local school administrative unit through a State‑approved visiting international exchange teacher program and supporting the visiting exchange teachers.
(5b) Except as provided in subdivision (5a) of this subsection, positions allocated for classroom teachers and instructional support personnel may be converted to dollar equivalents for any purpose authorized by the policies of the State Board of Education. These positions shall be converted at the salary on the first step of the "A" Teachers Salary Schedule. Certified position allotments shall not be transferred to dollars to hire the same type of position.
(5c) Funds allocated for school building administration may be converted for any purpose authorized by the policies of the State Board of Education. For funds related to principal positions, the salary transferred shall be based on the first step of the Principal III Salary Schedule. For funds related to assistant principal months of employment, the salary transferred shall be based on the first step of the Assistant Principal Salary Schedule. Certified position allotments shall not be transferred to dollars to hire the same type of position.
(6) Funds
allocated for vocational education may be transferred only in accordance with
any rules that the State Board of Education considers appropriate to ensure compliance
with federal regulations.
(7) Funds
allocated for career development shall be used in accordance with Section 17.3
of Chapter 324 of the 1995 Session Laws.
(8) Funds
allocated for academically or intellectually gifted students may be used only
(i) for academically or intellectually gifted students; (ii) to implement the
plan developed under G.S. 115C‑150.7; or (iii) in accordance with an
accepted school improvement plan, for any purpose so long as that school
demonstrates it is providing appropriate services to academically or
intellectually gifted students assigned to that school in accordance with the
local plan developed under G.S. 115C‑150.7.
(9) Funds
allocated in the Alternative Schools/At‑Risk Student allotment shall be
spent only for alternative learning programs, at‑risk students, and
school safety programs.
(10) Funds to carry out the elements of the Excellent Public Schools Act that are contained in Section 7A.1 of S.L. 2012‑142 shall not be transferred.
(c) To ensure that parents, educators, and the general public are informed on how State funds have been used to address local educational priorities, each local school administrative unit shall publish the following information on its Web site by October 15 of each year:
(1) A description of each program report code, written in plain English, and a summary of the prior fiscal year's expenditure of State funds within each program report code.
(2) A description of each object code within a program report code, written in plain English, and a summary of the prior fiscal year's expenditure of State funds for each object code.
(3) A description of each allotment transfer that increased or decreased the initial allotment amount by more than five percent (5%) and the educational priorities that necessitated the transfer."
SECTION 8.15.(a) The Department of Public Instruction shall not transfer any school‑based personnel from the State's residential schools to central office administrative positions.
SECTION 8.15.(b) Notwithstanding G.S. 146‑30 or any other provision of law, the Department of Public Instruction shall retain all proceeds generated from the rental of building space on the residential school campuses. The Department of Public Instruction shall use all receipts generated from these leases to staff and operate the North Carolina School for the Deaf, the Eastern North Carolina School for the Deaf, and the Governor Morehead School. These receipts shall not be used to support administrative functions within the Department.
EXCELLENT PUBLIC SCHOOLS ACT/SUMMER READING CAMPS
SECTION 8.16. Funds appropriated for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium for summer reading camps as defined in G.S. 115C‑83.3(9) shall not revert at the end of each fiscal year but shall remain available until expended.
PARTICIPATION IN COMMUNITIES IN SCHOOLS LEARNING INITIATIVE
SECTION 8.17.(a) The purpose of the Harvard University Reads for Summer Learning Initiative, which is conducted in concert with Communities In Schools of North Carolina, Inc. (CISNC), is to help at‑risk children in grades two through four read at grade level by the fourth grade and to maintain their reading competency. Students who are enrolled in this initiative shall be exempt from mandatory retention requirements set out in G.S. 115C‑83.7 and G.S. 115C‑238.29F. Any student participating in this initiative and in need of more intensive intervention shall, however, be placed in a summer reading program as determined by the local school administrative unit and as approved by the child's parent or guardian.
SECTION 8.17.(b) CISNC shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on the initiative by November 1, 2015. This report shall include reading competency outcome data for all participating students.
SECTION 8.17.(c) Subsection (a) of this section expires at the end of the 2014‑2015 school year.
INSTRUCTIONAL IMPROVEMENT SYSTEM
SECTION 8.18.(a) It is the intent of the General Assembly that the optional portions of the Home Base Instructional Improvement System (System) shall be receipt‑supported. The State Board of Education shall establish a cost not to exceed four dollars ($4.00) per average daily membership for local school administrative units and charter schools that elect to participate in the optional portions of the System. A local school administrative unit or charter school may identify budget reductions to State Public School Fund allotments to cover the required payment.
SECTION 8.18.(b) If funds collected pursuant to subsection (a) of this section are not sufficient to cover the cost of the optional portions of the System, the State Board of Education may use funds appropriated to the Department of Public Instruction or State Aid for Public Schools for this purpose.
SECTION 8.18.(c) If funds collected pursuant to subsection (a) of this section exceed the cost of the optional portions of the System, such funds shall not revert and shall be used to reduce the per‑student cost in the subsequent fiscal years.
SECTION 8.18.(d) This section becomes effective July 1, 2014.
SECTION 8.19. The Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee shall study the State Board of Education's policy on calculating the weighted grade point average and class rank on high school transcripts, especially the proper weights for courses taken through community colleges, independent colleges, and universities. The Committee shall report the results of its study to the General Assembly prior to the convening of the 2014 Regular Session of the 2013 General Assembly.
SECTION 8.20. G.S. 115C‑238.63(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) Appointment. – A board of directors for a regional school shall consist of the following members. Appointed members of the board of directors shall be selected for their interest in and commitment to the importance of public education to regional economic development and to the purposes of the regional school.
(1) Local boards of education. – Each participating unit shall appoint one member to the board of directors from among the membership of the local board of education. Members appointed by local boards of education shall serve terms of four years.
(2) Local superintendents. – The local superintendent of the local school administrative unit identified as the finance agent for the regional school shall serve as an ex officio member of the board of directors. One additional superintendent shall be selected from among the superintendents of the participating units by those superintendents. The additional superintendent shall serve an initial term of two years. Subsequent appointees shall serve a term of four years.
(3) Economic development
region. Business community. – The Economic Development Regional
Partnership for the economic development region board of directors for
the chamber of commerce of the county in which the regional school is located
located, in consultation with the North Carolina Economic Developers
Association, shall appoint at least three members as representatives
of the business community. At least fifty percent (50%) of the members of
the board of directors for the regional school shall be representatives of the
business community appointed in accordance with this subdivision. At least
one of the appointees shall be a resident of the county in which the regional
school is located. The appointees shall serve an initial term of two years.
Subsequent appointees shall serve a term of four years.
(4) Parent Advisory Council. – The Parent Advisory Council established by G.S. 115C‑238.69 shall appoint a member to the board of directors from among the Council membership. The member appointed by the Council shall serve a term of four years or until the child of the parent no longer attends the regional school.
(5) Higher education partners. – Any institution of higher education partner may appoint a representative of the institution of higher education to serve as an ex officio member of the board of directors."
TEACH FOR AMERICA EXPANSION AND NC TEACHER CORPS
SECTION 8.21.(a) Teach for America, Inc. (TFA), shall use a portion of the funds available to it for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium to recruit, train, support, and retain teachers to work in the North Carolina public schools. TFA shall leverage State funds to raise additional funding to achieve the purposes set out in this section and shall expand its current programs and initiate new programs as follows:
(1) TFA shall establish a program in the Piedmont Triad region (the area within and surrounding the three major cities of Greensboro, Winston‑Salem, and High Point) and expand its current program in the southeast region of the State. TFA shall establish the following goals for the number of teacher candidates accepted to these programs:
a. In the Piedmont Triad region, at least 50 candidates who will be recruited in the 2013‑2014 school year to begin teaching in the 2014‑2015 school year.
b. In the southeast region of the State, at least 50 candidates to begin teaching in the 2013‑2014 school year.
c. Combined for the southeast and northeast regions of the State, a total of at least 175 candidates beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
(2) TFA shall develop and establish a new program, Teach Back Home, to increase the recruitment of candidates who are residents of North Carolina.
(3) TFA shall develop and establish two new programs, Teach Beyond Two and Make it Home, to increase the number of candidates who remain working in North Carolina public schools beyond their initial two‑year TFA commitment by developing innovative strategies to work with both TFA participants and local school administrators and board of education members to extend the service commitment of TFA participants.
(4) TFA shall increase targeted recruitment efforts of candidates who are (i) working in areas related to STEM education, (ii) mid‑career level and lateral entry industry professionals, and (iii) veterans of the United States Armed Forces.
SECTION 8.21.(b) By March 1, 2014, and by January 1, 2015, and annually thereafter, TFA shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on the operation of its programs under subsection (a) of this section, including at least all of the following information:
(1) The total number of applications received nationally from candidates seeking participation in the program.
(2) The total number of applications received from candidates who are residents of North Carolina and information on the source of these candidates, including the number of (i) recent college graduates and the higher institution the candidates attended, (ii) mid‑career level and lateral entry industry professionals, and (iii) veterans of the United States Armed Forces.
(3) The total number of North Carolina candidates accepted by TFA.
(4) The total number of accepted candidates placed in North Carolina, including the number of accepted candidates who are residents of North Carolina.
(5) The regions in which accepted candidates have been placed, the number of candidates in each region, and the number of students impacted by placement in those regions.
(6) Success of recruitment efforts, including the Teach Back Home program and targeting of candidates who are (i) working in areas related to STEM education, (ii) mid‑career level and lateral entry industry professionals, and (iii) veterans of the United States Armed Forces.
(7) Success of retention efforts, including the Teach Beyond Two and Make it Home programs, and the percentage of accepted candidates working in their placement communities beyond the initial TFA two‑year commitment period and the number of years those candidates teach beyond the initial commitment.
(8) A financial accounting of how the State funds appropriated to TFA were expended in the previous year, including at least the following information:
a. Funds expended by region of the State.
b. Details on program costs, including at least the following:
1. Recruitment, candidate selection, and placement.
2. Preservice training and preparation costs.
3. Operational and administrative costs, including development and fundraising, alumni support, management costs, and marketing and outreach.
c. Funds received through private fundraising, specifically by sources in each region of the State.
SECTION 8.21.(c) Effective July 1, 2014, G.S. 115C-296.7 is amended by adding a new subsection to read:
"(h) The State Board of Education is authorized to contract for the administration of the NC Teacher Corps."
SECTION 8.21.(c1) The State Board of Education shall enter into a contract, effective July 1, 2014, with Teach for America, Inc., (TFA) to administer provisions of G.S. 115C-296.7. The contract shall require that TFA make publicly available all documents related to the execution of this program and the expenditure of State funds.
SECTION 8.21.(d) Beginning with the 2014‑2015 fiscal year, TFA shall use a portion of the funds available to it to administer the NC Teacher Corps program in accordance with subsection (c1) of this section. TFA may also use a portion of the funds available to it for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year to recruit a cohort of NC Teacher Corps members for the 2014‑2015 school year. TFA shall include information regarding the operation of the NC Teacher Corps in its annual report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by January 1, 2015, and annually thereafter, as required under subsection (b) of this section.
SECTION 8.21.(e) TFA shall submit quarterly updates on the information contained in the annual report required by this section to the offices of the President Pro Tempore of the Senate and the Speaker of the House of Representatives, the Chairs of the Senate Appropriations/Base Budget Committee, the House Appropriations Committee, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Education/Higher Education, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Education, and the Fiscal Research Division.
SECTION 8.21.(f) The State Board of Education shall provide ongoing support through coaching, mentoring, and continued professional development to NC Teacher Corps members who were placed in North Carolina public schools in accordance with G.S. 115C‑296.7 for the 2012‑2013 and 2013‑2014 school years.
PHASE OUT CERTAIN TEACHER SALARY SUPPLEMENTS
SECTION 8.22. Notwithstanding Section 35.11 of this act, no teachers or instructional support personnel, except for certified school nurses and instructional support personnel in positions for which a master's degree is required for licensure, shall be paid on the "M" salary schedule or receive a salary supplement for academic preparation at the six‑year degree level or at the doctoral degree level for the 2014‑2015 school year, unless they were paid on that salary schedule or received that salary supplement prior to the 2014‑2015 school year.
PUBLIC‑PRIVATE PARTNERSHIPS FOR THE READ TO ACHIEVE PROGRAM
SECTION 8.23. Local school administrative units shall consider the utilization of public‑private partnerships in implementing the requirements of the North Carolina Read to Achieve Program. The Department of Public Instruction may recommend nonprofit organizations with expertise in literacy training in low‑performing schools and the ability to leverage private resources to partner with the local school administrative units in implementing the program.
SECTION 8.25.(a) Section 7.17 of S.L. 2012‑142 is repealed.
SECTION 8.25.(b) The federal Investing in Innovation Fund Grant: Validating Early College Strategies for Traditional Comprehensive High Schools awarded to the North Carolina New Schools Project for 2012‑2017 requires students to enroll in a community college course in the 10th grade. Notwithstanding any other provision of law, specified local school administrative units may offer one community college course to participating sophomore (10th grade) students. Participating local school administrative units are Alleghany, Beaufort, Hertford, Jones, Madison, Richmond, Rutherford, Surry, Warren, Wilkes, and Yancey County Schools.
SECTION 8.25.(c) Grant funds shall be used to pay for all costs incurred by the local school administrative units and the community college partners to implement the grant, including community college FTE. Community colleges shall not earn budget FTE for student course enrollments supported with this grant.
SECTION 8.25.(d) Research for the project shall address the effects of early college strategies in preparing students for college completion. The North Carolina New Schools Project shall report on the implementation of the grant to the State Board of Education, State Board of Community Colleges, Office of the Governor, and the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee no later than March 15, 2014, and annually thereafter until the end of the grant period.
BROADEN SUCCESSFUL PARTICIPATION IN ADVANCED COURSES
SECTION 8.27.(a) G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1. reads as rewritten:
"c1. To issue an annual "report card" for the State and for each local school administrative unit, assessing each unit's efforts to improve student performance based on the growth in performance of the students in each school and taking into account progress over the previous years' level of performance and the State's performance in comparison with other states. This assessment shall take into account factors that have been shown to affect student performance and that the State Board considers relevant to assess the State's efforts to improve student performance. As a part of the annual "report card" for each local school administrative unit, the State Board shall award an overall numerical school performance score on a scale of zero to 100 and a corresponding letter grade of A, B, C, D, or F earned by each school within the local school administrative unit. The school performance score and grade shall reflect student performance on annual subject‑specific assessments, college and workplace readiness measures, and graduation rates. For schools serving students in any grade from kindergarten to eighth grade, separate performance scores and grades shall also be awarded based on the school performance in reading and mathematics respectively. The annual "report card" for schools serving students in third grade also shall include the number and percentage of third grade students who (i) take and pass the alternative assessment of reading comprehension; (ii) were retained in third grade for not demonstrating reading proficiency as indicated in G.S. 115C‑83.7(a); and (iii) were exempt from mandatory third grade retention by category of exemption as listed in G.S. 115C‑83.7(b). The annual "report card" for high schools shall also include measures of Advanced Placement course participation and International Baccalaureate Diploma Programme participation and Advanced Placement and International Baccalaureate examination participation and performance."
SECTION 8.27.(b) Article 8 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑83.4A. Advanced courses.
(a) It is the intent of the State to enhance accessibility and encourage students to enroll in and successfully complete more rigorous advanced courses to enable success in postsecondary education for all students. For the purposes of this section, an advanced course is an Advanced Placement or International Baccalaureate Diploma Programme course. To attain this goal, to the extent funds are made available for this purpose, students enrolled in public schools shall be exempt from paying any fees for administration of examinations for advanced courses and registration fees for advanced courses in which the student is enrolled regardless of the score the student achieves on an examination.
(b) Eligible secondary students shall be encouraged to enroll in advanced courses to expose them to more rigorous coursework while still in secondary school. Successfully completing advanced courses will increase the quality and level of students' preparation for postsecondary career paths and their pursuit of higher education.
(c) The results of student diagnostic tests administered pursuant to G.S. 115C‑174.18 and G.S. 115C‑174.22, such as the Preliminary SAT/National Merit Scholarship Qualifying Test (PSAT/NMSQT) and ACT, shall be used to identify students who are prepared or who need additional work to be prepared to enroll and be successful in advanced courses. Students may also be identified for potential enrollment in advanced courses based on other criteria established by schools to increase access to those courses for their students.
(d) Local boards of education shall provide information to students and parents on available opportunities and the enrollment process for students to take advanced courses. The information shall explain the value of advanced courses in preparing students for postsecondary level coursework, enabling students to gain access to postsecondary opportunities, and qualifying for scholarships and other financial aid opportunities.
(e) Local boards of education shall ensure that all high school students have access to advanced courses in language arts, mathematics, science, and social studies. Such access may be provided through enrollment in courses offered through or approved by the North Carolina Virtual Public School.
(f) The State Board of Education shall seek a partner, such as the College Board, to form the North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership, hereinafter referred to as Partnership, to assist in improving college readiness of secondary students and to assist secondary schools to ensure that students have access to high‑quality, rigorous academics with a focus on access to Advanced Placement courses.
In order to implement its responsibilities under this section, the partner selected by the State Board of Education shall provide staff to do the following:
(1) Provide professional development in the form of support and training to enable teachers of Advanced Placement courses to have the necessary content knowledge, instructional skills, and materials to prepare students for success in Advanced Placement courses and examinations and mastery of postsecondary course content.
(2) Provide administrators, including principals and counselors, with professional development that will enable them to create strong and effective Advanced Placement courses in their schools.
(3) Provide teachers of students in grades seven through 12 with preadvanced course professional development and materials that prepare students for success in Advanced Placement courses.
(4) Provide consulting expertise and technical assistance to support implementation.
(5) Prioritize assistance to schools designated as low‑performing by the State Board of Education and provide for frequent visits to the schools targeted by the Partnership.
(g) The Partnership shall report annually to the Department of Public Instruction on the Partnership's implementation of its responsibilities under subsection (f) of this section.
(h) Beginning October 1, 2014, the State Board of Education shall report annually to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on advanced courses in North Carolina. The report shall include, at a minimum, the following information:
(1) The North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership's report to the Department of Public Instruction as required by subsection (g) of this section and the State Board's assessment of that report.
(2) Number of students enrolled in advanced courses and participating in advanced course examinations, including demographic information by gender, race, and free and reduced‑price lunch status.
(3) Student performance on advanced course examinations, including information by course, local school administrative unit, and school.
(4) Number of students participating in 10th grade PSAT/NMSQT testing.
(5) Number of teachers attending summer institutes offered by the North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership.
(6) Distribution of funding appropriated for advanced course testing fees and professional development by local school administrative unit and school.
(7) Status and efforts of the North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership.
(8) Other trends in advanced courses and examinations."
SECTION 8.27.(c) G.S. 115C‑174.18 reads as rewritten:
"§
115C‑174.18. Opportunity to take Preliminary Scholastic Aptitude
Test.Preliminary SAT/National Merit Scholarship Qualifying Test
(PSAT/NMSQT).
Every student in the eighth
through tenth grades who has completed Algebra I or who is in the last month of
Algebra I shall be given an opportunity to take a version of the Preliminary
Scholastic Aptitude Test (PSAT) either the Preliminary SAT/National
Merit Scholarship Qualifying Test (PSAT/NMSQT) or the ACT, at the discretion of
the local school administrative unit, one time at State expense.no
cost to the student. The maximum amount of State funds used for this purpose
shall be the cost of the PSAT/NMSQT."
SECTION 8.27.(d) Of the funds appropriated to the Department of Public Instruction to implement the requirements of this section, ten million eight hundred thirty‑one thousand one hundred eighty‑four dollars ($10,831,184) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used to fund fees for testing in advanced courses and one million five hundred thousand dollars ($1,500,000) for each fiscal year shall be used by the North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership to carry out its responsibilities as set forth in this section. Funding appropriated for professional development may be used by the State Board of Education to contract with an independent evaluator to assess the implementation and impact of advanced course programs in North Carolina. For the purposes of this section, the term "advanced courses" means an Advanced Placement or International Baccalaureate Diploma Programme course.
(1) Provide funds to local school administrative units to pay testing fees for advanced courses for all students.
(2) Provide funds to the North Carolina Advanced Placement Partnership for professional development for teachers of Advanced Placement courses.
SECTION 8.27.(f) Except as otherwise provided in this section, this section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
INCREASE SUCCESSFUL CAREER AND TECHNICAL EDUCATION (CTE) PARTICIPATION
SECTION 8.28.(a) G.S. 115C‑12 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(41) To Establish Career and Technical Education Incentives. – The State Board of Education shall establish, implement, and determine the impact of a career and technical education incentive program as provided under G.S. 115C‑156.2."
SECTION 8.28.(b) Article 10 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑156.2. Industry certifications and credentials program.
(a) It is the intent of the State to encourage students to enroll in and successfully complete rigorous coursework and credentialing processes in career and technical education to enable success in the workplace. To attain this goal, to the extent funds are made available for this purpose, students shall be supported to earn approved industry certifications and credentials.
(1) Students enrolled in public schools and in career and technical education courses shall be exempt from paying any fees for one administration of examinations leading to industry certifications and credentials pursuant to rules adopted by the State Board of Education.
(2) Each school year, at such time as agreed to by the Department of Commerce and the State Board of Education, the Department of Commerce shall provide the State Board of Education with a list of those occupations in high need of additional skilled employees. If the occupations identified in such list are not substantially the same as those occupations identified in the list from the prior year, reasonable notice of such changes shall be provided to local school administrative units.
(3) Local school administrative units shall consult with their local industries, employers, and workforce development boards to identify industry certification and credentials that the local school administrative unit may offer to best meet State and local workforce needs.
(b) Beginning in 2014, the State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by September 1 of each year on the number of students in career and technical education courses who earned (i) community college credit and (ii) related industry certifications and credentials."
SECTION 8.28.(c) This section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
SECTION 8.29.(a) Article 39 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new Part to read:
"Part 2A. Scholarship Grants.
"§ 115C‑562.1. Definitions.
The following definitions apply in this Part:
(1) Authority. – The State Education Assistance Authority.
(2) Eligible students. – A student who has not yet received a high school diploma and who meets all of the following requirements:
a. Meets one of the following criteria:
1. Was a full‑time student assigned to and attending a public school pursuant to G.S. 115C‑366 during the previous semester.
2. Received a scholarship grant during the previous school year.
3. Is entering either kindergarten or the first grade.
4. Is a child in foster care as defined in G.S. 131D‑10.2(9).
5. Is a child whose adoption decree was entered not more than one year prior to submission of the scholarship grant application.
b. Resides in a household with an income level not in excess of one hundred thirty‑three percent (133%) of the amount required for the student to qualify for the federal free or reduced‑price lunch program.
(3) Division. – The Division of Nonpublic Education, Department of Administration.
(4) Local school administrative unit. – A local school administrative unit, charter school, or regional school.
(5) Nonpublic school. – A school that meets the requirements of Part 1 or Part 2 of this Article as identified by the Division.
(6) Scholarship grants. – Grants awarded annually by the Authority to eligible students.
"§ 115C‑562.2. Scholarship grants.
(a) The Authority shall make available no later than February 1 annually applications to eligible students for the award of scholarship grants to attend any nonpublic school. Information about scholarship grants and the application process shall be made available on the Authority's Web site. Beginning March 1, the Authority shall begin awarding scholarship grants according to the following criteria:
(1) First priority shall be given to eligible students who received a scholarship grant during the previous school year if those students have applied by March 1.
(2) After scholarship grants have been awarded to prior recipients as provided in subdivision (1) of this subsection, scholarships shall be awarded with remaining funds as follows:
a. At least fifty percent (50%) of the remaining funds shall be used to award scholarship grants to eligible students residing in households with an income level not in excess of the amount required for the student to qualify for the federal free or reduced‑price lunch program.
b. No more than thirty‑five percent (35%) of the remaining funds shall be used to award scholarship grants to eligible students entering either kindergarten or first grade.
c. Any remaining funds shall be used to award scholarship grants to all other eligible students.
(b) Scholarship grants awarded to eligible students residing in households with an income level not in excess of the amount required for the student to qualify for the federal free or reduced‑price lunch program shall be for amounts of up to four thousand two hundred dollars ($4,200) per year. Scholarship grants awarded to eligible students residing in households with an income level in excess of the amount required for the student to qualify for the federal free or reduced‑price lunch program shall be for amounts of not more than ninety percent (90%) of the required tuition and fees for the nonpublic school the eligible child will attend. Tuition and fees for a nonpublic school may include tuition and fees for books, transportation, equipment, or other items required by the nonpublic school. No scholarship grant shall exceed four thousand two hundred dollars ($4,200) per year per eligible student, and no scholarship grant shall exceed the required tuition and fees for the nonpublic school the eligible student will attend.
(c) The Authority shall permit an eligible student receiving a scholarship grant to enroll in a different nonpublic school and remain eligible. An eligible student receiving a scholarship grant who transfers to another nonpublic school during the year may be eligible to receive a pro rata share of any unexpended portion of the scholarship grant for tuition and fees at the nonpublic school to which the student transfers.
(d) The Authority shall establish rules and regulations for the administration and awarding of scholarship grants and may include in those rules a lottery process for selection of scholarship grant recipients within the criteria established by this section.
"§ 115C‑562.3. Verification of eligibility.
(a) The Authority may seek verification of information on any application for scholarship grants from eligible students. The Authority shall select and verify a random sample of no less than six percent (6%) of applications annually. The Authority shall establish rules for the verification process and may use the federal verification requirements process for free and reduced‑price lunch applications as guidance for those rules. If a household fails to cooperate with verification efforts, the Authority shall revoke the award of the scholarship grant to the eligible student.
(b) Household members of applicants for scholarship grants shall authorize the Authority to access information needed for verification efforts held by other State agencies, including the Department of Revenue, the Department of Health and Human Services, and the Department of Public Instruction.
"§ 115C‑562.4. Identification of nonpublic schools and distribution of scholarship grant information.
(a) The Division shall provide annually by February 1 to the Authority a list of all nonpublic schools operating in the State that meet the requirements of Part 1 or Part 2 of this Article. The Division shall notify the Authority of any schools included in the list that the Division has determined to be ineligible within five business days of the determination of ineligibility.
(b) The Authority shall provide information about the scholarship grant program to the Division, including applications and the obligations of nonpublic schools accepting eligible students receiving scholarship grants. The Division shall ensure that information about the scholarship grant program is provided to all qualified nonpublic schools on an annual basis.
"§ 115C‑562.5. Obligations of nonpublic schools accepting eligible students receiving scholarship grants.
(a) A nonpublic school that accepts eligible students receiving scholarship grants shall comply with the following:
(1) Provide to the Authority documentation for required tuition and fees charged to the student by the nonpublic school.
(2) Conduct a criminal background check for the staff member with the highest decision‑making authority, as defined by the bylaws, articles of incorporation, or other governing document, to ensure that person has not been convicted of any crime listed in G.S. 115C‑332.
(3) Provide to the parent or guardian of an eligible student, whose tuition and fees are paid in whole or in part with a scholarship grant, an annual written explanation of the student's progress, including the student's scores on standardized achievement tests.
(4) Administer, at least once in each school year, a nationally standardized test or other nationally standardized equivalent measurement selected by the chief administrative officer of the nonpublic school to all eligible students whose tuition and fees are paid in whole or in part with a scholarship grant enrolled in grades three and higher. The nationally standardized test or other equivalent measurement selected must measure achievement in the areas of English grammar, reading, spelling, and mathematics. Test performance data shall be submitted to the Authority by July 15 of each year. Test performance data reported to the Authority under this subdivision is not a public record under Chapter 132 of the General Statutes.
(5) Provide to the Authority graduation rates of the students receiving scholarship grants in a manner consistent with nationally recognized standards.
(6) Contract with a certified public accountant to perform a financial review, consistent with generally accepted accounting principles, for each school year in which the school accepts students receiving more than three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000) in scholarship grants awarded under this Part.
(b) A nonpublic school that accepts students receiving scholarship grants shall not require any additional fees based on the status of the student as a scholarship grant recipient.
(c) A nonpublic school enrolling more than 25 students whose tuition and fees are paid in whole or in part with a scholarship grant shall report to the Authority on the aggregate standardized test performance of eligible students. Aggregate test performance data reported to the Authority which does not contain personally identifiable student data shall be a public record under Chapter 132 of the General Statutes. Test performance data may be shared with public or private institutions of higher education located in North Carolina and shall be provided to an independent research organization selected by the Authority for research purposes as permitted by the Federal Education Rights and Privacy Act, 20 U.S.C. § 1232g.
(d) A nonpublic school accepting students receiving scholarship grants that fails to comply with the requirements of this section shall be ineligible to receive future scholarship grants if the Authority determines that the nonpublic school is not in compliance with the requirements of this section. The nonpublic school shall notify the parent or guardian of any enrolled student receiving a scholarship grant that the nonpublic school is no longer eligible to receive future scholarship grants. A nonpublic school may appeal for reconsideration of eligibility after one year.
"§ 115C‑562.6. Scholarship endorsement.
The Authority shall remit, at least two times each school year, scholarship grant funds awarded to eligible students to the nonpublic school for endorsement by at least one of the student's parents or guardians. The parent or guardian shall restrictively endorse the scholarship grant funds awarded to the eligible student to the nonpublic school for deposit into the account of the nonpublic school. The parent or guardian shall not designate any entity or individual associated with the nonpublic school as the parent's attorney‑in‑fact to endorse the scholarship grant funds but shall endorse the scholarship grant funds in person at the site of the nonpublic school. A parent's or guardian's failure to comply with this section shall result in forfeit of the scholarship grant. A scholarship grant forfeited for failure to comply with this section shall be returned to the Authority to be awarded to another student.
"§ 115C‑562.7. Authority reporting requirements.
(a) The Authority shall report to the Department of Public Instruction annually, no later than September 1, the number and names of students who have received scholarship grants for the current school year and who were enrolled the prior semester in a local school administrative unit by the previously attended local school administrative unit. By September 15 of each year, the State Board of Education shall determine the amount of the reduction for each local school administrative unit by multiplying the students who have received scholarship grants for the current school year and who were enrolled the prior semester in a local school administrative unit by the per pupil allocation for average daily membership from the local school administrative unit. Local school administrative units shall identify to the Department of Public Instruction the reductions to State General Fund appropriations for Opportunity Scholarships by October 1 of each year.
(b) The Authority shall report annually, no later than March 1, to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on the following:
(1) Total number, grade level, race, ethnicity, and sex of eligible students receiving scholarship grants.
(2) Total amount of scholarship grant funding awarded.
(3) Number of students previously enrolled in local school administrative units or charter schools in the prior semester by the previously attended local school administrative unit or charter school.
(4) Nonpublic schools in which scholarship grant recipients are enrolled, including numbers of scholarship grant students at each nonpublic school.
(5) Nonpublic schools deemed ineligible to receive scholarships.
(c) The Authority shall report annually, no later than December 1, to the Department of Public Instruction and the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on the following:
(1) Learning gains or losses of students receiving scholarship grants. The report shall include learning gains of participating students on a statewide basis and shall compare, to the extent possible, the learning gains or losses of eligible students by nonpublic school to the statewide learning gains or losses of public school students with similar socioeconomic backgrounds, using aggregate standardized test performance data provided to the Authority by nonpublic schools and by the Department of Public Instruction.
(2) Competitive effects on public school performance on standardized tests as a result of the scholarship grant program. The report shall analyze the impact of the availability of scholarship grants on public school performance on standardized tests by local school administrative units to the extent possible, and shall provide comparisons of the impact by geographic region and between rural and urban local school administrative units.
This report shall be conducted by an independent research organization to be selected by the Authority, which may be a public or private entity or university. The independent research organization shall report to the Authority on the results of its research. The Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee shall review reports from the Authority and shall make ongoing recommendations to the General Assembly as needed regarding improving administration and accountability for nonpublic schools accepting students receiving scholarship grants."
SECTION 8.29.(b) G.S. 110‑86(2) reads as rewritten:
"(2) Child care. – A program or arrangement where three or more children less than 13 years old, who do not reside where the care is provided, receive care on a regular basis of at least once per week for more than four hours but less than 24 hours per day from persons other than their guardians or full‑time custodians, or from persons not related to them by birth, marriage, or adoption. Child care does not include the following:
…
f. Nonpublic schools
described in Part 2 of Article 39 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes that
are accredited by national or regional accrediting agencies with early
childhood standards the Southern Association of Colleges and Schools and
that operate a child care facility as defined in subdivision (3) of this
section for less than six and one‑half hours per day either on or off the
school site;
…."
SECTION 8.29.(c) G.S. 115C‑555 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑555. Qualification of nonpublic schools.
The provisions of this Part shall apply to any nonpublic school which has one or more of the following characteristics:
(1) It is accredited by the State Board of Education.
(2) It is accredited by the
Southern Association of Colleges and Schools.a national or regional
accrediting agency.
(3) It is an active member of the North Carolina Association of Independent Schools.
(4) It receives no funding from the State of North Carolina. For the purposes of this Article, scholarship grant funds awarded pursuant to Part 2A of this Article to eligible students attending a nonpublic school shall not be considered funding from the State of North Carolina."
SECTION 8.29.(d) G.S. 116‑204 reads as rewritten:
"§ 116‑204. Powers of Authority.
The Authority is hereby authorized and empowered:
…
(11) To administer the awarding of scholarship grants to students attending nonpublic schools as provided in Part 2A of Article 39 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes."
SECTION 8.29.(e) Notwithstanding the awards criteria in G.S. 115C‑562.2(a)(1) and (2), as enacted by this section, and the definition of eligible student in G.S. 115C‑562.1(2), as enacted by this section, for the 2014‑2015 school year, to be eligible to receive a scholarship grant, a student shall meet both of the following criteria:
(1) Reside in a household with an income level not in excess of the amount required for the student to qualify for the federal free or reduced‑price lunch program.
(2) Be a full‑time student who has not yet received a high school diploma and is assigned to and attending a public school pursuant to G.S. 115C‑366 during the 2014 spring semester.
The Authority shall establish temporary rules and regulations for the administration and awarding of scholarship grants in 2014‑2015, which may include a process for awarding grants using a random lottery system.
SECTION 8.29.(f) The Authority may retain up to four hundred thousand dollars ($400,000) annually for administrative costs associated with the scholarship grant program.
SECTION 8.29.(g) The Authority shall select an independent research organization, as required by G.S. 115C‑562.7, as enacted by this section, beginning with the 2017‑2018 school year. The first learning gains report required by G.S. 115C‑562.7, as enacted by this section, shall not be due until December 1, 2018. The first financial review for a nonpublic school that accepts scholarship grant funds, as required by G.S. 115C‑562.5(a)(6), as enacted by this section, shall not be required until the 2015‑2016 school year.
SECTION 8.29.(h) This section applies beginning with the 2014‑2015 school year. In accordance with G.S. 115C‑562.2, as enacted by this section, the Authority shall make applications available for the 2014‑2015 school year no later than February 1, 2014, and shall begin awarding grants no later than March 1, 2014. Information about scholarship grants and the application process shall be made available on the Authority's Web site. In accordance with G.S. 115C‑562.4, as enacted by this section, the Division of Nonpublic Education, Department of Administration, shall make available to the Authority a list of all nonpublic schools operating in the State that meet the requirements of Part 1 or Part 2 of Article 39 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes no later than February 1, 2014.
REPEAL REQUIREMENT THAT SCHOOLS PROVIDE READING WORKSHOPS FOR PARENTS OF STUDENTS WHO HAVE BEEN RETAINED
SECTION 8.30. G.S. 115C‑83.8(d) is repealed.
TASK FORCE TO STUDY TEACHER AND SCHOOL ADMINISTRATOR EFFECTIVENESS AND COMPENSATION
SECTION 8.31.(a) Establishment. – The North Carolina Educator Effectiveness and Compensation Task Force is established.
SECTION 8.31.(b) Membership. – The Task Force shall be composed of 18 members as follows:
(1) Nine members appointed by the Speaker of the House of Representatives as follows:
a. Four persons who are members of the House of Representatives at the time of appointment, at least two of whom represent the minority party.
b. A representative of the Department of Public Instruction.
c. A classroom teacher, as recommended by the North Carolina Association of Educators.
d. A school principal, as recommended by the North Carolina Association of School Administrators.
e. A representative of a North Carolina institution of higher education that offers a teacher education program and a master's degree program in education or school administration.
f. A representative from the Professional Educators of North Carolina.
(2) Nine members appointed by the President Pro Tempore of the Senate as follows:
a. Four persons who are members of the Senate at the time of appointment, at least two of whom represent the minority party.
b. A parent of a public school student.
c. Two classroom teachers.
d. A school system superintendent or public school principal.
e. A local school board member.
The Task Force shall have two cochairs, one designated by the President Pro Tempore of the Senate and one designated by the Speaker of the House of Representatives from among their appointees. The Task Force shall meet upon the call of the cochairs. Vacancies shall be filled by the appointing authority. A quorum of the Task Force shall be a majority of the members.
SECTION 8.31.(c) Duties. – The Task Force shall make recommendations on whether to create a statewide model of incentives to encourage the recruitment and retention of highly effective educators and to consider the transition to an alternative compensation system for educators. In developing recommendations, the Task Force shall consider at least the following factors:
(1) Alternatives to or simplification of the current teacher and school principal salary schedules, including the need for "hold harmless" options or a choice in compensation structure to avoid reduction in pay for current educators.
(2) Incorporating the feedback of educators in order to maximize buy‑in.
(3) The integration of school‑level performance measures in an alternative compensation system.
(4) Whether local school administrative units may create their own customized alternative compensation systems in lieu of or in addition to a statewide system, including necessary parameters such as funding flexibility and guidelines for local boards of education.
(5) The use of incentive pay to recruit and retain educators to teach in hard to staff areas.
(6) The recognition of educator responsibilities and leadership roles such as mentoring of beginning teachers and instructional coaching.
(7) Methods for identifying effective teaching and its relationship to an alternative compensation system, including:
a. The correlation of student outcomes with effective teaching.
b. The use of multiple teacher evaluation measures and feedback methods to recognize effective teaching such as classroom observations, student surveys, video training for teachers, and standard measures of student achievement.
c. The use of multiple teacher observations, including at least one observer from outside of the teacher's school.
d. The correlation to annual student growth and performance data, evaluations, effectiveness levels, and a three‑year average of student growth.
(8) Barriers to the implementation of alternative compensation systems.
(9) Educator compensation reform in other states and North Carolina pilot programs currently utilizing alternative compensation.
(10) Effective strategies for retaining effective teachers.
SECTION 8.31.(d) Compensation; Administration. – Members of the Task Force shall receive subsistence and travel allowances at the rates set forth in G.S. 120‑3.1, 138‑5, or 138‑6, as appropriate. With the prior approval of the Legislative Services Commission, the Legislative Services Officer shall assign professional and clerical staff to assist in the work of the Task Force. With the prior approval of the Legislative Services Commission, the Task Force may hold its meetings in the State Legislative Building or the Legislative Office Building. The Task Force may also meet at various locations around the State in order to promote greater public participation in its deliberations. The Task Force, while in the discharge of its official duties, may exercise all the powers provided under the provisions of G.S. 120‑19 and G.S. 120‑19.1 through G.S. 120‑19.4, including the power to request all officers, agents, agencies, and departments of the State to provide any information, data, or documents within their possession, ascertainable from their records or otherwise available to them, and the power to subpoena witnesses.
SECTION 8.31.(e) Transfer of Funds. – The Department of Public Instruction shall transfer all funds appropriated in this act for the Task Force to Budget Code 11000 in the General Assembly to support its operations in accordance with the requirements of this section.
SECTION 8.31.(f) Report. – The Task Force shall report its findings and recommendations to the 2014 Regular Session of the 2013 General Assembly no later than April 15, 2014. The Task Force shall terminate on April 15, 2014, or upon the filing of its final report, whichever occurs first.
EDUCATION AND WORKFORCE INNOVATION PROGRAM
SECTION 8.34.(a) Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new Article to read:
"Article 6C.
"Education and Workforce Innovation Program.
"§ 115C‑64.10. North Carolina Education and Workforce Innovation Commission.
(a) There is created the North Carolina Education and Workforce Innovation Commission (Commission). The Commission shall be located administratively in the Department of Public Instruction but shall exercise all its prescribed powers independently of the Department of Public Instruction. Of the funds appropriated for the Education and Workforce Innovation Program established under G.S. 115C‑64.11, up to two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000) each fiscal year may be used by the Department of Public Instruction to provide technical assistance and administrative assistance, including staff, to the Commission and reimbursements and expenses for the Commission.
(b) The Commission shall consist of the following 11 members:
(1) The Secretary of Commerce.
(2) The State Superintendent of Public Instruction.
(3) The Chair of the State Board of Education.
(4) The President of The University of North Carolina.
(5) The President of the North Carolina Community College System.
(6) Two members appointed by the Governor who have experience in education.
(7) Two members appointed by the General Assembly upon recommendation of the Speaker of the House of Representatives, as provided in G.S. 120‑121, who have experience in businesses operating in North Carolina.
(8) Two members appointed by the General Assembly upon the recommendation of the President Pro Tempore of the Senate, as provided in G.S. 120‑121, who have experience in businesses operating in North Carolina.
(c) The Commission members shall elect a chair from the membership of the Commission. The Commission shall meet at least three times annually on the call of the Chair or as additionally provided by the Commission. A quorum is six members of the Commission. Members may not send designees to Commission meetings nor may they vote by proxy.
(d) The Commission shall develop and administer the Education and Workforce Innovation Program, as established under G.S. 115C‑64.11, and make awards of grants under the Program. The Commission shall work closely with the North Carolina New Schools in administering the program.
(e) The Commission shall publish a report on the Education and Workforce Innovation Program on or before April 30 of each year. The report shall be submitted to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the State Board of Education, the State Board of Community Colleges, and the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina. The report shall include at least all of the following information:
(1) An accounting of how funds and personnel resources were utilized and their impact on student achievement, retention, and employability.
(2) Recommended statutory and policy changes.
(3) Recommendations for improvement of the program.
"§ 115C‑64.11. The Education and Workforce Innovation Program.
(a) Program Establishment. – There is established the Education and Workforce Innovation Program (Program) to foster innovation in education that will lead to more students graduating career and college ready. Funds appropriated to the Program shall be used to award competitive grants to an individual school, a local school administrative unit, or a regional partnership of more than one local school administrative unit to advance comprehensive, high‑quality education that equips teachers with the knowledge and skill required to succeed with all students. Before receiving a grant, applicants must meet all of the following conditions:
(1) Form a partnership, for the purposes of the grant, with either a public or private university or a community college.
(2) Form a partnership, for the purposes of the grant, with regional businesses and business leaders.
(3) Demonstrate the ability to sustain innovation once grant funding ends.
(b) Applicant Categories and Specific Requirements. –
(1) Individual schools. – Individual public schools must demonstrate all of the following in their applications:
a. Partnerships with business and industry to determine the skills and competencies needed for students' transition into growth sectors of the regional economy.
b. Aligned pathways to employment, including students' acquisition of college credit or industry recognized credentials.
c. Development of systems, infrastructure, capacity, and culture to enable teachers and school leaders to continuously focus on improving individual student achievement.
(2) Local school administrative units. – Local school administrative units must demonstrate all of the following in their applications:
a. Implementation of comprehensive reform and innovation.
b. Appointment of a senior leader to manage and sustain the change process with a specific focus on providing parents with a portfolio of meaningful options among schools.
(3) Regional partnerships of two or more local school administrative units. – Partnerships of two or more local school administrative units must demonstrate all of the following in their applications:
a. Implementation of resources of partnered local school administrative units in creating a tailored workforce development system for the regional economy and fostering innovation in each of the partnered local school administrative units.
b. Promotion of the development of knowledge and skills in career clusters of critical importance to the region.
c. Benefits of the shared strengths of local businesses and higher education.
d. Usage of technology to deliver instruction over large geographic regions and build networks with industry.
e. Implementation of comprehensive reform and innovation that can be replicated in other local school administrative units.
(c) Consideration of Factors in Awarding of Grants. – All applications must include information on at least the following in order to be considered for a grant:
(1) Describe the aligned pathways from school to high‑growth careers in regional economies.
(2) Leverage technology to efficiently and effectively drive teacher and principal development, connect students and teachers to online courses and resources, and foster virtual learning communities among faculty, higher education partners, and business partners.
(3) Establish a comprehensive approach to enhancing the knowledge and skills of teachers and administrators to successfully implement the proposed innovative program and to graduate all students ready for work and college.
(4) Link to a proven provider of professional development services for teachers and administrators capable of providing evidence‑based training and tools aligned with the goals of the proposed innovative program.
(5) Form explicit partnerships with businesses and industry, which may include business advisory councils, internship programs, and other customized projects aligned with relevant workforce skills.
(6) Partner with community colleges or public or private universities to enable communities to challenge every student to graduate with workplace credentials or college credit.
(7) Align K‑12 and postsecondary instruction and performance expectations to reduce the need for college remediation courses.
(8) Secure input from parents to foster broad ownership for school choice options and to foster greater understanding of the need for continued education beyond high school.
(9) Provide a description of the funds that will be used and a proposed budget for five years.
(10) Describe the source of matching funds required in subsection (d) of this section.
(11) Establish a strategy to achieve meaningful analysis of program outcomes due to the receipt of grant funds under this section.
(d) Matching Private and Local Funds. – All funds appropriated by the State must be matched by a combination of private and local funds. All grant applicants must fund twenty‑five percent (25%) of program costs through local funds. An additional twenty‑five percent (25%) of program costs must be raised by private funds.
(e) Grants. – Any grants awarded by the Commission may be spent over a five‑year period from the initial award.
(f) Reporting Requirements. – No later than March 1 of each year, a grant recipient shall submit to the Commission an annual report for the preceding grant year that describes the academic progress made by the students and the implementation of program initiatives."
SECTION 8.34.(b) The North Carolina Education and Workforce Innovation Commission (Commission), as established by G.S. 115C‑64.10, as enacted by this section, shall conduct a study to determine the most efficient way to fund dual enrollment for high school students in college coursework. The Commission shall report the results of this study to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by October 1, 2014.
SECTION 8.34.(c) The appointments to the Commission as set forth in G.S. 115C‑64.10, as enacted by this section, shall be made by the appointing entities no later than September 1, 2013. The Commission shall hold its first meeting no later than October 1, 2013.
SCHOOL PSYCHOLOGISTS, SCHOOL COUNSELORS, AND SCHOOL SOCIAL WORKERS
SECTION 8.35.(a) Article 21 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑316.1. Duties of school counselors.
(a) School counselors shall implement a comprehensive developmental school counseling program in their schools. Counselors shall spend at least eighty percent (80%) of their work time providing direct services to students. Direct services do not include the coordination of standardized testing. Direct services shall consist of:
(1) Delivering the school guidance curriculum through large group guidance, interdisciplinary curriculum development, group activities, and parent workshops.
(2) Guiding individual student planning through individual or small group assistance and individual or small group advisement.
(3) Providing responsive services through consultation with students, families, and staff; individual and small group counseling; crisis counseling; referrals; and peer facilitation.
(4) Performing other student services listed in the Department of Public Instruction school counselor job description that has been approved by the State Board of Education.
(b) During the remainder of their work time, counselors shall spend adequate time on school counseling program support activities that consist of professional development; consultation, collaboration, and training; and program management and operations. School counseling program support activities do not include the coordination of standardized testing. However, school counselors may assist other staff with the coordination of standardized testing."
SECTION 8.35.(b) Each local board of education shall develop a transition plan for implementing subsection (a) of this section within existing resources by reassigning duties within its schools.
The State Board of Education shall develop and distribute guidelines to all local school administrative units to assist with the implementation of subsection (a) of this section.
GRANTS FOR SCHOOL RESOURCE OFFICERS IN ELEMENTARY AND MIDDLE SCHOOLS
SECTION 8.36. Grants to local school administrative units, regional schools, and charter schools for school resource officers in elementary and middle schools shall be matched on the basis of two dollars ($2.00) in State funds for every one dollar ($1.00) in local funds and shall be used to supplement and not to supplant State, local, and federal funds for school resource officers.
The State Board of Education shall include need‑based considerations in its criteria for awarding these grants to local school administrative units, regional schools, and charter schools.
Local school administrative units, regional schools, and charter schools may use these funds to employ school resource officers in elementary and middle schools, to train them, or both. Any such training shall include instruction on research into the social and cognitive development of elementary school and middle school children.
SECTION 8.37.(a) G.S. 115C‑47(40) reads as rewritten:
"(40) To adopt emergency
response plans. – Local boards of education mayshall, in coordination
with local law enforcement agencies, adopt emergency response plans
relating to incidents of school violence. These plans are not a public record
as the term "public record" is defined under G.S. 132‑1
and shall not be subject to inspection and examination under G.S. 132‑6."
SECTION 8.37.(b) Grants to local school administrative units, regional schools, and charter schools for panic alarm systems in schools shall be matched on the basis of one dollar ($1.00) in State funds for every one dollar ($1.00) in local funds and shall be used to supplement and not to supplant State, local, and federal funds for panic alarm systems.
The State Board of Education shall include need‑based considerations in its criteria for awarding these grants to local school administrative units, regional schools, and charter schools.
SECTION 8.37.(c) Effective July 1, 2015, every public school shall have a panic alarm system that connects with the nearest local law enforcement agency in the local board of education's emergency response plan.
SECTION 8.38. Article 8C of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑105.49. School safety exercises.
(a) At least every two years, each local school administrative unit is encouraged to hold a full systemwide school safety and school lockdown exercise with the local law enforcement agencies that are part of the local board of education's emergency response plan. The purpose of the exercise shall be to permit participants to (i) discuss simulated emergency situations in a low‑stress environment, (ii) clarify their roles and responsibilities and the overall logistics of dealing with an emergency, and (iii) identify areas in which the emergency response plan needs to be modified.
(b) As part of a local board of education's emergency response plan, at least once a year, each school is encouraged to hold a full schoolwide school safety and lockdown exercise with local law enforcement agencies."
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS OF SCHOOL FACILITIES
SECTION 8.39.(a) Beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year, each local school administrative unit that currently maintains schematic diagrams of its school facilities shall provide those schematic diagrams to local law enforcement agencies. The local school administrative unit shall provide updates of the schematic diagrams to local law enforcement agencies when substantial modifications such as new facilities or modifications to doors and windows are made to school facilities. The local school administrative unit shall also provide keys to the main entrance of all school facilities to local law enforcement agencies.
SECTION 8.39.(b) Each local school administrative unit that does not currently maintain schematic diagrams of its school facilities as of the effective date of this act shall report to the Department of Public Instruction by March 1, 2014, on whether it intends to prepare schematic diagrams of its school facilities to provide to local law enforcement agencies and if any obstacles exist in preparing such schematic diagrams. Local school administrative units are encouraged to prepare schematic diagrams and provide keys to the main entrance of all school facilities to local law enforcement agencies prior to the beginning of the 2014‑2015 school year.
SECTION 8.39.(c) The Department of Public Instruction, in consultation with the Department of Public Safety, may develop standards and guidelines to assist local school administrative units in developing and providing schematic diagrams to local law enforcement agencies.
SECTION 8.39.(d) Schematic diagrams are not considered a public record as the term "public record" is defined under G.S. 132‑1 and shall not be subject to inspection and examination under G.S. 132‑6.
SECTION 8.40. Article 8C of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑105.51. Anonymous tip lines.
(a) Each local school administrative unit is encouraged to develop and operate an anonymous tip line, in coordination with local law enforcement and social services agencies, to receive anonymous information on internal or external risks to school buildings and school‑related activities.
(b) The Department of Public Instruction, in consultation with the Department of Public Safety, may develop standards and guidelines for the development, operation, and staffing of tip lines.
(c) The Department of Public Instruction may provide information to local school administrative units on federal, State, local, and private grants available for this purpose."
SCHOOL SAFETY COMPONENT OF SCHOOL IMPROVEMENT PLANS
SECTION 8.41.(a) G.S. 115C‑105.27, as rewritten by Section 11(a) of S.L. 2013‑226, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑105.27. Development and approval of school improvement plans.
(a) School Improvement
Team. – In order to improve student performance, each school shall
develop a school improvement plan that takes into consideration the annual
performance goal for that school that is set by the State Board under G.S. 115C‑105.35
and the goals set out in the mission statement for the public schools adopted
by the State Board of Education. The principal of each school,
representatives of the assistant principals, instructional personnel,
instructional support personnel, and teacher assistants assigned to the school
building, and parents of children enrolled in the school shall constitute a
school improvement team to team. The team shall develop a school
improvement plan to improve student performance.
Representatives of the assistant principals, instructional personnel, instructional support personnel, and teacher assistants shall be elected by their respective groups by secret ballot.
Unless the local board of education has adopted an election policy, parents shall be elected by parents of children enrolled in the school in an election conducted by the parent and teacher organization of the school or, if none exists, by the largest organization of parents formed for this purpose. Parents serving on school improvement teams shall reflect the racial and socioeconomic composition of the students enrolled in that school and shall not be members of the building‑level staff.
Parental involvement is a critical component of school success and positive student achievement; therefore, it is the intent of the General Assembly that parents, along with teachers, have a substantial role in developing school improvement plans. To this end, school improvement team meetings shall be held at a convenient time to assure substantial parent participation.
All school improvement plans
shall be, to the greatest extent possible, data‑driven. School
improvement teams shall use the Education Value Added Assessment System (EVAAS)
or a compatible and comparable system approved by the State Board of Education,
to analyze student data to identify root causes for problems, to determine
actions to address them, and to appropriately place students in courses such as
Algebra I. School improvement plans shall contain clear, unambiguous targets,
explicit indicators and actual measures, and expeditious time frames for
meeting the measurement standards.
(a1) Open Meetings. – School improvement team meetings are subject to the open meetings requirements of Article 33C of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes. Deliberations on the school safety components of the plan shall be in closed session in accordance with G.S. 143‑318.11(a)(8). The principal shall ensure that these requirements are met.
(a2) Public Records. – The school improvement plan, except for the school safety components of the plan, is a public record subject to Chapter 132 of the General Statutes and shall be posted on the school Web site. The names of the members of the school improvement team, their positions, and the date of their election to the school improvement team shall also be posted on the Web site.
The school safety components of the plan are not public records subject to Chapter 132 of the General Statutes.
(b) School Improvement Plan. – In order to improve student performance, the school improvement team at each school shall develop a school improvement plan that takes into consideration the annual performance goal for that school that is set by the State Board under G.S. 115C‑105.35 and the goals set out in the mission statement for the public schools adopted by the State Board of Education. All school improvement plans shall be, to the greatest extent possible, data‑driven. School improvement teams shall use the Education Value‑Added Assessment System (EVAAS) or a compatible and comparable system approved by the State Board of Education to (i) analyze student data and identify root causes for problems, (ii) determine actions to address them, and (iii) appropriately place students in courses such as Algebra I. School improvement plans shall contain clear, unambiguous targets, explicit indicators and actual measures, and expeditious time frames for meeting the measurement standards.
The strategies for improving student performance:
(1) Shall include a plan for the use of staff development funds that may be made available to the school by the local board of education to implement the school improvement plan. The plan may provide that a portion of these funds is used for mentor training and for release time and substitute teachers while mentors and teachers mentored are meeting;
(1a) Repealed by Session Laws 2012‑142, s. 7A.1(c), effective July 2, 2012.
(2) Shall include a plan to address school safety and discipline concerns;
(3) May include a decision to use State funds in accordance with G.S. 115C‑105.25;
(4) Shall include a plan that specifies the effective instructional practices and methods to be used to improve the academic performance of students identified as at risk of academic failure or at risk of dropping out of school;
(5) May include requests for waivers of State laws, rules, or policies for that school. A request for a waiver shall meet the requirements of G.S. 115C‑105.26;
(6) Shall include a plan to provide a duty‑free lunch period for every teacher on a daily basis or as otherwise approved by the school improvement team; and
(7) Shall include a plan to provide duty‑free instructional planning time for every teacher under G.S. 115C‑301.1, with the goal of providing an average of at least five hours of planning time per week.
(8) Shall include a plan to identify and eliminate unnecessary and redundant reporting requirements for teachers and, to the extent practicable, streamline the school's reporting system and procedures, including requiring forms and reports to be in electronic form when possible and incorporating relevant documents into the student accessible components of the Instructional Improvement System.
(c) School Vote on the Plan. – Support among affected staff members is essential to successful implementation of a school improvement plan to address improved student performance at that school. The principal of the school shall present the proposed school improvement plan to all of the principals, assistant principals, instructional personnel, instructional support personnel, and teacher assistants assigned to the school building for their review and vote. The vote shall be by secret ballot. The principal shall submit the school improvement plan to the local board of education only if the proposed school improvement plan has the approval of a majority of the staff who voted on the plan.
(c1) Consideration of the School Safety Components of the Plan. – The superintendent shall review the school safety components of the school improvement plans and make written recommendations on them to the local board of education. Prior to a vote to accept a school's improvement plan in accordance with G.S. 115C‑105.27(d), the local board of education shall review the school safety components of the plan for that school in closed session. The board shall make findings on the safety components of the plan. Neither the safety components of the plan nor the board's findings on the safety components of the plan shall be set out in the minutes of the board.
(d) Adoption of the Plan. – The local board of education shall accept or reject the school improvement plan. The local board shall not make any substantive changes in any school improvement plan that it accepts. If the local board rejects a school improvement plan, the local board shall state with specificity its reasons for rejecting the plan; the school improvement team may then prepare another plan, present it to the principals, assistant principals, instructional personnel, instructional support personnel, and teacher assistants assigned to the school building for a vote, and submit it to the local board to accept or reject. If no school improvement plan is accepted for a school within 60 days after its initial submission to the local board, the school or the local board may ask to use the process to resolve disagreements recommended in the guidelines developed by the State Board under G.S. 115C‑105.20(b)(5). If this request is made, both the school and local board shall participate in the process to resolve disagreements. If there is no request to use that process, then the local board may develop a school improvement plan for the school. The General Assembly urges the local board to utilize the school's proposed school improvement plan to the maximum extent possible when developing such a plan.
(e) Effective Period of the Plan. – A school improvement plan shall remain in effect for no more than two years; however, the school improvement team may amend the plan as often as is necessary or appropriate. If, at any time, any part of a school improvement plan becomes unlawful or the local board finds that a school improvement plan is impeding student performance at a school, the local board may vacate the relevant portion of the plan and may direct the school to revise that portion. The procedures set out in this subsection shall apply to amendments and revisions to school improvement plans.
(f) Elimination of Other Unnecessary Plans. – If a local board of education finds that a school improvement plan adequately covers another plan that the local school administrative unit is otherwise required to prepare, the local school administrative unit shall not be required to prepare an additional plan on the matter.
(g) Compliance With Requirements. – Any employee, parent, or other interested individual or organization is encouraged to notify the principal of any concerns regarding compliance with this section. In addition, any employee, parent, or other interested individual or organization may submit in writing to the superintendent concerns regarding compliance with this section. The superintendent shall make a good‑faith effort to investigate the concern. The superintendent shall upon request provide a written response to the concern."
SECTION 8.41.(b) G.S. 143‑318.11(a)(8) reads as rewritten:
"(a) Permitted Purposes. – It is the policy of this State that closed sessions shall be held only when required to permit a public body to act in the public interest as permitted in this section. A public body may hold a closed session and exclude the public only when a closed session is required:
…
(8) To formulate plans by a local board of education relating to emergency response to incidents of school violence or to formulate and adopt the school safety components of school improvement plans by a local board of education or a school improvement team."
SECTION 8.41.(c) This section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
SECTION 8.42. Article 8C of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑105.52. School crisis kits.
The Department of Public Instruction, in consultation with the Department of Public Safety through the North Carolina Center for Safer Schools, may develop and adopt policies on the placement of school crisis kits in schools and on the contents of those kits. The kits should include, at a minimum, basic first‑aid supplies, communications devices, and other items recommended by the International Association of Chiefs of Police.
The principal of each school, in coordination with the law enforcement agencies that are part of the local board of education's emergency response plan, may place one or more crisis kits at appropriate locations in the school."
SCHOOL SAFETY FOR CHARTER SCHOOLS AND REGIONAL SCHOOLS
SECTION 8.43.(a) G.S. 115C‑238.29F is amended by adding a new subsection to read:
"(a1) Emergency Response Plan. – A charter school, in coordination with local law enforcement agencies, is encouraged to adopt an emergency response plan relating to incidents of school violence. These plans are not considered a public record as the term "public record" is defined under G.S. 132‑1 and shall not be subject to inspection and examination under G.S. 132‑6.
Charter schools are encouraged to provide schematic diagrams and keys to the main entrance of school facilities to local law enforcement agencies, in addition to implementing the provisions in G.S. 115C‑105.49(b) and G.S. 115C‑105.52."
SECTION 8.43.(b) G.S. 115C‑238.66 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(7a) Emergency Response Plan. – A regional school, in coordination with local law enforcement agencies, is encouraged to adopt an emergency response plan relating to incidents of school violence. These plans are not considered a public record as the term "public record" is defined under G.S. 132‑1 and shall not be subject to inspection and examination under G.S. 132‑6. Regional schools are encouraged to provide schematic diagrams and keys to the main entrance of school facilities to local law enforcement agencies, in addition to implementing the provisions in G.S. 115C‑105.49(b) and G.S. 115C‑105.52."
SECTION 8.44. The Department of Public Safety, through the North Carolina Center for Safer Schools and in conjunction with the Department of Justice and the Department of Public Instruction, is encouraged to develop school emergency and crisis training modules for school employees and provide them to schools as soon as practicable.
VOLUNTEER SCHOOL SAFETY RESOURCE OFFICER PROGRAM
SECTION 8.45.(a) G.S. 14‑269.2(a) is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(3a) Volunteer school safety resource officer. – A person who volunteers as a school safety resource officer as provided by G.S. 162‑26 or G.S. 160A‑288.4."
SECTION 8.45.(b) G.S. 14‑269.2(g) is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(g) This section shall not apply to any of the following:
…
(7) A volunteer school safety resource officer providing security at a school pursuant to an agreement as provided in G.S. 115C‑47(61) and either G.S. 162‑26 or G.S. 160A‑288.4, provided that the volunteer school safety resource officer is acting in the discharge of the person's official duties and is on the educational property of the school that the officer was assigned to by the head of the appropriate local law enforcement agency."
SECTION 8.45.(c) G.S. 115C‑47 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"§ 115C‑47. Powers and duties generally.
In addition to the powers and duties designated in G.S. 115C‑36, local boards of education shall have the power or duty:
…
(61) To Provide a Safe School Environment. – Local boards of education may enter into an agreement with the sheriff, chief of police of a local police department, or chief of police of a county police department to provide security at the schools by assigning volunteer school safety resource officers who meet the selection standards and criteria developed by the head of the appropriate local law enforcement agency and the criteria set out in G.S. 162‑26 or G.S. 160A‑288.4, as appropriate."
SECTION 8.45.(d) G.S. 160A‑282(c) reads as rewritten:
"(c) The board of commissioners of any county may provide that persons who are deputized by the sheriff of the county as special deputy sheriffs or persons who are serving as volunteer law‑enforcement officers at the request of the sheriff and under his authority, while undergoing official training and while performing duties on behalf of the county pursuant to orders or instructions of the sheriff, shall be entitled to benefits under the North Carolina Workers' Compensation Act and to any fringe benefits for which such persons qualify.
This subsection shall not apply to volunteer school safety resource officers as described in G.S. 162‑26."
SECTION 8.45.(e) Article 3 of Chapter 162 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 162‑26. Sheriff may establish volunteer school safety resource officer program.
(a) The sheriff may establish a volunteer school safety resource officer program to provide nonsalaried special deputies to serve as school safety resource officers in public schools. To be a volunteer in the program, a person must have prior experience as either (i) a sworn law enforcement officer or (ii) a military police officer with a minimum of two years' service. If a person with experience as a military police officer is no longer in the armed services, the person must also have an honorable discharge. A program volunteer must receive training on research into the social and cognitive development of elementary, middle, and high school children and must also meet the selection standards and any additional criteria established by the sheriff.
(b) Each volunteer shall report to the sheriff and shall work under the direction and supervision of the sheriff or the sheriff's designee when carrying out the volunteer's duties as a school safety resource officer. No volunteer may be assigned to a school as a school safety resource officer until the volunteer has updated or renewed the volunteer's law enforcement training and has been certified by the North Carolina Sheriff's Education and Training Standards Commission as meeting the educational and firearms proficiency standards required of persons serving as special deputy sheriffs. A volunteer is not required to meet the physical standards required by the North Carolina Sheriff's Education and Training Standards Commission but must have a standard medical exam to ensure the volunteer is in good health. A person selected by the sheriff to serve as a volunteer under this section shall have the power of arrest while performing official duties as a volunteer school safety resource officer.
(c) The sheriff may enter into an agreement with the local board of education to provide volunteer school safety resource officers who meet both the criteria established by this section and the selection and training requirements set by the sheriff of the county for the schools. The sheriff shall be responsible for the assignment of any volunteer school safety resource officer assigned to a public school and for the supervision of the officer.
(d) There shall be no liability on the part of and no cause of action shall arise against a volunteer school safety resource officer, the Sheriff or employees of the sheriff supervising a volunteer school safety officer, or the public school system or its employees for any good‑faith action taken by them in the performance of their duties with regard to the volunteer school safety resource officer program established pursuant to this section."
SECTION 8.45.(f) Article 13 of Chapter 160A of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 160A‑288.4. Police chief may establish volunteer school safety resource officer program.
(a) The chief of police of a local police department or of a county police department may establish a volunteer school safety resource officer program to provide nonsalaried special law enforcement officers to serve as school safety resource officers in public schools. To be a volunteer in the program, a person must have prior experience as either (i) a sworn law enforcement officer or (ii) a military police officer with a minimum of two years' service. If a person with experience as a military police officer is no longer in the armed services, the person must also have an honorable discharge. A program volunteer must receive training on research into the social and cognitive development of elementary, middle, and high school children and must also meet the selection standards and any additional criteria established by the chief of police.
(b) Each volunteer shall report to the chief of police and shall work under the direction and supervision of the chief of police or the chief's designee when carrying out the volunteer's duties as a school safety resource officer. No volunteer may be assigned to a school as a school safety resource officer until the volunteer has updated or renewed the volunteer's law enforcement training and has been certified by the North Carolina Criminal Justice Education and Training Standards Commission as meeting the educational and firearms proficiency standards required of persons serving as criminal justice officers. A volunteer is not required to meet the physical standards required by the North Carolina Criminal Justice Education and Training Standards Commission but must have a standard medical exam to ensure the volunteer is in good health. A person selected by the chief of police to serve as a volunteer under this section shall have the power of arrest while performing official duties as a volunteer school safety resource officer.
(c) The chief of police may enter into an agreement with the local board of education to provide volunteer school safety resource officers who meet both the criteria established by this section and the selection and training requirements set by the chief of police of the municipality or county in which the schools are located. The chief of police shall be responsible for the assignment of any volunteer school safety resource officer assigned to a public school and for the supervision of the officer.
(d) There shall be no liability on the part of and no cause of action shall arise against a volunteer school safety resource officer, the chief of police or employees of the local law enforcement agency supervising a volunteer school safety officer, or the public school system or its employees for any good‑faith action taken by them in the performance of their duties with regard to the volunteer school safety resource officer program established pursuant to this section."
SECTION 8.45.(g) This section becomes effective December 1, 2013.
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY OVERSIGHT CAPACITY
SECTION 8.46. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4 and subject to the direction, control, and approval of the State Board of Education, the State Superintendent of Public Instruction shall realign existing resources within the Department of Public Instruction to increase the information technology oversight capacity of the Department. The Superintendent shall identify two positions for this purpose in order to establish a Chief Information Officer and a Project Management Officer. The realignment of the positions and resources is subject to the approval of the Office of State Budget and Management.
SECTION 8.48. The State Board of Education shall study and determine needed modifications for authorization and oversight of virtual charter schools, including application requirements, enrollment growth, and funding allocations, and shall prepare these recommendations in the form of draft rules and proposed statutory changes. The State Board shall present the draft rules and the proposed statutory changes to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by February 1, 2014.
This section shall not be construed to affect litigation pending as of the date of the enactment of this section.
PILOT PROGRAM TO RAISE THE HIGH SCHOOL DROPOUT AGE FROM SIXTEEN TO EIGHTEEN
SECTION 8.49.(a) Notwithstanding G.S. 7B‑1501(27), 115C‑378, 115C‑238.66(3), 116‑235(b)(2), and 143B‑805(20), the State Board of Education shall authorize the Hickory Public Schools and the Newton‑Conover City Schools to establish and implement a pilot program to increase the high school dropout age from 16 years of age to the completion of the school year coinciding with the calendar year in which a student reaches 18 years of age, unless the student has previously graduated from high school.
SECTION 8.49.(b) Each local school administrative unit may use any funds available to it to implement the pilot program in accordance with this section to (i) employ up to three additional teachers and (ii) fund additional student‑related costs, such as transportation and technology costs, including additional computers, to serve a greater number of students as a result of the pilot program. Each local school administrative unit may also use any funds available to it to operate a night school program for students at risk of dropping out of high school. To the extent possible, the local school administrative units shall partner with Catawba Valley Community College in administering the pilot program.
SECTION 8.49.(c) The local school administrative units, in collaboration with the State Board of Education, shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Education, and the Senate Appropriations Committee on Education/Higher Education on or before January 1, 2016. The report shall include at least all of the following information:
(1) An analysis of the graduation rate in each local school administrative unit and the impact of the pilot program on the graduation rate.
(2) The teen crime statistics for Catawba County.
(3) The number of reported cases of violations of compulsory attendance laws in Catawba County and the disposition of those cases.
(4) The number of at‑risk students served in any night programs established as part of the pilot program and student graduation and performance outcomes for those students.
(5) All relevant data to assist in determining the effectiveness of the program and specific legislative recommendations, including the continuation, modification, or expansion of the program statewide.
SECTION 8.49.(d) The State Board of Education shall not authorize a pilot program under subsection (a) of this section except upon receipt of a copy of a joint resolution adopted by the boards of education for the Hickory Public Schools and the Newton‑Conover City Schools setting forth a date to begin establishment and implementation of the pilot program.
PART IX. THE EXCELLENT PUBLIC SCHOOLS ACT OF 2013
STATE EMPLOYEE LITERACY VOLUNTEER LEAVE TIME
SECTION 9.1. G.S. 126‑4 reads as rewritten:
"§ 126‑4. Powers and duties of State Personnel Commission.
Subject to the approval of the Governor, the State Personnel Commission shall establish policies and rules governing each of the following:
…
(5b) A leave program that allows employees to volunteer in a literacy program in a public school for up to five hours each month.
…."
SECTION 9.2.(a) G.S. 115C‑174.12(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) The State Board of Education shall establish policies and guidelines necessary for minimizing the time students spend taking tests administered through State and local testing programs, for minimizing the frequency of field testing at any one school, and for otherwise carrying out the provisions of this Article. These policies and guidelines shall include the following:
(1) Schools shall devote no more than two days of instructional time per year to the taking of practice tests that do not have the primary purpose of assessing current student learning;
(2) Students in a school shall not be subject to field tests or national tests during the two‑week period preceding the administration of end‑of‑grade tests, end‑of‑course tests, or the school's regularly scheduled final exams; and
(3) No school shall
participate in more than two field tests at any one grade level during a school
year unless that school volunteers, through a vote of its school improvement
team, to participate in an expanded number of field tests.year.
(4) All annual assessments of student achievement adopted by the State Board of Education pursuant to G.S. 115C‑174.11(c)(1) and (3) and all final exams for courses shall be administered within the final 10 instructional days of the school year for year‑long courses and within the final five instructional days of the semester for semester courses. Exceptions shall be permitted to accommodate a student's individualized education program and section 504 (29 U.S.C. § 794) plans and for the administration of final exams for courses with national or international curricula required to be held at designated times.
These policies shall reflect
standard testing practices to insure reliability and validity of the sample
testing. The results of the field tests shall be used in the final design of
each test. The State Board of Education's policies regarding the testing of
children with disabilities shall (i) provide broad accommodations and alternate
methods of assessment that are consistent with a child's student's individualized
education program and section 504 (29 U.S.C. § 794) plans, (ii) prohibit the
use of statewide tests as the sole determinant of decisions about a child'sstudent's
graduation or promotion, and (iii) provide parents with information about
the Statewide Testing Program and options for studentschildren
with disabilities. The State Board shall report its proposed policies and
proposed changes in policies to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee
prior to adoption.
The State Board of Education may appoint an Advisory Council on Testing to assist in carrying out its responsibilities under this Article."
SECTION 9.2.(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 115C‑174.11(c), the State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee prior to the purchase and implementation of a new assessment instrument to assess student achievement on the Common Core State Standards, including the Common Core Smarter Balance Consortium Assessments. The State Board shall not purchase such an assessment instrument without the enactment of legislation by the General Assembly authorizing the purchase.
SECTION 9.2.(c) This section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
STRENGTHEN TEACHER LICENSURE AND MODIFY LICENSURE FEES
SECTION 9.3.(a) G.S. 115C‑296, as amended by Section 5(b) of S.L. 2013‑226, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑296. Board sets licensure requirements; reports; lateral entry and mentor programs.
…
(a2) The State Board of
Education shall impose the following establish a schedule of fees
for teacher licensure and administrative changes:changes. The fees
established under this subsection shall not exceed the actual cost of providing
the service. The schedule may include fees for any of the following services:
(1) Application for
demographic or administrative changes to a license, $30.00.license.
(2) Application for a
duplicate license or for copies of documents in the licensure files, $30.00.files.
(3) Application for a
renewal, extension, addition, upgrade, reinstatement, and variation to a
license, $55.00.license.
(4) Initial application for a
New, In‑State Approved Program Graduate, $55.00.Graduate.
(5) Initial application for an
Out‑of‑State license, $85.00.license.
(6) All other applications,
$85.00.applications.
TheAn applicant must
pay the feeany nonrefundable service fees at the time thean
application is submitted.
(a3) The State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by March 15 in any year that the amount of fees in the fee schedule established under subsection (a2) of this section has been modified during the previous 12 months. The report shall include the number of personnel paid from licensure receipts, any change in personnel paid from receipts, other related costs covered by the receipts, and the estimated unexpended receipts as of June 30 of the year reported.
…."
SECTION 9.3.(b) G.S. 115C‑296, as amended by Section 5(b) of S.L. 2013‑226, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑296. Board sets licensure requirements; reports; lateral entry and mentor programs.
…
(b) It is the policy of the State of North Carolina to maintain the highest quality teacher education programs and school administrator programs in order to enhance the competence of professional personnel licensed in North Carolina. To the end that teacher preparation programs are upgraded to reflect a more rigorous course of study, the State Board of Education, as lead agency in coordination and cooperation with the University Board of Governors, the Board of Community Colleges and such other public and private agencies as are necessary, shall continue to refine the several licensure requirements, standards for approval of institutions of teacher education, standards for institution‑based innovative and experimental programs, standards for implementing consortium‑based teacher education, and standards for improved efficiencies in the administration of the approved programs.
(1) Licensure Standards. –
a. The licensure program shall provide for initial licensure after completion of preservice training, continuing licensure after three years of teaching experience, and license renewal every five years thereafter, until the retirement of the teacher. The last license renewal received prior to retirement shall remain in effect for five years after retirement. The licensure program shall also provide for lifetime licensure after 50 years of teaching.
b. The State Board of Education, in consultation with the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, shall evaluate and develop enhanced requirements for continuing licensure. The new requirements shall reflect more rigorous standards for continuing licensure and shall be aligned with high‑quality professional development programs that reflect State priorities for improving student achievement. Standards for continuing licensure shall include at least eight continuing education credits with at least three credits required in a teacher's academic subject area.
…
(b2) An undergraduate student
seeking a degree in teacher education must attain passing scores on a
preprofessional skills test prior to admission to an approved teacher education
program in a North Carolina college or university. The State Board of Education
shall permit students to fulfill this requirement by achieving the prescribed
minimum scores set by the State Board of Education for the Praxis I tests or by
achieving the appropriate required score, as determined by the State Board of
Education, on the verbal and mathematics portions of the SAT.SAT or
ACT. The minimum combined verbal and mathematics score set by the State
Board of Education for the SAT shall be between 900 and 1,200.1,100
or greater. The minimum composite score set by the State Board of Education for
the ACT shall be 24 or greater.
(c) It is the policy of the
State of North Carolina to encourage lateral entry into the profession of
teaching by skilled individuals from the private sector. To this end, before
the 1985‑86 school year begins, the State Board of Education shall
develop criteria and procedures to accomplish the employment of such
individuals as classroom teachers. Beginning with the 2006‑2007 school
year, the criteria and procedures shall include preservice training in (i) the
identification and education of children with disabilities and (ii) positive
management of student behavior, effective communication for defusing and
deescalating disruptive or dangerous behavior, and safe and appropriate use of
seclusion and restraint. Skilled individuals who choose to enter the profession
of teaching laterally may be granted a provisionallateral entry teaching
license for no more than three years and shall be required to obtain licensure
before contracting for a fourth year of service with any local administrative
unit in this State.
.…"
SECTION 9.3.(c) G.S. 115C‑296, as amended by Section 5(b) of S.L. 2013‑226, and as rewritten by subsections (a) and (b) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑296. Board sets licensure requirements; reports; lateral entry and mentor programs.
(a) The State Board of
Education shall have entire control of licensing all applicants for teaching
positions in all public elementary and high schools of North Carolina;
and it shall prescribe the rules and regulations for the renewal and extension
of all licenses and shall determine and fix the salary for each grade and type
of license which it authorizes.
The State Board of Education mayshall
require an applicant for an initial bachelors degree certificatelicense
or graduate degree certificatelicense to demonstrate the
applicant's academic and professional preparation by achieving a prescribed
minimum score on a standard examination appropriate and adequate for that
purpose. Elementary Education (K‑6) and special education general
curriculum teachers shall also achieve a prescribed minimum score on subtests
or standard examinations specific to teaching reading and mathematics. The
State Board of Education shall permit an applicant to fulfill any such testing
requirement before or during the applicant's second year of teaching provided
the applicant took the examination at least once during the first year of
teaching. The State Board of Education shall make any required standard initial
licensure exam sufficiently rigorous and raise the prescribed minimum
score as necessary to ensure that each applicant has adequate received
high-quality academic and professional preparation to teach.teach
effectively.
(a1) The State Board shall adopt policies that establish the minimum scores for any required standard examinations and other measures necessary to assess the qualifications of professional personnel as required under subsection (a) of this section. For purposes of this subsection, the State Board shall not be subject to Article 2A of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes. At least 30 days prior to changing any policy adopted under this subsection, the State Board shall provide written notice to all North Carolina schools of education and to all local boards of education. The written notice shall include the proposed revised policy.
(a2) The State Board of Education shall establish a schedule of fees for teacher licensure and administrative changes. The fees established under this subsection shall not exceed the actual cost of providing the service. The schedule may include fees for any of the following services:
(1) Application for demographic or administrative changes to a license.
(2) Application for a duplicate license or for copies of documents in the licensure files.
(3) Application for a renewal, extension, addition, upgrade, reinstatement, and variation to a license.
(4) Initial application for a New, In‑State Approved Program Graduate.
(5) Initial application for an Out‑of‑State license.
(6) All other applications.
An applicant must pay any nonrefundable service fees at the time an application is submitted.
(a3) The State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by March 15 in any year that the amount of fees in the fee schedule established under subsection (a2) of this section has been modified during the previous 12 months. The report shall include the number of personnel paid from licensure receipts, any change in personnel paid from receipts, other related costs covered by the receipts, and the estimated unexpended receipts as of June 30 of the year reported.
(b) It is the policy of the State of North Carolina to maintain the highest quality teacher education programs and school administrator programs in order to enhance the competence of professional personnel licensed in North Carolina. To the end that teacher preparation programs are upgraded to reflect a more rigorous course of study, the State Board of Education, as lead agency in coordination and cooperation with the University Board of Governors, the Board of Community Colleges and such other public and private agencies as are necessary, shall continue to refine the several licensure requirements, standards for approval of institutions of teacher education, standards for institution‑based innovative and experimental programs, standards for implementing consortium‑based teacher education, and standards for improved efficiencies in the administration of the approved programs.
(1) Licensure standards. –
a. The licensure program shall provide for initial licensure after completion of preservice training, continuing licensure after three years of teaching experience, and license renewal every five years thereafter, until the retirement of the teacher. The last license renewal received prior to retirement shall remain in effect for five years after retirement. The licensure program shall also provide for lifetime licensure after 50 years of teaching.
b. The State Board of Education, in consultation with the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, shall evaluate and develop enhanced requirements for continuing licensure. The new requirements shall reflect more rigorous standards for continuing licensure and shall be aligned with high‑quality professional development programs that reflect State priorities for improving student achievement. Standards for continuing licensure shall include at least eight continuing education credits, with at least three credits required in the teacher's academic subject areas. Standards for continuing licensure for elementary and middle school teachers shall include at least three continuing education credits related to literacy. Literacy renewal credits shall include evidence‑based assessment, diagnosis, and intervention strategies for students not demonstrating reading proficiency. Oral language, phonemic and phonological awareness, phonics, vocabulary, fluency, and comprehension shall be addressed in literacy‑related activities leading to license renewal for elementary school teachers.
c. The State Board of Education, in consultation with local boards of education and the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, shall (i) reevaluate and enhance the requirements for renewal of teacher licenses and (ii) consider modifications in the license renewal achievement and to make it a mechanism for teachers to renew continually their knowledge and professional skills.
(2) Teacher education programs. –
a. The State Board of Education, as lead agency in coordination with the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, the North Carolina Independent Colleges and Universities, and any other public and private agencies as necessary, shall continue to raise standards for entry into teacher education programs.
b. Reserved for future codification.
c. To further ensure that teacher preparation programs remain current and reflect a rigorous course of study that is aligned to State and national standards, the State Board of Education, in consultation with the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, shall do all of the following to ensure that students are prepared to teach in elementary schools:
1. Provide students with adequate coursework in the teaching of reading and mathematics.
2. Assess students prior to licensure to determine that they possess the requisite knowledge in scientifically based reading and mathematics instruction that is aligned with the State Board's expectations.
3. Continue to provide students with preparation in applying formative and summative assessments within the school and classroom setting through technology‑based assessment systems available in North Carolina schools that measure and predict expected student improvement.
4. Prepare students to integrate arts across the curriculum.
d. The State Board of Education, in consultation with local boards of education and the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, shall evaluate and modify, as necessary, the academic requirements of teacher preparation programs for students preparing to teach science in middle and high schools to ensure that there is adequate preparation in issues related to science laboratory safety.
e. The standards for
approval of institutions of teacher education shall require that teacher
education programs for all students include the following demonstrated competenciescompetencies:
1. inAll teacher
education programs. –
I. (i) theThe
identification and education of children with disabilities anddisabilities.
II. (ii)
positivePositive management of student behavior and effective
communication techniques for defusing and deescalating disruptive or dangerous
behavior.
2. Elementary and special education general curriculum teacher education programs. –
I. Teaching of reading, including a substantive understanding of reading as a process involving oral language, phonological and phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency, vocabulary, and comprehension.
II. Evidence‑based assessment and diagnosis of specific areas of difficulty with reading development and of reading deficiencies.
III. Appropriate application of instructional supports and services and reading interventions to ensure reading proficiency for all students.
f. The State Board of Education shall incorporate the criteria developed in accordance with G.S. 116‑74.21 for assessing proposals under the School Administrator Training Program into its school administrator program approval standards.
...."
SECTION 9.3.(d) For the 2013‑2014 fiscal year only and notwithstanding Article 2A of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes, the State Board of Education shall be exempt from rulemaking in establishing a schedule of fees for teacher licensure and administrative changes pursuant to G.S. 115C‑296(a2), as amended by this section.
SECTION 9.3.(e) The State Board of Education shall develop a plan to require the schools of education to measure performance and provide an annual report on the demonstrated competencies included in their elementary and special education general curriculum teacher education programs on (i) teaching of reading, including a substantive understanding of reading as a process involving oral language, phonological and phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency, vocabulary, and comprehension; (ii) evidence‑based assessment and diagnosis of specific areas of difficulty with reading development and of reading deficiencies; and (iii) appropriate application of instructional supports and services and reading interventions to ensure reading proficiency for all students. The plan shall address requiring this information to be included in the annual performance reports to the State Board and the higher education educator preparation program report cards required by G.S. 115C‑296, as enacted by this section. The State Board shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on or before March 15, 2014, on the plan to include this information in the performance reports required for the 2014‑2015 school year.
SECTION 9.3.(f) Subsection (b) of this section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year. Subsection (c) of this section applies beginning with the 2014‑2015 school year.
For teachers who are in their fourth or fifth year of their current five‑year license renewal cycle, the changes required by G.S. 115C‑296(b)(1)b., as enacted by subsections (b) and (c) of this section, shall apply beginning with the first year of their next five‑year license renewal cycle.
SECTION 9.4.(a) Section 7A.3(e) of S.L. 2012‑142 is repealed.
SECTION 9.4.(b) Article 8 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new Part to read:
"Part 1B. School Performance.
"§ 115C‑83.11. School achievement, growth, performance scores, and grades.
(a) School Scores and Grades. – The State Board of Education shall award school achievement, growth, and performance scores and an associated performance grade as required by G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., and calculated as provided in this section. The State Board of Education shall enter all necessary data into the Education Value‑Added Assessment System (EVAAS) in order to calculate school performance scores and grades.
(b) Calculation of the School Achievement Score. – In calculating the overall school achievement score earned by schools, the State Board of Education shall total the sum of points earned by a school on all of the following indicators that are measured for that school:
(1) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on annual assessments for mathematics in grades three through eight.
(2) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on annual assessments for reading in grades three through eight.
(3) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on annual assessments for science in grades five and eight.
(4) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on the Algebra I or Integrated Math I end‑of‑course test.
(5) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on the English II end‑of‑course test.(6) One point for each percent of students who score at or above proficient on the Biology end‑of‑course test.
(7) One point for each percent of students who complete the Algebra II or Integrated Math III end‑of‑course test with a passing grade.
(8) One point for each percent of students who achieve the minimum score required for admission into a constituent institution of The University of North Carolina on a nationally normed test of college readiness.
(9) One point for each percent of students enrolled in Career and Technical Education courses who meet the standard when scoring at Silver, Gold, or Platinum levels on a nationally normed test of workplace readiness.
(10) One point for each percent of students who graduate within four years of entering high school.
Each school achievement indicator shall be of equal value when used to determine the overall school achievement score. The overall school achievement score shall be translated to a 100‑point scale and used for school reporting purposes as provided in G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., 115C‑238.29F, and 115C‑238.66.
(c) Calculation of the School Growth Score. – Using EVAAS, the State Board shall calculate the overall growth score earned by schools. In calculating the total growth score earned by schools, the State Board of Education shall weight student growth on the achievement indicators as provided in subsection (b) of this section that have available growth values. The numerical values used to determine whether a school has met, exceeded, or has not met expected growth shall be translated to a 100‑point scale and used for school reporting purposes as provided in G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., 115C‑238.29F, and 115C‑238.66.
(d) Calculation of the School Performance Scores and Grades. – For schools exceeding or not meeting expected school growth, the State Board of Education shall use EVAAS to calculate the school performance score by adding the school achievement score, as provided in subsection (b) of this section, and the school growth score, as provided in subsection (c) of this section, earned by a school. The school achievement score shall account for eighty percent (80%), and the school growth score shall account for (20%) of the total sum. For schools meeting expected growth, and with a school achievement score of eighty percent (80%) or higher, the school performance score shall solely reflect the achievement score. For schools meeting expected growth, and with a school achievement score below eighty percent (80%), the school achievement score shall account for eighty percent (80%), and the school growth score shall account for twenty percent (20%) of the total sum. For all schools, the total school performance score shall be converted to a 100‑point scale and used to determine a school performance grade based on the following scale:
(1) A school performance score of at least 90 is equivalent to an overall school performance grade of A.
(2) A school performance score of at least 80 is equivalent to an overall school performance grade of B.
(3) A school performance score of at least 70 is equivalent to an overall school performance grade of C.
(4) A school performance score of at least 60 is equivalent to an overall school performance grade of D.
(5) A school performance score of less than 60 points is equivalent to an overall school performance grade of F.
(e) Elementary and Middle School Reading and Math Achievement Scores. – For schools serving students in kindergarten through eighth grade, the school achievement scores in reading and mathematics, respectively, shall be reported separately on the annual school report card provided under G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., 115C‑238.29F, and 115C‑238.66.
(f) Indication of Growth. – In addition to awarding the overall school scores for achievement, growth, and performance and the performance grade, using EVAAS, the State Board shall designate that a school has met, exceeded, or has not met expected growth. The designation of student growth shall be clearly displayed in the annual school report card provided under G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., 115C‑238.29F, and 115C‑238.66."
SECTION 9.4.(c) G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1. reads as rewritten:
"c1. To issue an annual
"report card" for the State and for each local school administrative
unit, assessing each unit's efforts to improve student performance based on the
growth in performance of the students in each school and taking into account
progress over the previous years' level of performance and the State's
performance in comparison with other states. This assessment shall take into
account factors that have been shown to affect student performance and that the
State Board considers relevant to assess the State's efforts to improve student
performance. As a part of the annual "report card" for each local
school administrative unit, the State Board shall awardaward, in accordance
with G.S. 115C‑83.11, an overall numerical school achievement,
growth, and performance score on a scale of zero to 100 and a corresponding
performance letter grade of A, B, C, D, or F earned by each school
within the local school administrative unit. The school performance score and
grade shall reflect student performance on annual subject‑specific
assessments, college and workplace readiness measures, and graduation rates.
For schools serving students in any grade from kindergarten to eighth grade, separate
performance scores and grades shall also be awarded based on the school
performance in reading and mathematics respectively. The annual "report
card" for schools serving students in third grade also shall include the
number and percentage of third grade students who (i) take and pass the
alternative assessment of reading comprehension; (ii) were retained in third
grade for not demonstrating reading proficiency as indicated in G.S. 115C‑83.7(a);
and (iii) were exempt from mandatory third grade retention by category of
exemption as listed in G.S. 115C‑83.7(b)."
SECTION 9.4.(d) G.S. 115C‑12(24) reads as rewritten:
"(24) Duty to Develop Standards for Alternative Learning Programs, Provide Technical Assistance on Implementation of Programs, and Evaluate Programs. – The State Board of Education shall adopt standards for assigning students to alternative learning programs. These standards shall include (i) a description of the programs and services that are recommended to be provided in alternative learning programs and (ii) a process for ensuring that an assignment is appropriate for the student and that the student's parents are involved in the decision. The State Board also shall adopt policies that define what constitutes an alternative school and an alternative learning program.
The State Board of Education shall also adopt standards to require that local school administrative units shall use (i) the teachers allocated for students assigned to alternative learning programs pursuant to the regular teacher allotment and (ii) the teachers allocated for students assigned to alternative learning programs only to serve the needs of these students.
The State Board of Education shall provide technical support to local school administrative units to assist them in developing and implementing plans and proposals for alternative learning programs.
The State Board shall evaluate the effectiveness of alternative learning programs and, in its discretion, of any other programs funded from the Alternative Schools/At‑Risk Student allotment. Local school administrative units shall report to the State Board of Education on how funds in the Alternative Schools/At‑Risk Student allotment are spent and shall otherwise cooperate with the State Board of Education in evaluating the alternative learning programs. As part of its evaluation of the effectiveness of these programs, the State Board shall, through the application of the accountability system developed under G.S. 115C‑83.11 and G.S. 115C‑105.35, measure the educational performance and growth of students placed in alternative schools and alternative programs. If appropriate, the Board may modify this system to adapt to the specific characteristics of these schools. Also as part of its evaluation, the State Board shall evaluate its standards adopted under this subdivision and make any necessary changes to those standards based on strategies that have been proven successful in improving student achievement and shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by April 15, 2006 to determine if any changes are necessary to improve the implementation of successful alternative learning programs and alternative schools."
SECTION 9.4.(e) It is the intent of the General Assembly to provide clear information to the public regarding school performance. To this end, the State Board of Education shall do the following when providing information on school report cards as required by G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1.:
(1) Solely use the school performance grade calculation method and resulting scores and grades as provided under G.S. 115C‑83.11, as enacted by this section.
(2) Include a description understandable by members of the general public of the school performance grade calculation method and resulting scores and grades.
SECTION 9.4.(f) The State Board of Education shall issue the first annual report cards under G.S. 115C‑12(9)c1., as amended by this section, no earlier than August 1, 2014.
SECTION 9.4.(g) This section applies beginning with the 2013‑2014 school year.
SECTION 9.5. When a robust evaluation instrument and process that accurately assesses and evaluates the effectiveness of teachers, especially in the area of student growth, is wholly implemented in North Carolina, it is the intent of the General Assembly that the evaluation instrument and process be utilized in the implementation of a plan of performance pay for teachers in this State.
SECTION 9.6.(a) G.S. 115C‑325 is repealed.
SECTION 9.6.(b) Part 3 of Article 22 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding new sections to read:
"§ 115C‑325.1. Definitions.
As used in this Part, the following definitions apply:
(1) "Day" means calendar day. In computing any period of time, Rule 6 of the North Carolina Rules of Civil Procedure shall apply.
(2) "Demote" means to reduce the salary of a person who is classified or paid by the State Board of Education as a classroom teacher or as a school administrator during the time of the contract. The word "demote" does not include (i) a suspension without pay pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325.5(a); (ii) the elimination or reduction of bonus payments, including merit‑based supplements or a systemwide modification in the amount of any applicable local supplement; (iii) any reduction in salary that results from the elimination of a special duty, such as the duty of an athletic coach or a choral director; or (iv) any reduction of pay as compared to a prior term of contract.
(3) "Disciplinary suspension" means a final decision to suspend a teacher or school administrator without pay for no more than 60 days under G.S. 115C‑325.5(b).
(4) "Residential school" means a school operated by the Department of Health and Human Services that provides residential services to students pursuant to Part 3A of Article 3 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes or a school operated pursuant to Article 9C of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes.
(5) "School administrator" means a principal, assistant principal, supervisor, or director whose major function includes the direct or indirect supervision of teaching or any other part of the instructional program, as provided in G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(3).
(6) "Teacher" means a person meeting each of the following requirements:
a. Who holds at least one of the following licenses issued by the State Board of Education:
1. A current standard professional educator's license.
2. A current lateral entry teaching license.
3. A regular, not expired, vocational license.
b. Whose major responsibility is to teach or directly supervise teaching or who is classified by the State Board of Education or is paid either as a classroom teacher or instructional support personnel.
c. Who is employed to fill a full‑time, permanent position.
(7) "Year" means a calendar year beginning July 1 and ending June 30.
"§ 115C‑325.2. Personnel files.
(a) Maintenance of Personnel File. – The superintendent shall maintain in his or her office a personnel file for each teacher that contains any complaint, commendation, or suggestion for correction or improvement about the teacher's professional conduct, except that the superintendent may elect not to place in a teacher's file (i) a letter of complaint that contains invalid, irrelevant, outdated, or false information or (ii) a letter of complaint when there is no documentation of an attempt to resolve the issue. The complaint, commendation, or suggestion shall be signed by the person who makes it and shall be placed in the teacher's file only after five days' notice to the teacher. Any denial or explanation relating to such complaint, commendation, or suggestion that the teacher desires to make shall be placed in the file. Any teacher may petition the local board of education to remove any information from the teacher's personnel file that the teacher deems invalid, irrelevant, or outdated. The board may order the superintendent to remove said information if it finds the information is invalid, irrelevant, or outdated.
(b) Inspection of Personnel Files. – The personnel file shall be open for the teacher's inspection at all reasonable times but shall be open to other persons only in accordance with such rules and regulations as the board adopts. Any preemployment data or other information obtained about a teacher before the teacher's employment by the board may be kept in a file separate from the teacher's personnel file and need not be made available to the teacher. No data placed in the preemployment file may be introduced as evidence at a hearing on the dismissal or demotion of a teacher, except the data may be used to substantiate G.S. 115C‑325.4(a)(7) or G.S. 115C‑325.4(a)(14) as grounds for dismissal or demotion.
"§ 115C‑325.3. Teacher contracts.
(a) Length of Contract. – A contract between the local board of education and a teacher who has been employed by the local board of education for less than three years shall be for a term of one school year. A contract or renewal of contract between the local board of education and a teacher who has been employed by the local board of education for three years or more shall be for a term of one, two, or four school years.
(b) Superintendent Recommendation to Local Board. – Local boards of education shall employ teachers upon the recommendation of the superintendent. If a superintendent intends to recommend to the local board of education that a teacher be offered a new or renewed contract, the superintendent shall submit the recommendation to the local board for action and shall include in the recommendation the length of the term of contract. A superintendent shall only recommend a teacher for a contract of a term longer than one school year if the teacher has shown effectiveness as demonstrated by proficiency on the evaluation instrument. The local board may approve the superintendent's recommendation, may decide not to offer the teacher a new or renewed contract, or may decide to offer the teacher a renewed contract for a different term than recommended by the superintendent.
(c) Dismissal During Term of Contract. – A teacher shall not be dismissed or demoted during the term of the contract except for the grounds and by the procedure set forth in G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(d) Recommendation on Nonrenewal. – If a superintendent decides not to recommend that the local board of education offer a renewed contract to a teacher, the superintendent shall give the teacher written notice of the decision no later than June 1.
(e) Right to Petition for Hearing. – A teacher shall have the right to petition the local board of education for a hearing no later than 10 days after receiving written notice. The local board may, in its discretion, grant a hearing regarding the superintendent's recommendation for nonrenewal. The local board of education shall notify the teacher making the petition of its decision whether to grant a hearing. If the request for a hearing is granted, the local board shall conduct a hearing pursuant to the provisions of G.S. 115C‑45(c) and make a final decision on whether to offer the teacher a renewed contract. The board shall notify a teacher whose contract will not be renewed for the next school year of its decision by June 15; provided, however, if a teacher submits a request for a hearing, the board shall provide the nonrenewal notification within 10 days of the hearing or such later date upon the written consent of the superintendent and teacher. A decision not to offer a teacher a renewed contract shall not be arbitrary, capricious, discriminatory, for personal or political reasons, or on any basis prohibited by State or federal law.
(f) Failure to Offer Contract or Notify on Nonrenewal of Contract. – If a teacher fails to receive a contract offer but does not receive written notification from the superintendent of a recommendation of nonrenewal, and the teacher continues to teach in the local school administrative unit without entering into a contract with the local board, upon discovery of the absence of contract, the board by majority vote shall do one of the following:
(1) Offer the teacher a one-year contract expiring no later than June 30 of the current school year.
(2) Dismiss the teacher and provide the teacher with the equivalent of one additional month's pay. A teacher dismissed as provided in this section shall be considered an at‑will employee and shall not be entitled to a hearing or appeal of the dismissal.
(g) Local boards of education and teachers employed by the local board may mutually modify the terms of the contract to permit part‑time employment. An individual that mutually modifies a full‑time contract to permit part‑time employment or enters into a part‑time contract is not a teacher as defined in G.S. 115C‑325.1(6).
"§ 115C‑325.4. Dismissal or demotion for cause.
(a) Grounds. – No teacher shall be dismissed, demoted, or reduced to employment on a part‑time basis for disciplinary reasons during the term of the contract except for one or more of the following:
(1) Inadequate performance. In determining whether the professional performance of a teacher is adequate, consideration shall be given to regular and special evaluation reports prepared in accordance with the published policy of the employing local school administrative unit and to any published standards of performance which shall have been adopted by the board. Inadequate performance for a teacher shall mean (i) the failure to perform at a proficient level on any standard of the evaluation instrument or (ii) otherwise performing in a manner that is below standard.
(2) Immorality.
(3) Insubordination.
(4) Neglect of duty.
(5) Physical or mental incapacity.
(6) Habitual or excessive use of alcohol or nonmedical use of a controlled substance as defined in Article 5 of Chapter 90 of the General Statutes.
(7) Conviction of a felony or a crime involving moral turpitude.
(8) Advocating the overthrow of the government of the United States or of the State of North Carolina by force, violence, or other unlawful means.
(9) Failure to fulfill the duties and responsibilities imposed upon teachers or school administrators by the General Statutes of this State.
(10) Failure to comply with such reasonable requirements as the board may prescribe.
(11) Any cause which constitutes grounds for the revocation of the teacher's teaching license or the school administrator's administrator license.
(12) Failure to maintain his or her license in a current status.
(13) Failure to repay money owed to the State in accordance with the provisions of Article 60 of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes.
(14) Providing false information or knowingly omitting a material fact on an application for employment or in response to a preemployment inquiry.
(15) A justifiable decrease in the number of positions due to district reorganization, decreased enrollment, or decreased funding.
(b) Dismissal Procedure. – The procedures provided in G.S. 115C‑325.6 shall be followed for dismissals, demotions, or reductions to part‑time employment for disciplinary reasons for any reason specified in subsection (a) of this section.
"§ 115C‑325.5. Teacher suspension.
(a) Immediate Suspension Without Pay. – If a superintendent believes that cause exists for dismissing a teacher for any reason specified in G.S. 115C‑325.4 and that immediate suspension of the teacher is necessary, the superintendent may suspend the teacher without pay. Before suspending a teacher without pay, the superintendent shall meet with the teacher and give him or her written notice of the charges against the teacher, an explanation of the basis for the charges, and an opportunity to respond. Within five days after a suspension under this subsection, the superintendent shall initiate a dismissal, demotion, or disciplinary suspension without pay as provided in this section. If it is finally determined that no grounds for dismissal, demotion, or disciplinary suspension without pay exist, the teacher shall be reinstated immediately, shall be paid for the period of suspension, and all records of the suspension shall be removed from the teacher's personnel file.
(b) Disciplinary Suspension Without Pay. – A teacher recommended for disciplinary suspension without pay may request a hearing before the board. The hearing shall be conducted as provided in G.S. 115C‑325.7. If no request is made within 15 days, the superintendent may file his or her recommendation with the board. If, after considering the recommendation of the superintendent and the evidence adduced at the hearing if one is held, the board concludes that the grounds for the recommendation are true and substantiated by a preponderance of the evidence, the board, if it sees fit, may by resolution order such suspension.
(c) Suspension With Pay. – If a superintendent believes that cause may exist for dismissing or demoting a teacher for any reasons specified in G.S. 115C‑325.4 but that additional investigation of the facts is necessary and circumstances are such that the teacher should be removed immediately from the teacher's duties, the superintendent may suspend the teacher with pay for a reasonable period of time, not to exceed 90 days. The superintendent shall notify the board of education within two days of the superintendent's action and shall notify the teacher within two days of the action and the reasons for it. If the superintendent has not initiated dismissal or demotion proceedings against the teacher within the 90‑day period, the teacher shall be reinstated to the teacher's duties immediately, and all records of the suspension with pay shall be removed from the teacher's personnel file at the teacher's request. However, if the superintendent and the teacher agree to extend the 90‑day period, the superintendent may initiate dismissal or demotion proceedings against the teacher at any time during the period of the extension.
"§ 115C‑325.6. Procedure for dismissal or demotion of a teacher for cause.
(a) Recommendation of Dismissal or Demotion. – A teacher may not be dismissed, demoted, or reduced to part‑time employment for disciplinary reasons during the term of the contract except upon the superintendent's recommendation based on one or more of the grounds in G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(b) Notice of Recommendation. – Before recommending to a board the dismissal or demotion of a teacher, the superintendent shall give written notice to the teacher by certified mail or personal delivery of the superintendent's intention to make such recommendation and shall set forth as part of the superintendent's recommendation the grounds upon which he or she believes such dismissal or demotion is justified. The superintendent also shall meet with the teacher and provide written notice of the charges against the teacher, an explanation of the basis for the charges, and an opportunity to respond if the teacher has not done so under G.S. 115C‑325.5(a). The notice shall include a statement to the effect that the teacher, within 14 days after the date of receipt of the notice, may request a hearing before the board on the superintendent's recommendation. A copy of Part 3 of Article 22 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes shall also be sent to the teacher.
(c) Request for Hearing. – Within 14 days after receipt of the notice of recommendation, the teacher may file with the superintendent a written request for a hearing before the board on the superintendent's recommendation. The superintendent shall submit his or her recommendation to the board. Within five days after receiving the superintendent's recommendation and before taking any formal action, the board shall set a time and place for the hearing and shall notify the teacher by certified mail or personal delivery of the date, time, and place of the hearing. The time specified shall not be less than 10 nor more than 30 days after the board has notified the teacher, unless both parties agree to an extension. The hearing shall be conducted as provided in G.S. 115C‑325.7.
(d) No Request for Hearing. – If the teacher does not request a hearing before the board within the 14 days provided, the superintendent may submit his or her recommendation to the board. The board, if it sees fit, may by resolution (i) reject the superintendent's recommendation or (ii) accept or modify the superintendent's recommendation and dismiss, demote, reinstate, or suspend the teacher without pay.
"§ 115C‑325.7. Hearing before board.
(a) The following procedures shall apply for a board hearing for dismissal, demotion, reduction to part‑time employment for disciplinary reasons, or disciplinary suspension without pay:
(1) The hearing shall be private.
(2) The hearing shall be conducted in accordance with reasonable rules adopted by the State Board of Education to govern such hearings.
(3) At the hearing, the teacher and the superintendent shall have the right to be present and to be heard, to be represented by counsel, and to present through witnesses any competent testimony relevant to the issue of whether grounds exist for a dismissal, demotion, reduction to part‑time employment for disciplinary reasons, or disciplinary suspension without pay.
(4) Rules of evidence shall not apply to a hearing under this subsection, and the board may give probative effect to evidence that is of a kind commonly relied on by reasonably prudent persons in the conduct of serious affairs.
(5) At least five days before the hearing, the superintendent shall provide to the teacher a list of witnesses the superintendent intends to present, a brief statement of the nature of the testimony of each witness, and a copy of any documentary evidence the superintendent intends to present.
(6) At least three days before the hearing, the teacher shall provide the superintendent a list of witnesses the teacher intends to present, a brief statement of the nature of the testimony of each witness, and a copy of any documentary evidence the teacher intends to present.
(7) No new evidence may be presented at the hearing except upon a finding by the board that the new evidence is critical to the matter at issue and the party making the request could not, with reasonable diligence, have discovered and produced the evidence according to the schedule provided in this section.
(8) The board may subpoena and swear witnesses and may require them to give testimony and to produce records and documents relevant to the grounds for dismissal, demotion, reduction to part‑time employment for disciplinary reasons, or disciplinary suspension without pay.
(9) The board shall decide all procedural issues, including limiting cumulative evidence, necessary for a fair and efficient hearing.
(10) The superintendent shall provide for making a transcript of the hearing. The teacher may request and shall receive at no charge a transcript of the proceedings.
"§ 115C‑325.8. Right of appeal.
(a) A teacher who (i) has been dismissed, demoted, or reduced to employment on a part‑time basis for disciplinary reasons during the term of the contract as provided in G.S. 115C‑325.4, or has received a disciplinary suspension without pay as provided in G.S. 115C‑325.5, and (ii) requested and participated in a hearing before the local board of education, shall have a further right of appeal from the final decision of the local board of education to the superior court of the State on one or more of the following grounds that the decision:
(1) Is in violation of constitutional provisions.
(2) Is in excess of the statutory authority or jurisdiction of the board.
(3) Was made upon unlawful procedure.
(4) Is affected by other error of law.
(5) Is unsupported by substantial evidence in view of the entire record as submitted.
(6) Is arbitrary or capricious.
(b) An appeal pursuant to this section must be filed within 30 days of notification of the final decision of the local board of education and shall be decided on the administrative record. The superior court shall have authority to affirm or reverse the local board's decision or remand the matter to the local board of education. The superior court shall not have authority to award monetary damages or to direct the local board of education to enter into an employment contract of more than one year, ending June 30.
"§ 115C‑325.9. Teacher resignation.
(a) Teacher Resignation Following Recommendation for Dismissal. – If a teacher has been recommended for dismissal under G.S. 115C‑325.4 and the teacher chooses to resign without the written agreement of the superintendent, then:
(1) The superintendent shall report the matter to the State Board of Education.
(2) The teacher shall be deemed to have consented to (i) the placement in the teacher's personnel file of the written notice of the superintendent's intention to recommend dismissal and (ii) the release of the fact that the superintendent has reported this teacher to the State Board of Education to prospective employers, upon request. The provisions of G.S. 115C‑321 shall not apply to the release of this particular information.
(3) The teacher shall be deemed to have voluntarily surrendered his or her license pending an investigation by the State Board of Education in a determination whether or not to seek action against the teacher's license. This license surrender shall not exceed 45 days from the date of resignation. Provided further that the cessation of the license surrender shall not prevent the State Board of Education from taking any further action it deems appropriate. The State Board of Education shall initiate investigation within five working days of the written notice from the superintendent and shall make a final decision as to whether to revoke or suspend the teacher's license within 45 days from the date of resignation.
(b) Thirty Days' Notice Resignation Requirement. – A teacher who is not recommended for dismissal should not resign during the term of the contract without the consent of the superintendent unless he or she has given at least 30 days' notice. If a teacher who is not recommended for dismissal does resign during the term of the contract without giving at least 30 days' notice, the board may request that the State Board of Education revoke the teacher's license for the remainder of that school year. A copy of the request shall be placed in the teacher's personnel file.
"§ 115C‑325.10. Application to certain institutions.
Notwithstanding any law or regulation to the contrary, this Part shall apply to all persons employed in teaching and related educational classes in the schools and institutions of the Departments of Health and Human Services and Public Instruction and the Divisions of Juvenile Justice and Adult Correction of the Department of Public Safety, regardless of the age of the students.
"§ 115C‑325.11. Dismissal of school administrators and teachers employed in low‑performing residential schools.
(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this section or any other law, this section shall govern the dismissal by the State Board of Education of teachers, principals, assistant principals, directors, supervisors, and other licensed personnel assigned to a residential school that the State Board has identified as low‑performing and to which the State Board has assigned an assistance team. The State Board shall dismiss a teacher, principal, assistant principal, director, supervisor, or other licensed personnel when the State Board receives two consecutive evaluations that include written findings and recommendations regarding that person's inadequate performance from the assistance team. These findings and recommendations shall be substantial evidence of the inadequate performance of the teacher or school administrator.
(b) The State Board may dismiss a teacher, principal, assistant principal, director, supervisor, or other licensed personnel when:
(1) The State Board determines that the school has failed to make satisfactory improvement after the State Board assigned an assistance team to that school.
(2) That assistance team makes the recommendation to dismiss the teacher, principal, assistant principal, director, supervisor, or other licensed personnel for one or more grounds established in G.S. 115C‑325.4 for dismissal or demotion of a teacher.
Within 30 days of any dismissal under this subsection, a teacher, principal, assistant principal, director, supervisor, or other licensed personnel may request a hearing before a panel of three members designated by the State Board. The State Board shall adopt procedures to ensure that due process rights are afforded to persons recommended for dismissal under this subsection. Decisions of the panel may be appealed on the record to the State Board.
(c) Notwithstanding any other provision of this section or any other law, this subsection shall govern the dismissal by the State Board of licensed staff members who have engaged in a remediation plan under G.S. 115C‑105.38A(c) but who, after one retest, fail to meet the general knowledge standard set by the State Board. The failure to meet the general knowledge standard after one retest shall be substantial evidence of the inadequate performance of the licensed staff member.
Within 30 days of any dismissal under this subsection, a licensed staff member may request a hearing before a panel of three members designated by the State Board. The State Board shall adopt procedures to ensure that due process rights are afforded to licensed staff members recommended for dismissal under this subsection. Decisions of the panel may be appealed on the record to the State Board.
(d) The State Board or the superintendent of a residential school may terminate the contract of a school administrator dismissed under this section. Nothing in this section shall prevent the State Board from refusing to renew the contract of any person employed in a school identified as low‑performing.
(e) Neither party to a school administrator or teacher contract is entitled to damages under this section.
(f) The State Board shall have the right to subpoena witnesses and documents on behalf of any party to the proceedings under this section.
"§ 115C‑325.12. Procedure for dismissal of principals employed in low‑performing schools.
(a) Dismissal of Principals Assigned to Low‑Performing Schools With Assistance Teams. – Notwithstanding any other provision of this Part or any other law, this section governs the State Board's dismissal of principals assigned to low‑performing schools to which the State Board has assigned an assistance team.
(b) Authority of State Board to Dismiss Principal. – The State Board through its designee may, at any time, recommend the dismissal of any principal who is assigned to a low‑performing school to which an assistance team has been assigned. The State Board through its designee shall recommend the dismissal of any principal when the State Board receives from the assistance team assigned to that principal's school two consecutive evaluations that include written findings and recommendations regarding the principal's inadequate performance.
(c) Procedures for Dismissal of Principal. –
(1) If the State Board through its designee recommends the dismissal of a principal under this section, the principal shall be suspended with pay pending a hearing before a panel of three members of the State Board. The purpose of this hearing, which shall be held within 60 days after the principal is suspended, is to determine whether the principal shall be dismissed.
(2) The panel shall order the dismissal of the principal if it determines from available information, including the findings of the assistance team, that the low performance of the school is due to the principal's inadequate performance.
(3) The panel may order the dismissal of the principal if (i) it determines that the school has not made satisfactory improvement after the State Board assigned an assistance team to that school and (ii) the assistance team makes the recommendation to dismiss the principal for one or more grounds established in G.S. 115C‑325.4 for dismissal or demotion of a teacher.
(4) If the State Board or its designee recommends the dismissal of a principal before the assistance team assigned to the principal's school has evaluated that principal, the panel may order the dismissal of the principal if the panel determines from other available information that the low performance of the school is due to the principal's inadequate performance.
(5) In all hearings under this section, the burden of proof is on the principal to establish that the factors leading to the school's low performance were not due to the principal's inadequate performance. In all hearings under this section, the burden of proof is on the State Board to establish that the school failed to make satisfactory improvement after an assistance team was assigned to the school and to establish one or more of the grounds established for dismissal or demotion of a teacher under G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(6) In all hearings under this section, two consecutive evaluations that include written findings and recommendations regarding that principal's inadequate performance from the assistance team are substantial evidence of the inadequate performance of the principal.
(7) The State Board shall adopt procedures to ensure that due process rights are afforded to principals under this section. Decisions of the panel may be appealed on the record to the State Board.
(d) The State Board of Education or a local board may terminate the contract of a principal dismissed under this section.
(e) Neither party to a school administrator contract is entitled to damages under this section.
(f) The State Board shall have the right to subpoena witnesses and documents on behalf of any party to the proceedings under this section.
"§ 115C‑325.13. Procedure for dismissal of teachers employed in low‑performing schools.
(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Part or any other law, this section shall govern the State Board's dismissal of teachers, assistant principals, directors, and supervisors assigned to schools that the State Board has identified as low‑performing and to which the State Board has assigned an assistance team under Article 8B of this Chapter. The State Board shall dismiss a teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor when the State Board receives two consecutive evaluations that include written findings and recommendations regarding that person's inadequate performance from the assistance team. These findings and recommendations shall be substantial evidence of the inadequate performance of the teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor.
(b) The State Board may dismiss a teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor when:
(1) The State Board determines that the school has failed to make satisfactory improvement after the State Board assigned an assistance team to that school under G.S. 115C‑105.38; and
(2) That assistance team makes the recommendation to dismiss the teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor for one or more grounds established in G.S. 115C‑325.4 for dismissal or demotion for cause.
A teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor may request a hearing before a panel of three members of the State Board within 30 days of any dismissal under this section. The State Board shall adopt procedures to ensure that due process rights are afforded to persons recommended for dismissal under this section. Decisions of the panel may be appealed on the record to the State Board.
(c) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Part or any other law, this section shall govern the State Board's dismissal of licensed staff members who have engaged in a remediation plan under G.S. 115C‑105.38A(c) but who, after one retest, fail to meet the general knowledge standard set by the State Board. The failure to meet the general knowledge standard after one retest shall be substantial evidence of the inadequate performance of the licensed staff member.
(d) A licensed staff member may request a hearing before a panel of three members of the State Board within 30 days of any dismissal under this section. The State Board shall adopt procedures to ensure that due process rights are afforded to licensed staff members recommended for dismissal under this section. Decisions of the panel may be appealed on the record to the State Board.
(e) The State Board of Education or a local board may terminate the contract of a teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor dismissed under this section.
(f) Neither party to a school administrator or teacher contract is entitled to damages under this section.
(g) The State Board shall have the right to subpoena witnesses and documents on behalf of any party to the proceedings under this section."
SECTION 9.6.(c) G.S. 115C‑45(c) reads as rewritten:
"(c) Appeals to Board of Education and to Superior Court. – An appeal shall lie to the local board of education from any final administrative decision in the following matters:
(1) The discipline of a student under G.S. 115C‑390.7, 115C‑390.10, or 115C‑390.11;
(2) An alleged violation of a specified federal law, State law, State Board of Education policy, State rule, or local board policy, including policies regarding grade retention of students;
(3) The terms or conditions of employment or employment status of a school employee; and
(4) Any other decision that by statute specifically provides for a right of appeal to the local board of education and for which there is no other statutory appeal procedure.
As used in this subsection, the term "final administrative decision" means a decision of a school employee from which no further appeal to a school administrator is available.
Any person aggrieved by a decision not covered under subdivisions (1) through (4) of this subsection shall have the right to appeal to the superintendent and thereafter shall have the right to petition the local board of education for a hearing, and the local board may grant a hearing regarding any final decision of school personnel within the local school administrative unit. The local board of education shall notify the person making the petition of its decision whether to grant a hearing.
In all appeals to the board it is the duty of the board of education to see that a proper notice is given to all parties concerned and that a record of the hearing is properly entered in the records of the board conducting the hearing.
The board of education may designate hearing panels composed of not less than two members of the board to hear and act upon such appeals in the name and on behalf of the board of education.
An appeal of right brought before
a local board of education under subdivision (1), (2), (3), or (4) of
this subsection may be further appealed to the superior court of the State on
the grounds that the local board's decision is in violation of constitutional
provisions, is in excess of the statutory authority or jurisdiction of the board,
is made upon unlawful procedure, is affected by other error of law, is
unsupported by substantial evidence in view of the entire record as submitted,
or is arbitrary or capricious. However, the right of a noncertified employee
to appeal decisions of a local board under subdivision (3) of this subsection
shall only apply to decisions concerning the dismissal, demotion, or suspension
without pay of the noncertified employee. A noncertified employee may request
and shall be entitled to receive written notice as to the reasons for the
employee's dismissal, demotion, or suspension without pay. The notice shall be
provided to the employee prior to any local board of education hearing on the
issue. This subsection shall not alter the employment status of a noncertified
employee."
SECTION 9.6.(d) G.S. 115C‑287.1 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑287.1. Method of employment of principals, assistant principals, supervisors, and directors.
(a) (1) Beginning
July 1, 1995, allAll persons employed as school administrators shall
be employed pursuant to this section.
(2) Notwithstanding
G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(1), the following school administrators shall be
employed pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325:
a. School
administrators who, as of July 1, 1995, are serving in a principal or supervisor
position with career status in that position; and
b. School
administrators who, as of July 1, 1995, are serving in a principal or
supervisor position and who are eligible to achieve career status on or before
June 30, 1997.
A school
administrator shall cease to be employed pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325
if the school administrator: (i) voluntarily relinquishes career status or the
opportunity to achieve career status through promotion, resignation, or
otherwise; or (ii) is dismissed or demoted or whose contract is not renewed
pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325.
(3) For purposes of this section, school administrator means a:
a. Principal;
b. Assistant principal;
c. Supervisor; or
d. Director,
whose major function includes the direct or indirect supervision of teaching or of any other part of the instructional program.
(4) Nothing in
this section shall be construed to confer career status on any assistant
principal or director, or to make an assistant principal eligible for career
status as an assistant principal or a director eligible for career status as a
director.
(b) Local boards of
education shall employ school administrators who are ineligible for career
status as provided in G.S. 115C‑325(c)(3), upon the
recommendation of the superintendent. The initial contract between a school
administrator and a local board of education shall be for two to four years,
ending on June 30 of the final 12 months of the contract. In the case of a
subsequent contract between a principal or assistant principal and a local
board of education, the contract shall be for a term of four years. In the case
of an initial contract between a school administrator and a local board of
education, the first year of the contract may be for a period of less than 12
months provided the contract becomes effective on or before September 1. A
local board of education may, with the written consent of the school
administrator, extend, renew, or offer a new school administrator's contract at
any time after the first 12 months of the contract so long as the term of the
new, renewed, or extended contract does not exceed four years. Rolling annual
contract renewals are not allowed. Nothing in this section shall be construed
to prohibit the filling of an administrative position on an interim or
temporary basis.
(c) The term of employment
shall be stated in a written contract that shall be entered into between the
local board of education and the school administrator. The school administrator
shall not be dismissed or demoted during the term of the contract except for
the grounds and by the procedure by which a career teacher may be
dismissed or demoted for cause as set forth in G.S. 115C‑325.G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(d) If a superintendent intends to recommend to the local board of education that the school administrator be offered a new, renewed, or extended contract, the superintendent shall submit the recommendation to the local board for action. The local board may approve the superintendent's recommendation or decide not to offer the school administrator a new, renewed, or extended school administrator's contract.
If a superintendent decides not to
recommend that the local board of education offer a new, renewed, or extended
school administrator's contract to the school administrator, the superintendent
shall give the school administrator written notice of his or her decision and
the reasons for his or her decision no later than May 1 of the final year
of the contract. The superintendent's reasons may not be arbitrary, capricious,
discriminatory, personal, or political.political, or prohibited by
State or federal law. No action by the local board or further notice to the
school administrator shall be necessary unless the school administrator files
with the superintendent a written request, within 10 days of receipt of the
superintendent's decision, for a hearing before the local board. Failure to
file a timely request for a hearing shall result in a waiver of the right to
appeal the superintendent's decision. If a school administrator files a timely
request for a hearing, the local board shall conduct a hearing pursuant to the
provisions of G.S. 115C‑45(c) and make a final decision on whether
to offer the school administrator a new, renewed, or extended school
administrator's contract.
If the local board decides not to
offer the school administrator a new, renewed, or extended school
administrator's contract, the local board shall notify the school administrator
of its decision by June 1 of the final year of the contract. A decision not to
offer the school administrator a new, renewed, or extended contract may be for
any cause that is not arbitrary, capricious, discriminatory, personal, or political.political,
or prohibited by State or federal law. The local board's decision not to
offer the school administrator a new, renewed, or extended school administrator's
contract is subject to judicial review in accordance with Article 4 of Chapter
150B of the General Statutes.
(e) Repealed by Session Laws 1995, c. 369, s. 1.
(f) If the superintendent or the local board of education fails to notify a school administrator by June 1 of the final year of the contract that the school administrator will not be offered a new school administrator's contract, the school administrator shall be entitled to 30 days of additional employment or severance pay beyond the date the school administrator receives written notice that a new contract will not be offered.
(g) If, prior to
appointment as a school administrator, the school administrator held career
status as a teacher in the local school administrative unit in which he or she
is employed as a school administrator, a school administrator shall retain
career status as a teacher if the school administrator is not offered a new,
renewed, or extended contract by the local board of education, unless the
school administrator voluntarily relinquished that right or is dismissed or
demoted pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325.
(h) An individual who holds
a provisional assistant principal's certificatelicense and who is
employed as an assistant principal under G.S. 115C‑284(c) shall be
considered a school administrator for purposes of this section. Notwithstanding
subsection (b) of this section, a local board may enter into one‑year
contracts with a school administrator who holds a provisional assistant
principal's certificate.license. If the school administrator
held career status as a teacher in the local school administrative unit prior
to being employed as an assistant principal and the State Board for any reason
does not extend the school administrator's provisional assistant principal's
certificate, the school administrator shall retain career status as a teacher
unless the school administrator voluntarily relinquished that right or is
dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325. Nothing in this
subsection or G.S. 115C‑284(c) shall be construed to require a local
board to extend or renew the contract of a school administrator who holds a
provisional assistant principal's certificate.license."
SECTION 9.6.(e) The State Board of Education shall develop by rule as provided in Article 2A of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes a model contract for use by local boards of education in awarding teacher contracts. The State Board may adopt a temporary rule for a model contract as provided in G.S. 150B‑21.1 to provide a contract to local boards of education no later than January 1, 2014, but shall replace the temporary rule with a permanent rule as soon as practicable.
SECTION 9.6.(f) G.S. 115C‑325(c)(1) through (c)(3) and G.S. 115‑325(c)(5) and (c)(6) are repealed effective August 1, 2013. Individuals who have not received career status prior to the 2013‑2014 school year shall not be granted career status during the 2013‑2014 school year. All teachers who have not been granted career status prior to the 2013‑2014 school year shall be offered only one‑year contracts, except for qualifying teachers offered a four‑year contract as provided in subsection (g) of this section, until the 2018‑2019 school year.
SECTION 9.6.(g) Beginning September 1, 2013, to June 30, 2014, all superintendents shall review the performance and evaluations of all teachers who have been employed by the local board for at least three consecutive years. Based on these reviews, the superintendent shall identify and recommend to the local board twenty‑five percent (25%) of those teachers employed by the local board for at least three consecutive years to be awarded four‑year contracts beginning with the 2014‑2015 school year. The superintendent shall not recommend to the local board any teacher for a four‑year contract unless that teacher has shown effectiveness as demonstrated by proficiency on the teacher evaluation instrument. The local board of education shall review the superintendent's recommendation and may approve that recommendation or may select other teachers as part of the twenty‑five percent (25%) to offer four‑year contracts, but the local board shall not offer any teacher a four‑year contract unless that teacher has shown effectiveness as demonstrated by proficiency on the teacher evaluation instrument. Contract offers shall be made and accepted no later than June 30, 2014. A teacher shall cease to be employed pursuant to G.S. 115C‑325 and voluntarily relinquishes career status or any claim of career status by acceptance of a four‑year contract as provided in this section.
SECTION 9.6.(h) Teachers employed by a local board of education on a four‑year contract beginning with the 2014‑2015 school year shall receive a five hundred dollar ($500.00) annual pay raise for each year of the four‑year contract.
SECTION 9.6.(i) Subsection (a) of this section becomes effective June 30, 2018, and no teacher employed by a local board of education on or after that date shall have career status. G.S. 115C‑325 applies only to teachers with career status after June 30, 2014.
SECTION 9.6.(j) Subsection (b) of this section becomes effective July 1, 2014. G.S. 115C‑325.1 through G.S. 115C‑325.13, as enacted by this section, shall apply to all teachers on one‑ or four‑year contracts beginning July 1, 2014. G.S. 115C‑325.1 through G.S. 115C‑325.13, as enacted by this section, shall apply to all teachers employed by local boards of education or the State on or after July 1, 2018.
SECTION 9.6.(k) Subsections (c) and (d) of this section become effective July 1, 2014, and apply to all employees employed on or after that date.
SECTION 9.6.(l) Except as otherwise provided in this section, this section is effective when this act becomes law.
TEACHER CONTRACT CONFORMING CHANGES
SECTION 9.7.(a) G.S. 115C‑105.26(b)(2) reads as rewritten:
"(2) State rules and
policies, except those pertaining to public school State salary schedules and
employee benefits for school employees, the instructional program that must be
offered under the Basic Education Program, the system of employment for public
school teachers and administrators set out in G.S. 115C‑287.1 and G.S. 115C‑325,in
Part 3 of Article 22 of this Chapter, health and safety codes, compulsory
attendance, the minimum lengths of the school day and year, and the Uniform
Education Reporting System."
SECTION 9.7.(b) G.S. 115C‑105.37B(a)(2) reads as rewritten:
"(2) Restart model, in
which the State Board of Education would authorize the local board of education
to operate the school with the same exemptions from statutes and rules as a charter
school authorized under Part 6A of Article 16 of this Chapter, or under the
management of an educational management organization that has been selected
through a rigorous review process. A school operated under this subdivision
remains under the control of the local board of education, and employees
assigned to the school are employees of the local school administrative unit
with the protections provided by G.S. 115C‑325.Part 3 of
Article 22 of this Chapter."
SECTION 9.7.(c) G.S. 115C‑105.38A reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑105.38A. Teacher competency assurance.
…
(d) Retesting; Dismissal. –
Upon completion of the remediation plan required under subsection (c) of this
section, the certifiedlicensed staff member shall take the
general knowledge test a second time. If the certifiedlicensed
staff member fails to acquire a passing score on the second test, the State
Board shall begin a dismissal proceeding under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2a).G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2a)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
…
(f) Other Actions Not Precluded. – Nothing in this section shall be construed to restrict or postpone the following actions:
(1) The dismissal of a
principal under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(1);G.S. 115C‑325.12.
(2) The dismissal of a
teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2);G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
(3) The dismissal or
demotion of a career an employee for any of the grounds listed
under G.S. 115C‑325(e);G.S. 115C‑325(e) or G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(4) The nonrenewal of a
school administrator's or probationary teacher's contract of employment;
oremployment.
(5) The decision
to grant career status.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(d) G.S. 115C‑105.39 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑105.39. Dismissal or removal of personnel; appointment of interim superintendent.
(a) Within 30 days of the
initial identification of a school as low‑performing, whether by the
local school administrative unit under G.S. 115C‑105.37(a1) or by
the State Board under G.S. 115C‑105.37(a), the superintendent shall
take one of the following actions concerning the school's principal: (i)
recommend to the local board that the principal be retained in the same
position, (ii) recommend to the local board that the principal be retained in
the same position and a plan of remediation should be developed, (iii)
recommend to the local board that the principal be transferred, or (iv) proceed
under G.S. 115C‑325G.S. 115C‑325.4 to
dismiss or demote the principal. The principal may be retained in the same
position without a plan for remediation only if the principal was in that
position for no more than two years before the school is identified as low‑performing.
The principal shall not be transferred to another principal position unless (i)
it is in a school classification in which the principal previously demonstrated
at least 2 years of success, (ii) there is a plan to evaluate and provide
remediation to the principal for at least one year following the transfer to
assure the principal does not impede student performance at the school to which
the principal is being transferred; and (iii) the parents of the students at
the school to which the principal is being transferred are notified. The
principal shall not be transferred to another low‑performing school in
the local school administrative unit. If the superintendent intends to
recommend demotion or dismissal, the superintendent shall notify the local
board. Within 15 days of (i) receiving notification that the superintendent
intends to proceed under G.S. 115C‑325,G.S. 115C‑325.4
or (ii) its decision concerning the superintendent's recommendation, but no
later than September 30, the local board shall submit to the State Board a
written notice of the action taken and the basis for that action. If the State
Board does not assign an assistance team to that school or if the State Board
assigns an assistance team to that school and the superintendent proceeds under
G.S. 115C‑325G.S. 115C‑325.4 to dismiss or
demote the principal, then the State Board shall take no further action. If the
State Board assigns an assistance team to the school and the superintendent is
not proceeding under G.S. 115C‑325G.S. 115C‑325.4
to dismiss or demote the principal, then the State Board shall vote to accept,
reject, or modify the local board's recommendations. The State Board shall
notify the local board of its action within five days. If the State Board
rejects or modifies the local board's recommendations and does not recommend
dismissal of the principal, the State Board's notification shall include
recommended action concerning the principal's assignment or terms of
employment. Upon receipt of the State Board's notification, the local board
shall implement the State Board's recommended action concerning the principal's
assignment or terms of employment unless the local board asks the State Board
to reconsider that recommendation. The State Board shall provide an opportunity
for the local board to be heard before the State Board acts on the local
board's request for a reconsideration. The State Board shall vote to affirm or
modify its original recommended action and shall notify the local board of its
action within five days. Upon receipt of the State Board's notification, the
local board shall implement the State Board's final recommended action
concerning the principal's assignment or terms of employment. If the State
Board rejects or modifies the local board's action and recommends dismissal of
the principal, the State Board shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(1).G.S. 115C‑325.12.
(b) The State Board
shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2) or G.S. 115C‑325.13
for the dismissal of teachers, assistant principals, directors, and supervisors
assigned to a school identified as low‑performing in accordance with G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2).G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(e) G.S. 115C‑238.68(3) reads as rewritten:
"(3) Career status.Leave
of absence from local school administrative unit. – Employees of the
board of directors shall not be eligible for career status. If a teacher
employed by a local school administrative unit makes a written request for a
leave of absence to teach at the regional school, the local school
administrative unit shall grant the leave for one year. For the initial year of
the regional school's operation, the local school administrative unit may
require that the request for a leave of absence be made up to 45 days before
the teacher would otherwise have to report for duty. After the initial year of
the regional school's operation, the local school administrative unit may
require that the request for a leave of absence be made up to 90 days before
the teacher would otherwise have to report for duty. A local board of education
is not required to grant a request for a leave of absence or a request to
extend or renew a leave of absence for a teacher who previously has received a
leave of absence from that school board under this subdivision. A teacher who
has career status under G.S. 115C‑325 prior to receiving a leave of
absence to teach at the regional school may return to a public school in the
local school administrative unit with career status at the end of the leave of
absence or upon the end of employment at the regional school if an appropriate
position is available. If an appropriate position is unavailable, the teacher's
name shall be placed on a list of available teachers in accordance with
G.S. 115C‑325(e)(2)."
SECTION 9.7.(f) G.S. 115C‑276(l) reads as rewritten:
"(l) To Maintain
Personnel Files and to Participate in Firing and Demoting of Staff. – The
superintendent shall maintain in his or her office a personnel file for
each teacher that contains complaints, commendations, or suggestions for
correction or improvement about the teacher and shall participate in the firing
and demoting of staff, as provided in G.S. 115C‑325.Part 3
of Article 22 of this Chapter."
SECTION 9.7.(g) G.S. 115C‑285(a)(7) reads as rewritten:
"(7) All persons employed
as principals in the schools and institutions listed in subsection (p) of G.S. 115C‑325
G.S. 115C‑325.10 shall be compensated at the same rate as
are teachers in the public schools in accordance with the salary schedule
adopted by the State Board of Education."
SECTION 9.7.(h) G.S. 115C‑304 is repealed.
SECTION 9.7.(i) G.S. 115C‑333 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑333. Evaluation of licensed employees including certain superintendents; mandatory improvement plans; State board notification upon dismissal of employees.
(a) Annual Evaluations; Low‑Performing Schools. – Local school administrative units shall evaluate at least once each year all licensed employees assigned to a school that has been identified as low‑performing. The evaluation shall occur early enough during the school year to provide adequate time for the development and implementation of a mandatory improvement plan if one is recommended under subsection (b) of this section. If the employee is a teacher with career status as defined under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6), or a teacher as defined under G.S. 115C‑325.1(6), either the principal, the assistant principal who supervises the teacher, or an assistance team assigned under G.S. 115C‑105.38 shall conduct the evaluation. If the employee is a school administrator as defined under G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(3), either the superintendent or the superintendent's designee shall conduct the evaluation.
All teachers in low‑performing
schools who have not attained career statusbeen employed for less than
three consecutive years shall be observed at least three times annually by
the principal or the principal's designee and at least once annually by a
teacher and shall be evaluated at least once annually by a principal. This
section shall not be construed to limit the duties and authority of an
assistance team assigned to a low‑performing school under G.S. 115C‑105.38.
A local board shall use the performance standards and criteria adopted by the State Board and may adopt additional evaluation criteria and standards. All other provisions of this section shall apply if a local board uses an evaluation other than one adopted by the State Board.
(b) Mandatory Improvement Plans. –
…
(2a) If a licensed employee in
a low‑performing school receives a rating on any standard on an
evaluation that is below proficient or otherwise represents unsatisfactory or
below standard performance in an area that the licensed employee was expected
to demonstrate, the individual or team that conducted the evaluation shall
recommend to the superintendent that (i) the employee receive a mandatory
improvement plan designed to improve the employee's performance or performance,
(ii) the superintendent recommend to the local board that if the
employee is a career status teacher the employee be dismissed or demoted
and if the employee is a teacher on contract the teacher's contract not be
recommended for renewal, or (iii) if the employee engaged in inappropriate
conduct or performed inadequately to such a degree that such conduct or
performance causes substantial harm to the educational environment that a
proceeding for immediate dismissal or demotion be instituted. If the
individual or team that conducted the evaluation elects not to make either any
of the above recommendations, the said individual or team shall notify the
superintendent of this decision. The superintendent shall determine whether to
develop a mandatory improvement planplan, to not recommend renewal of
the employee's contract, or to recommend a dismissal proceeding.
…
(c) Reassessment of
Employee in a Low‑Performing School. – After the expiration of the time
period for the mandatory improvement plan under subdivision (2a) of subsection
(b) of this section, the superintendent, the superintendent's designee, or the
assistance team shall assess the performance of the employee of the low‑performing
school a second time. If the superintendent, superintendent's designee, or
assistance team determines that the employee has failed to become proficient in
any of the performance standards articulated in the mandatory improvement plan
or demonstrate sufficient improvement toward such standards, the superintendent
shall recommend that if the employee is a teacher with career status the
teacher be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325, or if the
employee is a teacher on contract the employee the employee's contract
not be renewed or if the employee has engaged in inappropriate conduct or
performed inadequately to such a degree that such conduct or performance causes
substantial harm to the educational environment, that the employee be immediately
dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325.G.S. 115C‑325.4.
The results of the second assessment shall constitute substantial evidence of
the employee's inadequate performance.
(d) State Board
Notification. – If a local board dismisses an employee of a low‑performing
school who is a teacher with career status for any reason except a
reduction in force under G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)l., or dismisses an
employee who is a teacher on contract for cause or elects to not renew an
employee's contract as a result of a superintendent's recommendation under
subsection (b) or (c) of this section, it shall notify the State Board of
the action, and the State Board annually shall provide to all local boards the
names of those individuals. If a local board hires one of these individuals,
within 60 days the superintendent or the superintendent's designee shall
observe the employee, develop a mandatory improvement plan to assist the
employee, and submit the plan to the State Board. The State Board shall review
the mandatory improvement plan and may provide comments and suggestions to the
superintendent. If on the next evaluation the employee receives a rating on any
standard that was identified as an area of concern on the mandatory improvement
plan that is again below proficient or otherwise represents unsatisfactory or
below standard performance, the local board shall notify the State Board and
the State Board shall initiate a proceeding to revoke the employee's license
under G.S. 115C‑296(d). If on this next evaluation the employee
receives at least a proficient rating on all of the performance standards that
were identified as areas of concern on the mandatory improvement plan, the
local board shall notify the State Board that the employee is in good standing
and the State Board shall not continue to provide the individual's name to
local boards under this subsection unless the employee is a teacher with
career status and is subsequently dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325
except for a reduction in force.force, or the employee is a teacher
on contract subsequently dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325.4.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(j) G.S. 115C‑333.1 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑333.1. Evaluation of teachers in schools not identified as low‑performing; mandatory improvement plans; State Board notification upon dismissal of teachers.
(a) Annual Evaluations. –
All teachers who are assigned to schools that are not designated as low‑performing
and who have not attained career statusbeen employed for at least three
consecutive years shall be observed at least three times annually by the
principal or the principal's designee and at least once annually by a teacher
and shall be evaluated at least once annually by a principal. All teachers with
career status or on a four‑year contract who are assigned to
schools that are not designated as low‑performing shall be evaluated
annually unless a local board adopts rules that allow teachers with career
status or on a four‑year contract to be evaluated more or less
frequently, provided that such rules are not inconsistent with State or federal
requirements. Local boards also may adopt rules requiring the annual evaluation
of nonlicensed employees. A local board shall use the performance standards and
criteria adopted by the State Board and may adopt additional evaluation
criteria and standards. All other provisions of this section shall apply if a
local board uses an evaluation other than one adopted by the State Board.
…
(d) Reassessment of the
Teacher. – Upon completion of a mandatory improvement plan under subsection (b)
of this section, the principal shall assess the performance of the teacher a
second time. The principal shall also review and consider any report provided
by the qualified observer under subsection (c) of this section if one has been
submitted before the end of the mandatory improvement plan period. If, after
the second assessment of the teacher and consideration of any report from the
qualified observer, the superintendent or superintendent's designee determines
that the teacher has failed to become proficient in any of the performance
standards identified as deficient in the mandatory improvement plan or
demonstrate sufficient improvement toward such standards, the superintendent
may recommend that a teacher with career status be dismissed or demoted under
G.S. 115C‑325, or if the teacher is on contract that the teacher's
contract not be renewed or if the teacher has engaged in inappropriate conduct
or performed inadequately to such a degree that such conduct or performance
causes substantial harm to the educational environment, that the teacher be
immediately dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325.G.S. 115C‑325.4.
The results of the second assessment produced pursuant to the terms of this
subsection shall constitute substantial evidence of the teacher's inadequate
performance.
(e) Dismissal Proceedings
Without a Mandatory Improvement Plan. – The absence of a mandatory improvement plan
as described in this section shall not prohibit a superintendent from
initiating a dismissal proceeding against a teacher under the provisions of G.S. 115C‑325.
G.S. 115C‑325 or G.S. 115C‑325.4. However, the
superintendent shall not be entitled to the substantial evidence provision in
subsection (d) of this section if such mandatory improvement plan is not
utilized.
(f) State Board
Notification. – If a local board dismisses a teacher with career status
for any reason except a reduction in force under G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)l.,
or dismisses a teacher on contract for cause or elects to not renew a teacher's
contract as a result of a superintendent's recommendation under subsection (d) of
this section, it shall notify the State Board of the action, and the State
Board annually shall provide to all local boards the names of those teachers.
If a local board hires one of these teachers, within 60 days the superintendent
or the superintendent's designee shall observe the teacher, develop a mandatory
improvement plan to assist the teacher, and submit the plan to the State Board.
The State Board shall review the mandatory improvement plan and may provide
comments and suggestions to the superintendent. If on the next evaluation the
teacher receives a rating on any standard that was an area of concern on the
mandatory improvement plan that is again below proficient or a rating that
otherwise represents unsatisfactory or below standard performance, the local
board shall notify the State Board, and the State Board shall initiate a
proceeding to revoke the teacher's license under G.S. 115C‑296(d).
If on the next evaluation the teacher receives at least a proficient rating on
all of the overall performance standards that were areas of concern on the
mandatory improvement plan, the local board shall notify the State Board that
the teacher is in good standing, and the State Board shall not continue to
provide the teacher's name to local boards under this subsection unless the
teacher has career status and is subsequently dismissed under
G.S. 115C‑325 except for a reduction in force.force or is
a teacher on contract who is subsequently dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325.4.
If, however, on this next evaluation the teacher receives a developing
rating on any standards that were areas of concern on the mandatory improvement
plan, the teacher shall have one more year to bring the rating to proficient.
If,proficient if the local board elects to renew the teacher's contract.
If by the end of this second year,year the teacher is not
proficient in all standards that were areas of concern on the mandatory
improvement plan, the local board shall notify the State Board, and the State
Board shall initiate a proceeding to revoke the teacher's license under
G.S. 115C‑296(d).
…."
SECTION 9.7.(k) G.S. 115C‑335(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Training. – The
State Board, in collaboration with the Board of Governors of The University of
North Carolina, shall develop programs designed to train principals and
superintendents in the proper administration of the employee evaluations
developed by the State Board. The Board of Governors shall use the professional
development programs for public school employees that are under its authority
to make this training available to all principals and superintendents at locations
that are geographically convenient to local school administrative units. The
programs shall include methods to determine whether an employee's performance
has improved student learning, the development and implementation of
appropriate professional growth and mandatory improvement plans, the process
for contract nonrenewal, and the dismissal process under G.S. 115C‑325.Part
3 of Article 22 of this Chapter. The Board of Governors shall ensure that
the subject matter of the training programs is incorporated into the masters in
school administration programs offered by the constituent institutions. The
State Board, in collaboration with the Board of Governors, also shall develop
in‑service programs for licensed public school employees that may be
included in a mandatory improvement plan created under G.S. 115C‑333(b)
or G.S. 115C‑333.1(b). The Board of Governors shall use the
professional development programs for public school employees that are under
its authority to make this training available at locations that are
geographically convenient to local school administrative units."
SECTION 9.7.(l) G.S. 115C‑404(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Documents received
under this section shall be used only to protect the safety of or to improve
the education opportunities for the student or others. Information gained in
accordance with G.S. 7B‑3100 shall not be the sole basis for a
decision to suspend or expel a student. Upon receipt of each document, the
principal shall share the document with those individuals who have (i) direct
guidance, teaching, or supervisory responsibility for the student, and (ii) a
specific need to know in order to protect the safety of the student or others.
Those individuals shall indicate in writing that they have read the document
and that they agree to maintain its confidentiality. Failure to maintain the
confidentiality of these documents as required by this section is grounds for
the dismissal of an employee who is not employed on contract, grounds for
dismissal of an employee on contract not a career employeein
accordance with G.S. 115C‑325.4(a)(9), and is grounds for
dismissal of an employee who is a career employee,teacher in
accordance with G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)i."
SECTION 9.7.(m) G.S. 143B‑146.7(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) At any time after
the State Board identifies a school as low‑performing under this Part,
the Secretary State Board shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑325(p1)
or G.S. 115C‑325.11 for the dismissal of certificatedlicensed
instructional personnel assigned to that school."
SECTION 9.7.(n) G.S. 143B‑146.8 reads as rewritten:
"§
143B‑146.8. Evaluation of certificated licensed personnel
and principals; action plans; State Board notification.
(a) Annual Evaluations; Low‑Performing
Schools. – The principal shall evaluate at least once each year all certificated
licensed personnel assigned to a participating school that has been
identified as low‑performing but has not received an assistance team. The
evaluation shall occur early enough during the school year to provide adequate
time for the development and implementation of an action plan if one is
recommended under subsection (b) of this section. If the employee is a teacher
as defined under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6), G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6)
with career status or a teacher as defined in G.S. 115C‑325.1(6) on
contract, either the principal or an assessment team assigned under
G.S. 143B‑146.9 shall conduct the evaluation. If the employee is a
school administrator as defined under G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(3), the
Superintendent shall conduct the evaluation.
Notwithstanding this subsection or
any other law, the principal shall observe at least three times annually, a
teacher shall observe at least once annually, and the principal shall evaluate
at least once annually, all teachers who have not attained career status.been
employed for less than three consecutive years. All other employees defined
as teachers under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6) with career status or
teachers as defined in G.S. 115C‑325.1(6) on a four‑year
contract who are assigned to participating schools that are not designated
as low‑performing shall be evaluated annually unless the Secretary State
Board adopts rules that allow specified categories of teachers with career
status or on four‑year contracts to be evaluated more or less
frequently. The Secretary State Board also may adopt rules
requiring the annual evaluation of noncertificated nonlicensed personnel.
This section shall not be construed to limit the duties and authority of an
assistance team assigned to a low‑performing school.
The Secretary shall use the
State Board's performance standards and criteria unless the Secretary develops
an alternative evaluation that is properly validated and that includes
standards and criteria similar to those adopted by the State Board. All other
provisions of this section shall apply if an evaluation is used other than one
adopted by the State Board.
(b) Action Plans. – If a certificated
licensed employee in a participating school that has been identified
as low‑performing receives an unsatisfactory or below standard rating on
any function of the evaluation that is related to the employee's instructional
duties, the individual or team that conducted the evaluation shall recommend to
the principal that: (i) the employee receive an action plan designed to improve
the employee's performance; or (ii) the principal recommend to the Secretary
that the employee who is a career teacher be dismissed or demoted
as provided in G.S. 115C‑325 or the employee who is a teacher on
contract not be recommended for renewal; or (iii) if the employee who is a
teacher on contract engages in inappropriate conduct or performs inadequately
to such a degree that such conduct or performance causes substantial harm to
the educational environment that a proceeding for immediate dismissal or
demotion under G.S. 115C‑325.4 be instituted. The principal
shall determine whether to develop an action planplan, to not
recommend renewal of the employee's contract, or to recommend a dismissal
proceeding. The person who evaluated the employee or the employee's supervisor
shall develop the action plan unless an assistance team or assessment team
conducted the evaluation. If an assistance team or assessment team conducted
the evaluation, that team shall develop the action plan in collaboration with the
employee's supervisor. Action plans shall be designed to be completed within 90
instructional days or before the beginning of the next school year. The State Board,
in consultation with the Secretary,Board shall develop guidelines
that include strategies to assist in evaluating certificated licensed
personnel and developing effective action plans within the time allotted
under this section. The Secretary State Board may adopt policies
for the development and implementation of action plans or professional development
plans for personnel who do not require action plans under this section.
(c) Reevaluation. – Upon
completion of an action plan under subsection (b) of this section, the
principal or the assessment team shall evaluate the employee a second time. If
on the second evaluation the employee receives one unsatisfactory or more than
one below standard rating on any function that is related to the employee's
instructional duties, the principal shall recommend that the employee with
career status be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325, or that
an employee's contract not be renewed or if the employee engages in
inappropriate conduct or performs inadequately to such a degree that such
conduct or performance causes substantial harm to the educational environment,
that the employee be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325.G.S. 115C‑325.4.
The results of the second evaluation shall constitute substantial evidence of
the employee's inadequate performance.
(d) State Board
Notification. – If the Secretary dismisses an employee is dismissed for
any reason except a reduction in force under G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)l.,cause
or an employee's contract is not renewed as a result of a superintendent's
recommendation under subsection (b) or (c) of this section, the Secretary
shall notify the State Board shall be notified of the action, and
the State Board annually shall provide to all local boards of education the
names of those individuals. If a local board hires one of these individuals,
that local board shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑333(d).
…."
SECTION 9.7.(o) G.S. 115C‑105.38A, as amended by subsection (c) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑105.38A. Teacher competency assurance.
…
(d) Retesting; Dismissal. –
Upon completion of the remediation plan required under subsection (c) of this
section, the licensed staff member shall take the general knowledge test a
second time. If the licensed staff member fails to acquire a passing score on
the second test, the State Board shall begin a dismissal proceeding under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2a)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
…
(f) Other Actions Not Precluded. – Nothing in this section shall be construed to restrict or postpone the following actions:
(1) The dismissal of a principal under G.S. 115C‑325.12.
(2) The dismissal of a
teacher, assistant principal, director, or supervisor under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
(3) The dismissal or
demotion of an employee for any of the grounds listed under G.S. 115C‑325(e)
or G.S. 115C‑325.4.
(4) The nonrenewal of a school administrator's or teacher's contract of employment.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(p) G.S. 115C‑105.39(b), as amended by subsection (d) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"(b) The State Board
shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2) or G.S. 115C‑325.13
for the dismissal of teachers, assistant principals, directors, and supervisors
assigned to a school identified as low‑performing in accordance with G.S. 115C‑325(q)(2)
or G.S. 115C‑325.13.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(q) G.S. 115C‑238.29F(e)(3) reads as rewritten:
"(3) If a teacher
employed by a local school administrative unit makes a written request for a
leave of absence to teach at a charter school, the local school administrative
unit shall grant the leave for one year. For the initial year of a charter
school's operation, the local school administrative unit may require that the
request for a leave of absence be made up to 45 days before the teacher would
otherwise have to report for duty. After the initial year of a charter school's
operation, the local school administrative unit may require that the request
for a leave of absence be made up to 90 days before the teacher would otherwise
have to report for duty. A local board of education is not required to grant a
request for a leave of absence or a request to extend or renew a leave of absence
for a teacher who previously has received a leave of absence from that school
board under this subdivision. A teacher who has career status under G.S. 115C‑325
prior to receivingreceived a leave of absence to teach at a charter
school may return to a public school in the local school administrative unit with
career status at the end of the leave of absence or upon the end of
employment at the charter school if an appropriate position is available.If
an appropriate position is unavailable, the teacher's name shall be placed on a
list of available teachers and that teacher shall have priority on all
positions for which that teacher is qualified in accordance with G.S. 115C‑325(e)(2)."
SECTION 9.7.(r) G.S. 115C‑238.68(3), as amended by subsection (e) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"(3) Leave of absence
from local school administrative unit. – If a teacher employed by a local
school administrative unit makes a written request for a leave of absence to
teach at the regional school, the local school administrative unit shall grant
the leave for one year. For the initial year of the regional school's
operation, the local school administrative unit may require that the request
for a leave of absence be made up to 45 days before the teacher would otherwise
have to report for duty. After the initial year of the regional school's
operation, the local school administrative unit may require that the request
for a leave of absence be made up to 90 days before the teacher would otherwise
have to report for duty. A local board of education is not required to grant a
request for a leave of absence or a request to extend or renew a leave of
absence for a teacher who previously has received a leave of absence from that
school board under this subdivision. A teacher who has career status under G.S. 115C‑325
prior to receiving received a leave of absence to teach at the
regional school may return to a public school in the local school
administrative unit with career status at the end of the leave of
absence or upon the end of employment at the regional school if an appropriate
position is available. If an appropriate position is unavailable, the
teacher's name shall be placed on a list of available teachers in accordance
with G.S. 115C‑325(e)(2)."
SECTION 9.7.(s) G.S. 115C‑333, as amended by subsection (i) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑333. Evaluation of licensed employees including certain superintendents; mandatory improvement plans; State board notification upon dismissal of employees.
(a) Annual Evaluations; Low‑Performing
Schools. – Local school administrative units shall evaluate at least once each
year all licensed employees assigned to a school that has been identified as
low‑performing. The evaluation shall occur early enough during the school
year to provide adequate time for the development and implementation of a
mandatory improvement plan if one is recommended under subsection (b) of this
section. If the employee is a teacher with career status as defined under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6),
or a teacher as defined under G.S. 115C‑325.1(6), G.S. 115C‑325.1(6)
either the principal, the assistant principal who supervises the teacher,
or an assistance team assigned under G.S. 115C‑105.38 shall conduct
the evaluation. If the employee is a school administrator as defined under
G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(3), either the superintendent or the
superintendent's designee shall conduct the evaluation.
All teachers in low‑performing schools who have been employed for less than three consecutive years shall be observed at least three times annually by the principal or the principal's designee and at least once annually by a teacher and shall be evaluated at least once annually by a principal. This section shall not be construed to limit the duties and authority of an assistance team assigned to a low‑performing school under G.S. 115C‑105.38.
A local board shall use the performance standards and criteria adopted by the State Board and may adopt additional evaluation criteria and standards. All other provisions of this section shall apply if a local board uses an evaluation other than one adopted by the State Board.
(b) Mandatory Improvement Plans. –
…
(2a) If a licensed employee in
a low‑performing school receives a rating on any standard on an
evaluation that is below proficient or otherwise represents unsatisfactory or
below standard performance in an area that the licensed employee was expected
to demonstrate, the individual or team that conducted the evaluation shall
recommend to the superintendent that (i) the employee receive a mandatory
improvement plan designed to improve the employee's performance, (ii) the
superintendent recommend to the local board that if the employee is a career
status teacher the employee be dismissed or demoted and if the employee is a
teacher on contract the teacher's employee's contract not be
recommended for renewal, or (iii) if the employee engaged in inappropriate
conduct or performed inadequately to such a degree that such conduct or
performance causes substantial harm to the educational environment that a
proceeding for immediate dismissal or demotion be instituted. If the individual
or team that conducted the evaluation elects not to make any of the above
recommendations, the said individual or team shall notify the superintendent of
this decision. The superintendent shall determine whether to develop a
mandatory improvement plan, to not recommend renewal of the employee's
contract, or to recommend a dismissal proceeding.
…
(c) Reassessment of
Employee in a Low‑Performing School. – After the expiration of the time
period for the mandatory improvement plan under subdivision (2a) of subsection
(b) of this section, the superintendent, the superintendent's designee, or the
assistance team shall assess the performance of the employee of the low‑performing
school a second time. If the superintendent, superintendent's designee, or
assistance team determines that the employee has failed to become proficient in
any of the performance standards articulated in the mandatory improvement plan
or demonstrate sufficient improvement toward such standards, the superintendent
shall recommend that if the employee is a teacher with career status the
teacher be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325, or if the
employee is a teacher on contract the employee's contract not be renewed or
if the employee has engaged in inappropriate conduct or performed inadequately
to such a degree that such conduct or performance causes substantial harm to
the educational environment, that the employee be immediately dismissed or
demoted under G.S. 115C‑325.4. The results of the second assessment
shall constitute substantial evidence of the employee's inadequate performance.
(d) State Board
Notification. – If a local board dismisses an employee of a low‑performing
school who is a teacher with career status for any reason except a reduction
in force under G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)l., or dismisses an employee who
is a teacher on contract for cause or elects to not renew an employee's
contract as a result of a superintendent's recommendation under subsection (b)
or (c) of this section, it shall notify the State Board of the action, and the
State Board annually shall provide to all local boards the names of those
individuals. If a local board hires one of these individuals, within 60 days
the superintendent or the superintendent's designee shall observe the employee,
develop a mandatory improvement plan to assist the employee, and submit the
plan to the State Board. The State Board shall review the mandatory improvement
plan and may provide comments and suggestions to the superintendent. If on the
next evaluation the employee receives a rating on any standard that was
identified as an area of concern on the mandatory improvement plan that is
again below proficient or otherwise represents unsatisfactory or below standard
performance, the local board shall notify the State Board and the State Board
shall initiate a proceeding to revoke the employee's license under
G.S. 115C‑296(d). If on this next evaluation the employee receives
at least a proficient rating on all of the performance standards that were
identified as areas of concern on the mandatory improvement plan, the local
board shall notify the State Board that the employee is in good standing and
the State Board shall not continue to provide the individual's name to local
boards under this subsection unless the employee is a teacher with career
status and is subsequently dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325 except for
a reduction in force, or the employee is a teacher on contract subsequently
dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325.4.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(t) G.S. 115C‑333.1, as amended by subsection (j) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"§ 115C‑333.1. Evaluation of teachers in schools not identified as low‑performing; mandatory improvement plans; State Board notification upon dismissal of teachers.
(a) Annual Evaluations. –
All teachers who are assigned to schools that are not designated as low‑performing
and who have not been employed for at least three consecutive years shall be
observed at least three times annually by the principal or the principal's
designee and at least once annually by a teacher and shall be evaluated at
least once annually by a principal. All teachers with career status or on a
four‑year contractwho have been employed for three or more years
who are assigned to schools that are not designated as low‑performing
shall be evaluated annually unless a local board adopts rules that allow
teachers with career status or on a four‑year contractemployed
for three or more years to be evaluated more or less frequently, provided
that such rules are not inconsistent with State or federal requirements. Local
boards also may adopt rules requiring the annual evaluation of nonlicensed
employees. A local board shall use the performance standards and criteria
adopted by the State Board and may adopt additional evaluation criteria and
standards. All other provisions of this section shall apply if a local board
uses an evaluation other than one adopted by the State Board.
…
(d) Reassessment of the
Teacher. – Upon completion of a mandatory improvement plan under subsection (b)
of this section, the principal shall assess the performance of the teacher a
second time. The principal shall also review and consider any report provided
by the qualified observer under subsection (c) of this section if one has been
submitted before the end of the mandatory improvement plan period. If, after
the second assessment of the teacher and consideration of any report from the
qualified observer, the superintendent or superintendent's designee determines
that the teacher has failed to become proficient in any of the performance
standards identified as deficient in the mandatory improvement plan or
demonstrate sufficient improvement toward such standards, the superintendent
may recommend that a teacher with career status be dismissed or demoted
under G.S. 115C‑325, or if the teacher is on contract that the
teacher's contract not be renewed renewed, or if the teacher has
engaged in inappropriate conduct or performed inadequately to such a degree that
such conduct or performance causes substantial harm to the educational
environment, that the teacher be immediately dismissed or demoted under
G.S. 115C‑325.4. The results of the second assessment produced
pursuant to the terms of this subsection shall constitute substantial evidence
of the teacher's inadequate performance.
(e) Dismissal Proceedings
Without a Mandatory Improvement Plan. – The absence of a mandatory improvement
plan as described in this section shall not prohibit a superintendent from initiating
a dismissal proceeding against a teacher under the provisions of G.S. 115C‑325
or G.S. 115C‑325.4. However, the superintendent shall not be
entitled to the substantial evidence provision in subsection (d) of this
section if such mandatory improvement plan is not utilized.
(f) State Board
Notification. – If a local board dismisses a teacherwith career status for
any reason except a reduction in force under G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)l.,
or dismisses a teacher on contract for cause or elects to not renew a teacher's
contract as a result of a superintendent's recommendation under subsection (d)
of this section, it shall notify the State Board of the action, and the State
Board annually shall provide to all local boards the names of those teachers.
If a local board hires one of these teachers, within 60 days the superintendent
or the superintendent's designee shall observe the teacher, develop a mandatory
improvement plan to assist the teacher, and submit the plan to the State Board.
The State Board shall review the mandatory improvement plan and may provide
comments and suggestions to the superintendent. If on the next evaluation the
teacher receives a rating on any standard that was an area of concern on the
mandatory improvement plan that is again below proficient or a rating that
otherwise represents unsatisfactory or below standard performance, the local
board shall notify the State Board, and the State Board shall initiate a
proceeding to revoke the teacher's license under G.S. 115C‑296(d).
If on the next evaluation the teacher receives at least a proficient rating on
all of the overall performance standards that were areas of concern on the
mandatory improvement plan, the local board shall notify the State Board that
the teacher is in good standing, and the State Board shall not continue to
provide the teacher's name to local boards under this subsection unless the
teacher has career status and is subsequently dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325
except for a reduction in force or is a teacher on contract who is subsequently
dismissed under G.S. 115C‑325.4. If, however, on this next
evaluation the teacher receives a developing rating on any standards that were
areas of concern on the mandatory improvement plan, the teacher shall have
one more year to bring the rating to proficient if the local board elects
to renew the teacher's contract. If by the end of this second year the teacher
is not proficient in all standards that were areas of concern on the mandatory
improvement plan, the local board shall notify the State Board, and the State
Board shall initiate a proceeding to revoke the teacher's license under
G.S. 115C‑296(d).
…."
SECTION 9.7.(u) Article 23 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑344. Employment benefits for exchange teachers.
An exchange teacher is a nonimmigrant alien teacher participating in an exchange visitor program designated by the United States Department of State pursuant to 22 C.F.R. Part 62 or by the United States Department of Homeland Security pursuant to 8 C.F.R. Part 214.2(q). For purposes of determining eligibility to receive employment benefits under this Chapter, including personal leave, annual vacation leave, and sick leave, an exchange teacher shall be considered a permanent teacher if employed with the expectation of at least six full consecutive monthly pay periods of employment and if employed at least 20 hours per week. An exchange teacher is not a teacher for purposes of the Teachers' and State Employees' Retirement System of North Carolina as provided in G.S. 135‑1(25)."
SECTION 9.7.(v) G.S. 115C‑404(b), as amended by subsection (n) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"(b) Documents received
under this section shall be used only to protect the safety of or to improve
the education opportunities for the student or others. Information gained in
accordance with G.S. 7B‑3100 shall not be the sole basis for a
decision to suspend or expel a student. Upon receipt of each document, the
principal shall share the document with those individuals who have (i) direct
guidance, teaching, or supervisory responsibility for the student, and (ii) a
specific need to know in order to protect the safety of the student or others.
Those individuals shall indicate in writing that they have read the document
and that they agree to maintain its confidentiality. Failure to maintain the
confidentiality of these documents as required by this section is grounds for
the dismissal of an employee who is not employed on contract,contract
and grounds for dismissal of an employee on contract in accordance with G.S. 115C‑325.4(a)(9).G.S. 115C‑325.4(a)(9),
and grounds for dismissal of an employee who is a career teacher in accordance
with G.S. 115C‑325(e)(1)i."
SECTION 9.7.(w) G.S. 143B‑146.7(b), as amended by subsection (m) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"(b) At any time after
the State Board identifies a school as low‑performing under this Part,
the State Board shall proceed under G.S. 115C‑325(p1) or G.S. 115C‑325.11
for the dismissal of licensed instructional personnel assigned to that
school."
SECTION 9.7.(x) G.S. 143B‑146.8, as amended by subsection (n) of this section, reads as rewritten:
"§ 143B‑146.8. Evaluation of licensed personnel and principals; action plans; State Board notification.
(a) Annual Evaluations; Low‑Performing
Schools. – The principal shall evaluate at least once each year all licensed
personnel assigned to a participating school that has been identified as low‑performing
but has not received an assistance team. The evaluation shall occur early
enough during the school year to provide adequate time for the development and
implementation of an action plan if one is recommended under subsection (b) of
this section. If the employee is a teacher as defined under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6)
with career status or a teacher as defined in G.S. 115C‑325.1(6)
on contract,G.S. 115C‑325.1(6), either the principal or
an assessment team assigned under G.S. 143B‑146.9 shall conduct the
evaluation. If the employee is a school administrator as defined under G.S. 115C‑287.1(a)(3),
the Superintendent shall conduct the evaluation.
Notwithstanding this subsection or
any other law, the principal shall observe at least three times annually, a
teacher shall observe at least once annually, and the principal shall evaluate
at least once annually, all teachers who have been employed for less than three
consecutive years. All other employees who have been employed for three or
more years and are defined as teachers under G.S. 115C‑325(a)(6)
with career status or teachers as defined in G.S. 115C‑325.1(5) on a
four‑year contract G.S. 115C‑325.1(6) who are
assigned to participating schools that are not designated as low‑performing
shall be evaluated annually unless the State Board adopts rules that allow
specified categories of teachers with career status or on four year
contractsthree or more years employment to be evaluated more or less
frequently. The State Board also may adopt rules requiring the annual
evaluation of nonlicensed personnel. This section shall not be construed to
limit the duties and authority of an assistance team assigned to a low‑performing
school.
(b) Action Plans. – If a
licensed employee in a participating school that has been identified as low‑performing
receives an unsatisfactory or below standard rating on any function of the
evaluation that is related to the employee's instructional duties, the
individual or team that conducted the evaluation shall recommend to the
principal that: (i) the employee receive an action plan designed to improve the
employee's performance; or (ii) the principal recommend that the employee
who is a career teacher be dismissed or demoted as provided in G.S. 115C‑325
or the employee who is a teacher on contractthe employee's contract
not be recommended for renewal; or (iii) if the employee who is a teacher on
contract engages in inappropriate conduct or performs inadequately to such a
degree that such conduct or performance causes substantial harm to the
educational environment that a proceeding for immediate dismissal or demotion
under G.S. 115C‑325.4 be instituted. The principal shall determine
whether to develop an action plan, to not recommend renewal of the employee's
contract, or to recommend a dismissal proceeding. The person who evaluated the
employee or the employee's supervisor shall develop the action plan unless an
assistance team or assessment team conducted the evaluation. If an assistance
team or assessment team conducted the evaluation, that team shall develop the
action plan in collaboration with the employee's supervisor. Action plans shall
be designed to be completed within 90 instructional days or before the
beginning of the next school year. The State Board shall develop guidelines
that include strategies to assist in evaluating licensed personnel and developing
effective action plans within the time allotted under this section. The State
Board may adopt policies for the development and implementation of action plans
or professional development plans for personnel who do not require action plans
under this section.
(c) Reevaluation. – Upon
completion of an action plan under subsection (b) of this section, the
principal or the assessment team shall evaluate the employee a second time. If
on the second evaluation the employee receives one unsatisfactory or more than
one below standard rating on any function that is related to the employee's
instructional duties, the principal shall recommend that the employee with
career status be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325, or that
an employee onemployee's contract not be renewed renewed, or
if the employee engages in inappropriate conduct or performs inadequately to
such a degree that such conduct or performance causes substantial harm to the
educational environment, that the employee be dismissed or demoted under G.S. 115C‑325.4.
The results of the second evaluation shall constitute substantial evidence of
the employee's inadequate performance.
…."
SECTION 9.7.(y) Subsection (u) of this section becomes effective August 1, 2013. Subsections (a) through (n) of this section become effective July 1, 2014. Subsections (o) through (t) and (v) through (x) become effective June 30, 2018.
PART X. COMMUNITY COLLEGES
REORGANIZATION OF THE COMMUNITY COLLEGES SYSTEM OFFICE
SECTION 10.1.(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, and consistent with the authority established in G.S. 115D‑3, the President of the North Carolina Community College System may reorganize the System Office in accordance with recommendations and plans submitted to and approved by the State Board of Community Colleges.
SECTION 10.1.(b) This section expires June 30, 2014.
CARRYFORWARD OF COLLEGE INFORMATION SYSTEM FUNDS
SECTION 10.2. Of the funds appropriated to the Community Colleges System Office for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium for the College Information System, up to one million two hundred fifty thousand dollars ($1,250,000) shall not revert at the end of each fiscal year but shall remain available until expended. These funds may be used only to purchase periodic system upgrades.
SECTION 10.3.(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the State Board of Community Colleges may authorize a local community college to use up to twenty percent (20%) of the State Literacy Funds allocated to it to provide employability skills, job‑specific occupational and technical skills, and developmental education instruction to students concurrently enrolled in a community college course leading to a high school diploma or equivalent certificate.
SECTION 10.3.(b) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, if a community college is authorized by the State Board to provide employability skills, job‑specific occupational or technical skills, or developmental education instruction to students concurrently enrolled in a community college course leading to a high school diploma or equivalent certificate, the college may waive the tuition and registration fees associated with this instruction.
SECTION 10.4.(a) Beginning with the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, community colleges shall receive funding based on the number of full‑time equivalent (FTE) students enrolled in curriculum, continuing education, and Basic Skills courses, by tiered funding level. Community colleges shall calculate this enrollment as the higher of the current year's total enrollment or the average enrollment of the last two academic years.
The State Board of Community Colleges shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by February 1, 2014, on the use of nonrecurring funds appropriated to it to phase in this new enrollment funding model.
SECTION 10.4.(b) G.S. 115D‑5 is amended by adding a new subsection to read:
"(v) Community colleges may teach technical education, health care, developmental education, and STEM‑related courses at any time during the year, including the summer term. Student membership hours from these courses shall be counted when computing full‑time equivalent students (FTE) for use in budget funding formulas at the State level."
SECTION 10.4.(c) The State Board of Community Colleges shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by October 1, 2014, on FTE for the 2014 summer term.
SECTION 10.4.(d) Subsection (b) of this section is effective when it becomes law and applies beginning with the summer 2014 term.
SECTION 10.4A.(a) It is the intent of the General Assembly that, beginning with the 2014‑2015 fiscal year, the State Board of Community Colleges shall implement a fourth tier in the Tiered Funding Formula adopted by the State Board to allocate funds to community colleges based on the number of full‑time equivalent (FTE) students enrolled in curriculum, continuing education, and Basic Skills courses in order to fund curriculum programs leading to immediate employment at the highest available funding level.
SECTION 10.4A.(b) By March 15, 2014, the State Board of Community Colleges shall report to the House Appropriations Committee, the Senate Appropriations/Base Budget Committee, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Education, and the Senate Appropriations Committee on Education/Higher Education on a plan for implementation of the additional funding level for curriculum programs leading to immediate employment and the feasibility of beginning implementation of an additional funding level for these programs in the 2014‑2015 fiscal year. The State Board shall also include in its report the specific curriculum programs that would be eligible for the additional funding level, the types of immediate employment available for graduates of these programs, and the funding necessary or recommended to adequately implement the programs.
SECTION 10.5.(a) G.S. 115D‑31.3 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115D‑31.3. Institutional performance accountability.
(a) CreationImplementation
of Accountability Measures and Performance Standards. – The State Board of
Community Colleges shall create new adopt and implement a system of accountability
measures and performance standards for the Community College System. TheAt
least once every three years, the State Board of Community Colleges shall review
review, and revise if necessary, annually the accountability
measures and performance standards to ensure that they are appropriate for use
in recognition of successful institutional performance. If the State Board determines
that accountability measures and performance standards must be revised following
a review required by this subsection, the State Board shall report to the Joint
Legislative Education Oversight Committee prior to the implementation of any proposed
revisions.
(b) through (d) Repealed by Session Laws 2000‑67, s. 9.7, effective July 1, 2000.
(e) Mandatory Performance Measures. – The State Board of Community Colleges shall evaluate each college on the following eight performance measures:
(1) Progress of basic skills students.
(2) Passing rate forAttainment
of General Educational Development (GED) diploma examinations.diplomas
by students.
(3) Performance of students who transfer to a four‑year institution.
(4) Success rates of
developmental students in subsequent college‑level English courses.
(5) Success rates of
developmental students in subsequent college‑level math courses.
(5a) Progress of first‑year curriculum students.
(6) Repealed by Session Laws 2012‑142, s. 8.5, effective July 1, 2012.
(7) Curriculum student retention and graduation.
(8) Repealed by Session Laws 2012‑142, s. 8.5, effective July 1, 2012.
(9) Passing rate for Attainment
of licensure and certification examinations.certifications by
students.
The State Board may also evaluate each college on additional performance measures.
(f) Publication of Performance Ratings. – Each college shall publish its performance on the eight measures set out in subsection (e) of this section (i) annually in its electronic catalog or on the Internet and (ii) in its printed catalog each time the catalog is reprinted.
The Community Colleges System Office shall publish the performance of all colleges on all eight measures.
(g) Recognition for of
Successful Institutional Performance. – For the purpose of recognition for
of successful institutional performance, the State Board of
Community Colleges shall evaluate each college on the eight performance measures.
measures set out in subsection (e) of this section. For each of
these eight performance measures on which a college performs successfully, the
college may retain and carry forward into the next fiscal year one‑fourth
of one percent (1/4 of 1%) of its final fiscal year General Fund
appropriations.Subject to the availability of funds, the State Board may
allocate funds among colleges based on the evaluation of each institution's performance,
including at least the following components:
(1) Program quality evaluated by determining a college's rate of student success on each measure as compared to a systemwide performance baseline and goal.
(2) Program impact on student outcomes evaluated by the number of students succeeding on each measure.
(g1) Carryforward of Funds Allocated Based on Performance. – A college that receives funds under subsection (g) of this section may retain and carry forward an amount up to or equal to its performance‑based funding allocation for that year into the next fiscal year.
(h) Recognition for
Exceptional Institutional Performance. – Funds not allocated to colleges in
accordance with subsection (g) of this section shall be used to reward
exceptional institutional performance. A college is deemed to have achieved
exceptional institutional performance if it succeeds on all eight performance
measures. After all State aid budget obligations have been met, the State Board
of Community Colleges shall distribute the remainder of these funds to colleges
that achieve exceptional institutional performance status based on the pro rata
share of total full time equivalent (FTE) students served at each college. The
State Board may withhold the portion of funds for which a college may qualify
as an exceptional institution while the college is under investigation by a
State or federal agency or if its performance does not meet the standards
established by the Southern Association of Colleges and Schools, the State
Auditor's Office, or the State Board of Community Colleges. The State Board may
release the funds at such time as the investigations are complete and the
issues are resolved.
(i) Permissible
Uses of Funds. – Funds retained by colleges or distributed to colleges pursuant
to this section shall be used for the purchase of equipment, initial program
start‑up costs including faculty salaries for the first year of a program,
and one‑time faculty and staff bonuses. These funds shall not be used for
continuing salary increases or for other obligations beyond the fiscal year
into which they were carried forward. These funds shall be encumbered within 12
months of the fiscal year into which they were carried forward.
(j) Use of funds
in low‑wealth counties. – Funds retained by colleges or distributed to
colleges pursuant to this section may be used to supplement local funding for
maintenance of plant if the college does not receive maintenance of plant funds
pursuant to G.S. 115D‑31.2, and if the county in which the main
campus of the community college is located meets all of the following:
(1) Is designated
as a Tier 1 county in accordance with G.S. 143B‑437.08.
(2) Had an unemployment
rate of at least two percent (2%) above the State average or greater than seven
percent (7%), whichever is higher, in the prior calendar year.
(3) Is a county
whose wealth, as calculated under the formula for distributing supplemental
funding for schools in low‑wealth counties, is eighty percent (80%) or
less of the State average.
Funds may be used for this
purpose only after all local funds appropriated for maintenance of plant have
been expended."
SECTION 10.5.(b) Section 9.2(b) of S.L. 1999‑237 is repealed.
SECTION 10.5.(c) Section 8.6 of S.L. 2012‑142 is repealed.
SECTION 10.5.(d) Effective only for the 2011‑2012 reporting year, and notwithstanding G.S. 115D‑31.3, the State Board of Community Colleges shall not require a college to report its performance on the progress of basic skills students as part of the mandatory performance standards prescribed by G.S. 115D‑31.3(e), as amended by this section. In distributing performance‑based funding allocations for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year, notwithstanding G.S. 115D‑31.3, the State Board of Community Colleges shall not consider the progress of basic skills students or the attainment of GED diplomas for the purpose of recognizing successful institutional performance. However, the State Board of Community Colleges shall distribute a portion of the Basic Skills block grant appropriated under this act for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year based on the number of GED diplomas awarded by each college.
SECTION 10.5.(e) Beginning with the 2012‑2013 reporting year, the State Board of Community Colleges shall require a college to report its performance on all eight of the mandatory performance standards prescribed by G.S. 115D‑31.3(e), as amended by this section.
REPEAL OF SENIOR CITIZEN TUITION WAIVER
SECTION 10.6. G.S. 115D‑5(b)(11) is repealed.
STUDY OF THE APPROVAL PROCESS FOR MULTICAMPUS CENTERS
SECTION 10.7. The State Board of Community Colleges shall develop a process for approval of community college multicampus centers. The Board shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by January 1, 2014, on its plan for a multicampus approval process and any statutory changes necessary to implement the plan.
COOPERATION BY THE MANUFACTURING SOLUTIONS CENTER AND THE TEXTILE TECHNOLOGY CENTER
SECTION 10.8.(a) The General Assembly finds that the missions of both the Manufacturing Solutions Center at Catawba Valley Community College and the Textile Technology Center at Gaston College are to help North Carolina manufacturers create and maintain jobs and increase sales.
The Manufacturing Solutions Center accomplishes this mission by (i) enhancing and improving products through research and development; (ii) creating prototypes for new products; (iii) analyzing new materials to enhance structure; (iv) testing products for reliability and quality; (v) training personnel in Lean Manufacturing and Supply Chain strategies; (vi) providing a forum for rollout of new technologies; (vii) providing hands‑on assistance to companies in the areas of international sales and government procurement; and (viii) advocating for industry.
The Textile Technology Center accomplishes this mission by (i) developing a world‑class workforce for the textile industry in North Carolina; (ii) identifying and solving problems confronting the textile industry; and (iii) serving as a statewide center of excellence that serves all components of the textile industry.
SECTION 10.8.(b) The General Assembly further finds that the strategies of the Manufacturing Solutions Center and the Textile Technology Center are complementary and that cooperation by the Centers is in the best interest of the State; therefore, the General Assembly directs the Centers to work cooperatively whenever possible to maximize the State's ability to help North Carolina manufacturers create and maintain jobs and increase sales.
EXPAND INDUSTRIAL AND ENGINEERING TECHNOLOGIES EDUCATION TO FRESHMAN AND SOPHOMORE HIGH SCHOOL STUDENTS
SECTION 10.9.(a) G.S. 115D‑20(4)a.2. reads as rewritten:
"§ 115D‑20. Powers and duties of trustees.
The trustees of each institution shall constitute the local administrative board of such institution, with such powers and duties as are provided in this Chapter and as are delegated to it by the State Board of Community Colleges. The powers and duties of trustees shall include the following:
...
(4) To apply the standards and requirements for admission and graduation of students and other standards established by the State Board of Community Colleges. Notwithstanding any law or administrative rule to the contrary, local community colleges are permitted to offer the following programs:
a. Subject to the approval of the State Board of Community Colleges, local community colleges may collaborate with local school administrative units to offer courses through the following programs:
...
2. Academic transition
pathways for qualified junior and senior high school students that lead to a
career technical education certificate or diploma.diploma and
academic transition pathways for qualified freshmen and sophomore high school
students that lead to a career technical education certificate or diploma in
industrial and engineering technologies."
SECTION 10.9.(b) The Community Colleges System Office shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by October 1, 2014, and October 1, 2015, on freshmen and sophomore students served under G.S. 115D‑20(4)a.2., as amended by subsection (a) of this section. The report shall include the number of and budget FTE for freshmen students and the number of and budget FTE for sophomore students.
CLARIFY EMPLOYEE ACADEMIC ASSISTANCE
SECTION 10.12. G.S. 115D‑5(b1) reads as rewritten:
"(b1) The State Board of Community Colleges shall not waive tuition and registration fees for community college faculty or staff members. Community colleges may, however, use State or local funds to pay tuition and registration fees for one course per semester for full‑time community college faculty or staff members employed for a nine‑, ten‑, eleven‑, or twelve‑month term. Community colleges may also use State and local funds to pay tuition and registration fees for professional development courses and for other courses consistent with the academic assistance program authorized by the State Personnel Commission."
REVISE TARGETED ASSISTANCE CRITERIA
SECTION 10.13. G.S. 115D‑40.1(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Targeted
Assistance. – Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this section, the State Board
may allocate no more than up to ten percent (10%) of the funds
appropriated for Financial Assistance for Community College Students to:to
the following students:
(1) Students who do not
qualify for need‑based assistance but who enroll in low‑enrollment
programs that prepare students for high‑demand occupations, andoccupations.
(2) Students with
disabilities who have been referred by the Department of Health and Human
Services, Division of Vocational RehabilitationRehabilitation, and
are enrolled in a community college."
SECTION 10.14.(a) Of the funds appropriated to Forsyth Technical Community College in fiscal year 2005‑2006 for the construction of the Center for Emerging Technologies at Forsyth Technical Community College, the sum of three million dollars ($3,000,000) for fiscal year 2013‑2014 shall be transferred by the Office of State Budget and Management to Budget Code 26800 to be administered by the North Carolina Community Colleges System Office. The Community Colleges System Office shall allocate up to three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000) of these funds each fiscal year to Forsyth Technical Community College for the operating costs and lease expenses for the community college's biotechnology, nanotechnology, design, and advanced information technology programs; Small Business Center; and Corporate and Industrial Training programs. The Community Colleges System Office shall continue to allocate these funds to Forsyth Technical Community College for this purpose until those funds are expended. No additional State funds shall be made available to Forsyth Technical Community College to be used for the purposes described in this section.
SECTION 10.14.(b) The Office of State Budget and Management shall transfer all funds in Budget Codes 40520 and 40620 that are unencumbered as of July 1, 2013, except those funds to be transferred in accordance with subsection (a) of this section, to Budget Code 16800. Of the funds transferred to Budget Code 16800 under this subsection, the State Board of Community Colleges shall allocate those funds to the community colleges to which the funds were appropriated. These funds shall be used for community college equipment.
CLARIFY COMMUNITY COLLEGE AUDITS
SECTION 10.15.(a) Effective July 1, 2015, G.S. 115D‑5(m) is repealed.
SECTION 10.15.(b) G.S. 115D‑58.16 reads as rewritten:
"§ 115D‑58.16. Audits.
(a) Each community college
shall be auditedsubject to a financial audit a minimum of once
every two years. Community colleges may use State funds to contract with the
State Auditor or with a certified public accountant to perform the audits. The
colleges shall submit the results of the audits to the State Board of Community
Colleges.
The State Board of Community Colleges shall ensure that all colleges are audited in accordance with this section.
(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of Chapter 143D of the General Statutes, a community college shall not be subject to the EAGLE program administered by the Office of the State Controller unless (i) there is a finding of internal control problems in the most recent financial audit of the college or (ii) the State Board of Community Colleges determines that a college should be subject to the program."
SECTION 10.15.(c) A study of the program audit function under G.S. 115D‑5(m) shall be conducted by a committee, located administratively in the Community Colleges System Office, composed of the following 12 members:
(1) The Community Colleges System Office Chief Financial Officer.
(2) Three State Board of Community College members appointed by the chair of the State Board of Community Colleges.
(3) Three college presidents appointed by the North Carolina Association of Community College Presidents.
(4) Three college board of trustee members appointed by the chair of the North Carolina Association of Community College Trustees.
(5) The State Chief Information Officer or designee.
(6) The State Auditor or designee shall serve as a nonvoting member.
The Community Colleges System Office Chief Financial Officer shall chair the committee. The committee shall meet upon the call of the chair. A quorum of the committee shall be a majority of the members.
The committee shall determine how program audit procedures may be streamlined to minimize the administrative burden on the institutions being audited and how funding mechanisms may be changed to reduce reliance on contact hours. The committee shall seek input from community college staff members who are responsible for assistance with the program audits to study the problems associated with the program audit function and potential resolutions for those issues. The committee shall report the results of its study and recommendations to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by January 1, 2015.
SECTION 10.16.(a) Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Community Colleges System Office for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year, the sum of four million eight hundred eight thousand dollars ($4,808,000) shall be used for the North Carolina Back‑to‑Work Program, a retraining program focused on unemployed and underemployed North Carolinians, military veterans, and North Carolina National Guard members. The program shall provide students with occupational skills, employability skills, including a Career Readiness Certificate, and opportunities to earn third‑party, industry recognized credentials. Funds may only be allocated to community colleges whose training plans include support for one or more of the following: (i) employers who have committed to assist colleges with the design and implementation of their training plans and to interview program completers for available jobs; (ii) companies with registered apprenticeship programs with the North Carolina Department of Labor; (iii) coordinated projects among two or more colleges that focus on serving the needs of an industry cluster; or (iv) programs developed in collaboration with the North Carolina National Guard or veterans' organizations. Funds may only be used for the following activities: student instruction, student support and coaching, and targeted financial assistance for students, including assistance with tuition, registration fees, books, and certification costs.
SECTION 10.16.(b) Funds appropriated for the North Carolina Back‑to‑Work Program for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year shall not revert at the end of the fiscal year but shall remain available for the Program.
SECTION 10.16.(c) Subsection (b) of this section becomes effective June 30, 2013.
PART XI. UNIVERSITIES
USE OF ESCHEAT FUND FOR NEED‑BASED FINANCIAL AID PROGRAMS/STUDY SCHOLARSHIPS FOR CHILDREN OF WAR VETERANS PROGRAM
SECTION 11.1.(a) There is appropriated from the Escheat Fund income to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina the sum of sixty‑four million two hundred eighty‑seven thousand two hundred forty‑two dollars ($64,287,242) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of thirty‑seven million two hundred eighty‑seven thousand two hundred forty‑two dollars ($37,287,242) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year to be used for The University of North Carolina Need‑Based Financial Aid Program.
SECTION 11.1.(b) There is appropriated from the Escheat Fund income to the State Board of Community Colleges the sum of fifteen million two hundred forty‑six thousand three hundred seventy‑three dollars ($15,246,373) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of sixteen million three hundred thirty‑five thousand dollars ($16,335,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year to be used for community college grants.
SECTION 11.1.(c) There is appropriated from the Escheat Fund income to the Department of Administration, Division of Veterans Affairs, the sum of seven million six hundred nine thousand five hundred ninety‑one dollars ($7,609,591) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of six million five hundred twenty thousand nine hundred sixty‑four dollars ($6,520,964) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year to be used for need‑based student financial aid.
SECTION 11.1.(d) The funds appropriated by this section shall be allocated by the State Education Assistance Authority (SEAA) for need‑based student financial aid in accordance with G.S. 116B‑7. If the interest income generated from the Escheat Fund is less than the amounts referenced in this section, the difference may be taken from the Escheat Fund principal to reach the appropriations referenced in this section; however, under no circumstances shall the Escheat Fund principal be reduced below the sum required in G.S. 116B‑6(f). If any funds appropriated under this section remain uncommitted for need‑based financial aid as of the end of a fiscal year, the funds shall be returned to the Escheat Fund, but only to the extent the funds exceed the amount of the Escheat Fund income for that fiscal year.
SECTION 11.1.(e) The State Education Assistance Authority shall perform all of the administrative functions necessary to implement this program of financial aid. The SEAA shall conduct periodic evaluations of expenditures of the scholarship programs to determine if allocations are utilized to ensure access to institutions of higher learning and to meet the goals of the respective programs. SEAA may make recommendations for redistribution of funds to The University of North Carolina, Department of Administration, and the President of the Community College System regarding their respective scholarship programs, who then may authorize redistribution of unutilized funds for a particular fiscal year.
SECTION 11.1.(f) G.S. 116B‑7(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) The income derived
from the investment or deposit of the Escheat Fund shall be distributed
annually on or before July 15 August 15 to the State Education
Assistance Authority for grants and loans to aid worthy and needy students who
are residents of this State and are enrolled in public institutions of higher
education in this State. Such grants and loans shall be made upon terms,
consistent with the provisions of this Chapter, pursuant to which the State
Education Assistance Authority makes grants and loans to other students under
G.S. 116‑201 to 116‑209.23, Article 23 of Chapter 116 of the
General Statutes, policies of the Board of Governors of The University of North
Carolina regarding need‑based grants for students of The University of
North Carolina, and policies of the State Board of Community Colleges regarding
need‑based grants for students of the community colleges."
SECTION 11.1.(g) The Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee shall study the Scholarships for Children of War Veterans Program in the Department of Administration and no later than March 1, 2014, shall report its findings to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on General Government, to the Chairs of the Senate Appropriations Committee on General Government and Information Technology, and to the General Assembly. The report shall include findings and recommendations regarding all of the following:
(1) Which State agency is the appropriate entity to administer the program.
(2) Ways in which the Program could be redesigned so as to increase cost predictability. This part of the report shall specifically include recommendations regarding the desirability of imposing time limits and scholarship award maximums on scholarships made available under the Program.
(3) Methods of coordinating with other scholarship programs so as to ensure that non‑State resources are maximized before Program resources are used.
(4) Feasibility of setting a lower tuition rate for recipients of the scholarships who attend a constituent institution of The University of North Carolina or a community college in the North Carolina Community College System.
UNC NEED‑BASED FINANCIAL AID FORWARD FUNDING RESERVE/PROVIDE FUNDS FOR UNC NEED‑BASED GRANTS
SECTION 11.2.(a) It is the intent of the General Assembly to move the UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid Program grant funding into a reserve in the North Carolina Student Loan Fund designated for that purpose so that funds appropriated for grants in a fiscal year are awarded to students for the following academic year. This change will provide additional program stability.
SECTION 11.2.(b) The UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid Forward Funding Reserve (Reserve) is established as a reserve in the North Carolina Student Loan Fund. The funds in the UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid Forward Funding Reserve shall be held in reserve for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year. Beginning with the 2015‑2016 fiscal year, the funds in the Reserve shall be used to fund grants from the UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid Program for the 2015‑2016 program year and each subsequent program year.
SECTION 11.2.(c) Section 6.11(e) of this act appropriates funds from the Education Lottery Fund in the amount of thirty‑two million five hundred thirty thousand three hundred fifty‑nine dollars ($32,530,359) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and in the amount of nineteen million one hundred thirty thousand seven hundred twenty‑eight dollars ($19,130,728) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year to the Reserve. The following funds shall also be transferred to the Reserve:
(1) The sum of fifty‑nine million eight hundred fifty‑nine thousand five hundred sixty‑two dollars ($59,859,562) shall be transferred from the North Carolina Student Loan Fund to the Reserve.
(2) Of the funds appropriated by this act to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the sum of three million four hundred seventy‑five thousand five hundred thirty‑eight dollars ($3,475,538) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of three million four hundred fifty‑four thousand six hundred fifty‑six dollars ($3,454,656) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be transferred to the Reserve.
(3) Notwithstanding G.S. 115C‑296.2, the sum of three million five hundred twenty‑five thousand dollars ($3,525,000) shall be transferred from the fund balance of the National Board Certification Loan program to the Reserve.
(4) The sum of five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000) shall be transferred from the John B. McLendon Scholarship Fund established in G.S. 116‑209.40 to the Reserve.
SECTION 11.2.(d) G.S. 116‑209.40 is repealed.
COORDINATED RESIDENCY DETERMINATION PROCESS
SECTION 11.3.(a) The General Assembly finds that it is in the best interest of the State for the University System, the Community College System, and the State Education Assistance Authority to apply the criteria in G.S. 116‑143.1 to determine residency for tuition purposes in a coordinated and similar manner. Therefore, The University of North Carolina, the North Carolina Community College System, and the State Education Assistance Authority shall jointly develop and implement a coordinated and centralized process to be used by those three entities when determining the residency for tuition purposes of students who apply for admission and are admitted to a constituent institution of The University of North Carolina or a community college under the jurisdiction of the State Board of Community Colleges and for private college students receiving State‑funded financial aid. In developing a centralized residency determination process, The University of North Carolina General Administration, the North Carolina Community College System, and the State Education Assistance Authority shall consult with the North Carolina Independent Colleges and Universities.
SECTION 11.3.(b) No later than January 1, 2014, The University of North Carolina, the North Carolina Community College System, and the State Education Assistance Authority shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee regarding the progress in developing and implementing a coordinated and centralized process and any necessary statutory changes.
UNC MANAGEMENT FLEXIBILITY REDUCTION
SECTION 11.5.(a) The management flexibility reduction for The University of North Carolina shall not be allocated by the Board of Governors to the constituent institutions and affiliated entities using an across‑the‑board method but shall be done in a manner that recognizes the importance of the academic missions and differences among The University of North Carolina entities.
Before taking reductions in instructional budgets, the Board of Governors and the campuses of the constituent institutions shall consider all of the following:
(1) Reducing State funding for centers and institutes, speaker series, and other nonacademic activities.
(2) Faculty workload adjustments.
(3) Restructuring of research activities.
(4) Implementing cost‑saving span of control measures.
(5) Reducing the number of senior and middle management positions.
(6) Eliminating low‑performing, redundant, or low‑enrollment programs.
(7) Using alternative funding sources.
(8) Protecting direct classroom services.
The Board of Governors and the campuses of the constituent institutions also shall review the institutional trust funds and the special funds held by or on behalf of The University of North Carolina and its constituent institutions to determine whether there are monies available in those funds that can be used to assist with operating costs. In addition, the campuses of the constituent institutions also shall require their faculty to have a teaching workload equal to the national average in their Carnegie classification.
SECTION 11.5.(b) In allocating the management flexibility reduction, no reduction in State funds shall be allocated in either fiscal year of the 2013‑2015 biennium to any of the following:
(1) UNC Need‑Based Financial Aid.
(2) North Carolina Need‑Based Scholarship.
(3) Any special responsibility constituent institution which has been granted a basic type designation of "Special Focus Institution" under the Carnegie Classification of Institutions of Higher Education.
(4) Any special responsibility constituent institution which has been granted a basic type designation of "Baccalaureate Colleges–Arts & Sciences" under the Carnegie Classification of Institutions of Higher Education.
(5) Any constituent high school of The University of North Carolina.
SECTION 11.5.(c) The University of North Carolina shall report on the implementation of the management flexibility reduction in subsection (a) of this section to the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division no later than October 1, 2013. This report shall identify both of the following by campus:
(1) The total number of positions eliminated by type (faculty/nonfaculty).
(2) The low‑performing, redundant, and low‑enrollment programs that were eliminated.
UNC BOARD OF GOVERNORS REPORT ON OVERHEAD RECEIPTS
SECTION 11.6.(a) G.S. 116‑11 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(9a) The Board of Governors shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee and the Office of State Budget and Management by March 1 of each year regarding the sum of facilities and administrative fees and overhead receipts for The University of North Carolina that are collected and expended by each constituent institution. The report shall include all of the following information:
a. The collection of facilities and administrative fees and overhead receipts by grant or program.
b. The use of facilities and administrative fees and overhead receipts showing expenditures by grant or program.
c. The sum of facilities and administrative fees and overhead receipts collected or expended by each constituent institution for maintenance and operation of facilities that were constructed with or at any time operated by funds from the General Fund."
SECTION 11.6.(b) Section 31.14 of S.L. 2001‑424 is repealed.
STUDENT CHARGES AT THE NORTH CAROLINA SCHOOL OF SCIENCE AND MATH
SECTION 11.7.(a) G.S. 116‑40.22 reads as rewritten:
"§ 116‑40.22. Management flexibility.
…
(c) Tuition and Fees. –
Notwithstanding any provision in Chapter 116 of the General Statutes to the
contrary, in addition to any tuition and fees set by the Board of Governors
pursuant to G.S. 116‑11(7), the Board of Trustees of the institution
may recommend to the Board of Governors tuition and fees for program‑specific
and institution‑specific needs at that institution without regard to
whether an emergency situation exists and not inconsistent with the actions of
the General Assembly. Any tuition and fees set pursuant to this subsection are
appropriated for use by the institution. Notwithstanding this subsection,
neither the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina nor its
Board of Trustees shall impose any tuition or mandatory fee at the North
Carolina School of Science and Mathematics without the approval of the General Assembly.Assembly,
except as provided in subsection (f) of this section.
…
(f) The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina may approve, upon the recommendation of the Board of Trustees of the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics, the imposition of fees not inconsistent with actions of the General Assembly for distance education services provided by the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics to nonresidents and for students participating in extracurricular enrichment programs sponsored by the School."
SECTION 11.7.(b) G.S. 116‑143 reads as rewritten:
"§ 116‑143. State‑supported institutions of higher education required to charge tuition and fees.
…
(b) In the event that said
students are unable to pay the cost of tuition and required academic fees as
the same may become due, in cash, the said several boards of trustees are
hereby authorized and empowered, in their discretion, to accept the obligation
of the student or students together with such collateral or security as they
may deem necessary and proper, it being the purpose of this Article that all
students in State institutions of higher learning shall be required to pay
tuition, and that free tuition is hereby abolished. Notwithstanding this
section, neither the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina nor
its Board of Trustees shall impose any tuition or mandatory fee at the North
Carolina School of Science and Mathematics without the approval of the General Assembly.Assembly,
except as provided in subsection (e) of this section.
…
(e) The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina may approve, upon the recommendation of the Board of Trustees of the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics, the imposition of fees not inconsistent with actions of the General Assembly for distance education services provided by the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics to nonresidents and for students participating in extracurricular enrichment programs sponsored by the School."
SECTION 11.7.(c) This section applies to the 2013‑2014 spring academic semester and each subsequent academic semester.
STUDENT CHARGES AT THE UNC SCHOOL OF THE ARTS
SECTION 11.8.(a) Article 4 of Chapter 116 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 116‑68.1. Fees.
The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina may set fees, not inconsistent with the actions of the General Assembly, to be paid by in‑State high school students enrolled at the University of North Carolina School of the Arts to assist with expenses of the institution. The Board of Trustees may recommend to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina that fees be set, not inconsistent with actions of the General Assembly, to be paid by in‑State high school students enrolled at the University of North Carolina School of the Arts to assist with expenses of the institution. The University of North Carolina School of the Arts may charge and collect fees established as provided by this section from in‑State high school students enrolled at the University of North Carolina School of the Arts."
SECTION 11.8.(b) This section applies to the 2014‑2015 academic year and each subsequent academic year.
AUTHORIZE STATE EDUCATION ASSISTANCE AUTHORITY TO CONTINUE TO COLLECT NORTH CAROLINA TEACHING FELLOWS REPAYMENTS
SECTION 11.9. Subsection (b) of Section 1.38 of S.L. 2011‑266 is repealed.
UNC DISPOSITION AND ACQUISITION OF REAL PROPERTY
SECTION 11.10.(a) G.S. 116‑198.34(5) reads as rewritten:
"§ 116‑198.34. General powers of Board of Governors.
The Board may exercise any one or more of the following powers:
…
(5) To acquire, hold, lease, and dispose of real and personal property in the exercise of its powers and the performance of its duties hereunder and to lease all or any part of any project or projects and any existing facilities upon such terms and conditions as the Board determines, subject to the provisions of G.S. 143‑341 and Chapter 146 of the General Statutes.
Notwithstanding
G.S. 143‑341 and Chapter 146 of the General Statutes, an
acquisition for a period of 10 years or less or a disposition of 65
years or less by easement, lease, or rental agreement of real property
or space in any building on the Centennial Campus, on the Horace Williams
Campus, on a Millennial Campus, or on a Kannapolis Research Campus made for
a period of 10 years or less shall not require the approval of the Governor
and the Council of State. The Board shall report the acquisitions or
dispositions described in this paragraph of this subdivision to the Department
of Administration for inclusion in the inventory maintained by Department
pursuant to G.S. 143‑341(4)a. and b. and the information regarding those
transactions that is required by G.S. 143‑341(4)a. and b. All
other acquisitions and dispositions made under this subdivision for a period in
excess of 10 years the terms described in this paragraph of this subdivision
are subject to the provisions of G.S. 143‑341 and Chapter 146 of
the General Statutes.
…."
SECTION 11.10.(b) Subsection (d) of Section 9.10 of S.L. 2012‑142 is repealed.
UNC/WAKE FOREST INSTITUTE FOR REGENERATIVE MEDICINE/PROFIT SHARING WITH STATE
SECTION 11.12.(a) Of the funds appropriated by this act for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina the sum of seven million dollars ($7,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of seven million dollars ($7,000,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be allocated to Wake Forest University Health Sciences (hereinafter "Wake Forest") in support of the Wake Forest Institute for Regenerative Medicine (hereinafter "Institute") and its Department of Defense Armed Forces Institute for Regenerative Medicine and current good manufacturing practices (cGMP) facility.
SECTION 11.12.(b) Wake Forest shall reimburse the State for State funds appropriated for the Institute under subsection (a) of this section and in prior fiscal years by returning to the State five percent (5%) of the royalty revenue received by the Institute from commercialized projects arising under those research projects supported by the State funds, either through direct research support or through substantial utilization of the cGMP facility not reimbursed through other funds ("Subject Projects"). Royalty revenue reimbursed to the State shall be subject to all of the following:
(1) The total amount to be reimbursed to the State shall be limited to the aggregate amount of State funds allocated to Wake Forest for the Institute plus simple interest at the rate of four percent (4%) annually from the time of disbursement until reimbursement commences.
(2) Wake Forest shall be entitled to deduct the expenses reasonably incurred in prosecuting, defending, and enforcing patent rights for the Subject Projects, except to the extent the expenses are recovered from a third party, before calculating the amount to be paid to the State.
(3) Calculation of the payments to the State shall be based upon the formula provided in subsection (c) of this section.
(4) Payments shall be made to the State and used by the State in a manner consistent with federal law.
SECTION 11.12.(c) Wake Forest on behalf of the Institute shall annually calculate and remit reimbursement payments to the State based upon the following formula:
(1) Payments to the State shall be based on that share of royalty revenue proportional to the State funds used for the Subject Project, which shall be calculated as the ratio of State funds to total funds used to support the Subject Project, based on budgets developed consistent with federal research funding accounting guidelines and including the fair market value of unreimbursed cGMP facility utilization.
(2) Wake Forest shall calculate net royalty revenue on a Subject Project‑by‑Subject‑Project basis by deducting any expenses authorized under subsection (b)(2) of this section from the total royalty revenue received from the Subject Project.
(3) Wake Forest shall multiply net royalty revenue by the support ratio calculated in subsection (c)(1) of this section and then multiply the product by five percent (5%) to determine the State royalty share ("State Royalty Share").
(4) The State Royalty Share shall be remitted to the State unless the cumulative State Royalty Share payments have satisfied the total aggregate amount to be reimbursed as provided in subsection (b)(1) of this section.
SECTION 11.12.(d) Wake Forest on behalf of the Institute shall comply with the following reporting requirements:
(1) By September 1 of each year, and more frequently as requested, report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina on prior State fiscal year program activities, objectives, and accomplishments and prior State fiscal year itemized expenditures and fund sources. The annual report shall include a report of royalty revenues generated from the Subject Projects.
(2) Provide to the Fiscal Research Division a copy of the Institute's annual audited financial statement within 30 days of issuance of the statement.
SECTION 11.12.(e) Remaining allotments after September 1 shall not be released to the Institute if the reporting requirements provided in subsection (d) of this section are not satisfied.
SECTION 11.12.(f) No more than one hundred twenty thousand dollars ($120,000) in State funds shall be used for the annual salary of any one employee of the Institute. For purposes of this subsection, the term "State funds" means funds appropriated by the State to the Institute and interest earned on those funds.
SECTION 11.12.(g) No State funds shall be used by the Institute (i) to hire or facilitate the hiring of a lobbyist or any person performing the duties or activities of a lobbyist, without regard to the person's title; or (ii) to facilitate any lobbying efforts.
SECTION 11.13. Of the funds appropriated by this act to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the Board of Governors may spend a sum of up to fifteen million dollars ($15,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and a sum of up to fifteen million dollars ($15,000,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year to implement provisions of The University of North Carolina Strategic Plan as set out in the report "Our Time, Our Future: The University of North Carolina Compact with North Carolina."
STUDENT FINANCIAL AID/SEMESTER LIMIT
SECTION 11.15.(a) G.S. 115C‑499.2(6) is repealed.
SECTION 11.15.(b) Article 35A of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115C‑499.2A. Semester limitation on eligibility for scholarship.
(a) Except as otherwise provided by subsection (c) of this section, a student with a matriculated status at a constituent institution of The University of North Carolina shall not receive a scholarship for more than 10 full‑time academic semesters, or its equivalent if enrolled part‑time, unless the student is enrolled in a program officially designated by the Board of Governors as a five‑year degree program. If a student is enrolled in such a five‑year degree program, then the student shall not receive a scholarship for more than 12 full‑time academic semesters or the equivalent if enrolled part‑time.
(b) Except as otherwise provided by subsection (c) of this section, a student with a matriculated status at a community college shall not receive a scholarship for more than six full‑time academic semesters, or the equivalent if enrolled part‑time.
(c) Upon application by a student, the appropriate postsecondary institution may grant a waiver to the student who may then receive a scholarship for the equivalent of one additional full‑time academic semester if the student demonstrates that any of the following have substantially disrupted or interrupted the student's pursuit of a degree, diploma, or certificate: (i) a military service obligation, (ii) serious medical debilitation, (iii) a short‑term or long‑term disability, or (iv) other extraordinary hardship. The Board of Governors or the State Board of Community Colleges, as appropriate, shall establish policies and procedures to implement the waiver provided by this subsection."
SECTION 11.15.(c) Article 3 of Chapter 115D of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 115D‑40.2. Semester limitation on eligibility for North Carolina Community College grants.
(a) Except as otherwise provided by this section, a student shall not receive a need‑based grant from the North Carolina Community College Grant Program for more than six full‑time academic semesters, or the equivalent if enrolled part‑time.
(b) Upon application by a student, the community college may grant a waiver to the student who may then receive a grant from the North Carolina Community College Grant Program for the equivalent of one additional full‑time academic semester if the student demonstrates that any of the following have substantially disrupted or interrupted the student's pursuit of a degree, diploma, or certificate: (i) a military service obligation, (ii) serious medical debilitation, (iii) a short‑term or long‑term disability, or (iv) other extraordinary hardship. The State Board shall establish policies and procedures to implement the waiver provided by this subsection."
SECTION 11.15.(d) G.S. 116‑25.1 reads as rewritten:
"§
116‑25.1. Limit receipt of Semester limitation on eligibility
for The University of North Carolina need‑based financial aid grants
to traditional time period required to earn baccalaureate degree.grants.
(a) Except as otherwise
provided by this section, a student shall not receive a grant from The
University of North Carolina Need‑Based Financial Aid Program for more
than nine 10 full‑time academic semesters, or its
equivalent if enrolled part‑time, unless the student is enrolled in a
program officially designated by the Board of Governors as a five‑year
degree program. If a student is enrolled in such a five‑year degree
program, then the student shall not receive a need‑based grant from The
University of North Carolina Need‑Based Financial Aid Program for more
than 11 12 full‑time academic semesters or its equivalent
if enrolled part‑time.
(b) Upon application by a
student, the student may receive a grant for one additional part‑time
or full‑time academic semester as appropriate, the constituent
institution may grant a waiver to the student who may then receive a grant for
the equivalent of one additional full‑time academic semester if the
student demonstrates that any of the following have substantially disrupted or
interrupted the student's pursuit of a degree: (i) a military service
obligation, (ii) serious medical debilitation, (iii) a short‑term or long‑term
disability, or (iv) other extraordinary hardship, including inability to
enroll in the appropriate courses due to reduced course offerings. hardship.
The Board of Governors shall establish the appropriatepolicies and
procedures to implement the additional semester extensionwaiver
provided by this subsection."
SECTION 11.15.(e) G.S. 116‑281(6) is repealed.
SECTION 11.15.(f) Article 34 of Chapter 116 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 116‑281.1. Semester limitation on eligibility for scholarship.
(a) A student shall not receive a scholarship under this Article for more than 10 full‑time academic semesters, or the equivalent if enrolled part‑time, unless the student is enrolled in a program officially designated by the eligible private postsecondary institution as a five‑year degree program. If a student is enrolled in such a five‑year degree program, then the student shall not receive a scholarship under this Article for more than 12 full‑time academic semesters or the equivalent if enrolled part‑time.
(b) Upon application by a student, the eligible private postsecondary institution may grant a waiver to the student who may then receive a scholarship for the equivalent of one additional full‑time academic semester if the student demonstrates that any of the following have substantially disrupted or interrupted the student's pursuit of a baccalaureate degree: (i) a military service obligation, (ii) serious medical debilitation, (iii) a short‑term or long‑term disability, or (iv) other extraordinary hardship. The eligible private postsecondary institution shall establish policies and procedures to implement the waiver provided by this subsection."
SECTION 11.15.(g) Article 23 of Chapter 116 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 116‑209.19A. Limit semesters eligible for need‑based grants and scholarships.
The Authority administers the following need‑based grant and scholarship programs: the Education Lottery Scholarships, North Carolina Community College Grant Program, The University of North Carolina Need‑Based Financial Aid Program, and Need‑Based Scholarships for Students Attending Private Institutions of Higher Education. G.S. 115C‑499.2A, 115D‑40.2, 116‑25.1, and 116‑281.1 limit the number of semesters that a student may receive a grant or scholarship from any of those programs and also provide the circumstances in which a waiver to those limits may be granted by the appropriate postsecondary institution. The Authority shall enforce these limitations in administering these programs so that unless a waiver is granted by the appropriate postsecondary institution, no student shall receive a grant or scholarship from any of those programs or any combination of those financial aid programs while pursuing a degree, diploma, or certificate for more than any of the following time periods: (i) 10 full‑time academic semesters or its equivalent if enrolled part‑time or (ii) 12 full‑time academic semesters or its equivalent if the student is enrolled in a program officially designated as a five‑year degree program.
A postsecondary institution that grants a waiver under G.S. 115C‑499.2A, 115D‑40.2, 116‑25.1, or 116‑281.1 shall certify the granting of the waiver in a manner acceptable to the Authority and shall also maintain documentation substantiating the reason for the waiver."
SECTION 11.15.(h) The State Education Assistance Authority shall structure its payment schedule to encourage students to complete an average of 30 credit hours per academic year. The State Education Assistance Authority shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by March 1, 2014, regarding the measures implemented by the Authority pursuant to this subsection.
SECTION 11.15.(i) This section applies to the 2014‑2015 academic year and each subsequent academic year.
STUDY SCHOOL OF SCIENCE AND MATHEMATICS/MORGANTON CAMPUS
SECTION 11.16.(a) The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics (School of Science and Math), and the Department of Public Instruction shall jointly study the feasibility of establishing a western campus for the School of Science and Math at the School for the Deaf in Morganton. In its study, the Board of Governors, the School of Science and Math, and the Department of Public Instruction shall consider the number of students with excellent academic records who apply to the School of Science and Math but are not accepted because of the School's lack of physical space to accommodate additional students. They may also consult with the Department of Administration regarding what, if any, renovations would be required at the School for the Deaf if a western campus for the School of Science and Math were located at that facility.
If it is determined that the School for the Deaf is not a suitable site for the location of a western campus, the Board of Governors, School of Science and Math, and the Department of Public Instruction in consultation with the Department of Administration may consider other sites in western North Carolina that are available as a site.
SECTION 11.16.(b) The Department of Administration shall, upon request by the Board of Governors, the North Carolina School of Science and Math, and the Department of Public Instruction, provide information regarding renovations that may be required to locate a western campus for the School of Science and Math at the School for the Deaf and shall also provide, upon request, information regarding other State‑owned real property that may be available for such a purpose.
SECTION 11.16.(c) The Board of Governors, the School of Science and Math, and the Department of Public Instruction shall report their findings and recommendations to the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Education by February 1, 2014.
STUDY NC GUARANTEED ADMISSION PROGRAM
SECTION 11.17.(a) The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina and the State Board of Community Colleges shall jointly study the feasibility of establishing an alternative undergraduate admission program to be known as the North Carolina Guaranteed Admission Program (NC GAP). The goals of NC GAP shall be to encourage and assist more students to obtain a baccalaureate degree within a shorter time period; to provide students with a college education at significantly lower costs for both the student and the State; to help decrease the amount of debt resulting from loans that a student may owe upon graduation; to provide a student with an interim degree that may increase a student's job opportunities if the student chooses not to continue postsecondary education; and to provide easier access to academic counseling that will assist a student in selecting coursework that reflects the student's educational and career goals and helps the student succeed academically.
NC GAP shall be designed as an alternative admission program for students who apply for admission to a constituent institution and satisfy the admission criteria but whose academic credentials are not as competitive as other students admitted to the institution. A student admitted to a constituent institution through NC GAP must agree to defer enrollment at the institution until the student earns an associate degree from one of the State's community colleges. Counseling and assistance shall be provided by the community college to any student in NC GAP to help the student in selecting coursework that reflects the student's educational and career goals and that provides a smooth transition from the community college to the constituent institution.
Once awarded the associate degree from the community college, the student is entitled to admission as a junior at the constituent institution.
Each constituent institution of higher education would be directed to establish NC GAP as part of its undergraduate admission program.
SECTION 11.17.(b) The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina and the State Board of Community Colleges shall report their findings and recommendations regarding NC GAP to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by March 1, 2014. The report shall include a comprehensive description of the proposed program, including the criteria that would be used to determine which students would be required to participate in the program as a condition of enrollment and the academic counseling that would need to be available to help students in NC GAP succeed academically.
UNC ISCHOOL/CAREER AND COLLEGE PROMISE PROGRAM
SECTION 11.18. The University of North Carolina at Greensboro and the Department of Public Instruction shall jointly study the feasibility of restarting the UNC‑G iSchool by incorporating it as a part of the Career and College Promise Program. As part of the study, the University of North Carolina at Greensboro and the Department of Public Instruction shall consider the cost of incorporating the iSchool within the existing structure of the Career and College Promise Program. The University of North Carolina at Greensboro and the Department of Public Instruction shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee by March 1, 2014, regarding their findings and recommendations.
PART XII. DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES
SUBPART XII‑A. CENTRAL MANAGEMENT AND SUPPORT
DEPARTMENT FLEXIBILITY TO ACHIEVE DEPARTMENTAL PRIORITIES AND ENHANCE FISCAL OVERSIGHT AND ACCOUNTABILITY
SECTION 12A.1.(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of law to the contrary and consistent with G.S. 143B‑10, the Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services may reorganize positions and related operational costs within the Department (i) upon a demonstration by the Department of cost‑effectiveness and (ii) after approval by the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM) of a written proposal submitted by the Department to OSBM. Proposals submitted to OSBM under this section shall, at a minimum, identify the positions involved and the strategies to be implemented in order to achieve efficiencies.
SECTION 12A.1.(b) In order to enhance fiscal oversight and accountability, the Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services may realign existing resources to expand its internal audit capacity. The Secretary may identify up to 32 existing positions for this purpose. Any realignment of resources and positions pursuant to this subsection is subject to the prior approval of OSBM. Notwithstanding any provision of law to the contrary, these realignments shall be reflected in the authorized budget. The expanded Office of Internal Audit shall provide the Department's management personnel with independent reviews and analyses of various functions and services within the Department, including operational audits, performance audits, compliance audits, financial audits, and other special reviews.
SECTION 12A.1.(c) By no later than June 30, 2014, the Department shall report any actions undertaken pursuant to this section to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall, at a minimum, identify the positions involved and the strategies implemented to achieve efficiencies, to expand internal audit capacity, or both.
FUNDING FOR NONPROFIT ORGANIZATIONS/ESTABLISH COMPETITIVE GRANTS PROCESS
SECTION 12A.2.(a) Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Central Management and Support, the sum of nine million five hundred twenty‑nine thousand one hundred thirty‑four dollars ($9,529,134) in recurring funds for each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the sum of three hundred seventeen thousand four hundred dollars ($317,400) in nonrecurring funds for each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, and the sum of three million eight hundred fifty‑two thousand five hundred dollars ($3,852,500) appropriated in Section 12J.1 of this act for each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium shall be used to allocate funds for nonprofit organizations.
SECTION 12A.2.(b) For fiscal year 2013‑2014 only, from funds appropriated under subsection (a) of this section, the Department shall allocate the designated amounts to the following nonprofit organizations:
(1) North Carolina Senior Games, Inc. $ 121,481
(2) ARC of North Carolina 305,598
(3) ARC of North Carolina – Wilmington 51,048
(4) Autism Society of North Carolina 2,941,818
(5) The Mariposa School for Children with Autism 339,879
(6) Easter Seals UCP of North Carolina 1,619,439
(7) ABC of North Carolina Child Development Center 366,703
(8) Residential Services, Inc. 246,424
(9) Oxford House, Inc. 200,000
(10) Brain Injury Association of North Carolina 225,223
(11) Food Bank of Central and Eastern North Carolina, Inc. 500,001
(12) Food Bank of the Albemarle 500,001
(13) Manna Food Bank 500,001
(14) Second Harvest Food Bank of Metrolina, Inc. 500,001
(15) Second Harvest Food Bank of Northwest North Carolina, Inc. 500,001
(16) Second Harvest Food Bank of Southeast North Carolina 499,999
(17) Prevent Blindness NC 458,163
(18) Maternity Homes 375,000
(19) NC High School Athletic Association (NCHSAA) 332,491
(20) Work First – Boys & Girls Clubs 2,452,500
(21) Vocational Rehabilitation Services – Easter Seal Society/UCP North Carolina 188,263
(22) ALS Jim "Catfish" Hunter 400,000
(23) Accessible Electronic Information for Blind and
Disabled Persons 75,000
SECTION 12A.2.(c) No later than December 1, 2013, each nonprofit organization receiving funding pursuant to subsection (b) of this section shall submit to the Division of Central Management and Support a written report of all activities funded by State appropriations. The report shall include the following information about the fiscal year preceding the year in which the report is due:
(1) The entity's mission, purpose, and governance structure.
(2) A description of the types of programs, services, and activities funded by State appropriations.
(3) Statistical and demographical information on the number of persons served by these programs, services, and activities, including the counties in which services are provided.
(4) Outcome measures that demonstrate the impact and effectiveness of the programs, services, and activities.
(5) A detailed program budget and list of expenditures, including all positions funded and funding sources.
(6) The source and amount of any matching funds received by the entity.
SECTION 12A.2.(d) It is the intent of the General Assembly that, beginning fiscal year 2014‑2015, the Department implement a competitive grants process for nonprofit funding. To that end, the Department shall develop a plan that establishes a competitive grants process to be administered by the Division of Central Management and Support. The Department shall develop a plan that, at a minimum, includes each of the following:
(1) A request for application (RFA) process to allow nonprofits to apply for and receive State funds on a competitive basis.
(2) A requirement that nonprofits match a minimum of ten percent (10%) of the total amount of the grant award.
(3) A requirement that the Secretary prioritize grant awards to those nonprofits that are able to leverage non‑State funds in addition to the grant award.
(4) A process that awards grants to nonprofits dedicated to providing services on a statewide basis and that support any of the following State health and wellness initiatives:
a. A program targeting advocacy, support, education, or residential services for persons diagnosed with autism.
b. A comprehensive program of education, advocacy, and support related to brain injury and those affected by brain injury.
c. A system of residential supports for those afflicted with substance abuse addiction.
d. A program of advocacy and supports for individuals with intellectual and developmental disabilities or severe and persistent mental illness, substance abusers, or the elderly.
e. Supports and services to children and adults with developmental disabilities or mental health diagnoses.
f. A food distribution system for needy individuals.
g. The provision and coordination of services for the homeless.
h. The provision of services for individuals aging out of foster care.
i. Programs promoting wellness, physical activity, and health education programming for North Carolinians.
j. A program focused on enhancing vision screening through the State's public school system.
k. Provision for the delivery of after‑school services for at‑risk youth.
l. The provision of direct services for amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS) and those diagnosed with the disease.
m. The provision of assistive information technology services for blind and disabled persons.
(5) Ensures that funds received by the Department to implement the plan supplement and do not supplant existing funds for health and wellness programs and initiatives.
SECTION 12A.2.(f) No later than March 1, 2014, the Secretary of Health and Human Services shall implement the plan for the competitive grants process.
SECTION 12A.2.(g) No later than July 1, 2014, the Secretary shall announce the recipients of the competitive grant awards and allocate funds to the grant recipients for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year pursuant to the amounts designated under subsection (a) of this section. After awards have been granted, the Secretary shall submit a report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services on the grant awards that includes at least all of the following:
(1) The identity and a brief description of each grantee and each program or initiative offered by the grantee.
(2) The amount of funding awarded to each grantee.
(3) The number of persons served by each grantee, broken down by program or initiative.
SUPPLEMENTAL SHORT‑TERM ASSISTANCE FOR GROUP HOMES
SECTION 12A.2A.(a) As used in this act, "group home" means any facility that (i) is licensed under Chapter 122C of the General Statutes, (ii) meets the definition of a supervised living facility under 10A NCAC 27G .5601(c)(1) or 10A NCAC 27G .5601(c)(3), and (iii) serves adults whose primary diagnosis is mental illness or a developmental disability but may also have other diagnoses.
SECTION 12A.2A.(b) From the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Central Management and Support, the sum of four million six hundred thousand dollars ($4,600,000) in nonrecurring funds shall be used to provide temporary, short‑term financial assistance in the form of a monthly payment to group homes on behalf of each resident who meets all of the following criteria:
(1) Was eligible for Medicaid‑covered personal care services (PCS) prior to January 1, 2013, but was determined to be ineligible for PCS on or after January 1, 2013, due to Medicaid State Plan changes in PCS eligibility criteria specified in Section 10.9F of S.L. 2012‑142, as amended by Section 3.7 of S.L. 2012‑145 and Section 70 of S.L. 2012‑194.
(2) Has continuously resided in a group home since December 31, 2012.
SECTION 12A.2A.(c) These monthly payments shall be subject to all of the following requirements and limitations:
(1) The amount of the monthly payments authorized by this section shall not exceed four hundred sixty‑four dollars and thirty cents ($464.30) per month for each resident who meets all criteria specified in subsection (b) of this section.
(2) A group home that receives the monthly payments authorized by this section shall not, under any circumstances, use these payments for any purpose other than providing, as necessary, supervision and medication management for a resident who meets all criteria specified in subsection (b) of this section.
(3) The Department shall make monthly payments authorized by this section to a group home on behalf of each resident who meets all criteria specified in subsection (b) of this section only for the period commencing July 1, 2013, and ending June 30, 2014, or upon depletion of the four million six hundred thousand dollars ($4,600,000) in nonrecurring funds appropriated in this act to the Division of Central Management and Support for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year for the purpose of this section, whichever is earlier.
(4) The Department shall make monthly payments authorized by this section only to the extent sufficient funds are available from the four million six hundred thousand dollars ($4,600,000) in nonrecurring funds appropriated in this act to the Division of Central Management and Support for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year for the purpose of this section.
(5) The Department shall not make monthly payments authorized by this section to a group home on behalf of a resident during the pendency of an appeal by or on behalf of the resident under G.S. 108A‑70.9A.
(6) The Department shall terminate all monthly payments pursuant to this section on June 30, 2014, or upon depletion of the funds appropriated in this act to the Division of Central Management and Support for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year for the purpose of this section, whichever is earlier.
(7) Each group home that receives the monthly payments authorized by this section shall submit to the Department a list of all funding sources for the operational costs of the group home for the preceding two years, in accordance with the schedule and format prescribed by the Department.
SECTION 12A.2A.(d) The Department shall use an existing mechanism to administer these funds in the least restrictive manner that ensures compliance with this section and timely and accurate payments to group homes. The Department shall not, under any circumstances, use any portion of the four million six hundred thousand dollars ($4,600,000) appropriated in this act to the Division of Central Management and Support for the purpose of this section for any other purpose.
SECTION 12A.2A.(e) By no later than April 1, 2014, the Department of Health and Human Services shall submit to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division:
(1) A plan for a long‑term solution for individuals residing in group homes who would like to continue residing in this setting and, as a result of an independent assessment, have been determined to need only supervision, medication management, or both.
(2) A list of funding sources for each group home that receives assistance authorized by this section, based on the information provided to the Department pursuant to Section 12A.2A(c)(7).
SECTION 12A.2A.(f) Nothing in this section shall be construed as an obligation by the General Assembly to appropriate funds for the purpose of this section, or as an entitlement by any group home, resident of a group home, or other person to receive temporary, short‑term financial assistance under this section.
SECTION 12A.2A.(g) This section expires June 30, 2014.
Establish Statewide Telepsychiatry Program
SECTION 12A.2B.(a) By no later than August 15, 2013, the Office of Rural Health and Community Care of the Department of Health and Human Services shall develop and submit to the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division a plan to implement a statewide telepsychiatry program to be administered by East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health (ECU Center for Telepsychiatry) pursuant to a contract between the Department and ECU Center for Telepsychiatry. The plan shall be substantially similar to the Albemarle Hospital Foundation telepsychiatry project currently operating in 14 hospitals in eastern North Carolina and shall allow all hospitals licensed to operate in the State under Chapter 131E or Chapter 122C of the General Statutes to participate in the telepsychiatry program, either as a consultant site or as a referring site. As used in this section, the terms "consultant site" and "referring site" are as defined in G.S. 143B‑139.4B(a). In addition, the plan shall include at least all of the following:
(1) Specific steps to be taken by ECU Center for Telepsychiatry, within specified time periods, to work toward implementation of the telepsychiatry program on a statewide basis.
(2) Specific steps to be taken by the Department to oversee and monitor establishment and administration of the program.
(3) Estimated program costs and rates of payment for telepsychiatry services.
(4) Requirements for liability coverage related to participation in telepsychiatry.
SECTION 12A.2B.(b) Article 3 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 143B‑139.4B. Office of Rural Health and Community Care to oversee and monitor establishment and administration of statewide telepsychiatry program.
(a) The following definitions apply in this section:
(1) Consultant site. – The hospital or other site at which the consulting provider is physically located at the time the consulting provider delivers the acute mental health or substance abuse care by means of telepsychiatry.
(2) Hospital. – A facility licensed under Chapter 131E or Chapter 122C of the General Statutes, or a State facility listed in G.S. 122C‑181.
(3) Referring site. – The hospital at which the patient is physically located.
(4) Telepsychiatry. – The delivery of acute mental health or substance abuse care, including diagnosis or treatment, by means of two‑way real‑time interactive audio and video by a consulting provider at a consultant site to an individual patient at a referring site. The term does not include the standard use of telephones, facsimile transmissions, unsecured electronic mail, or a combination of these in the course of care.
(5) Consulting provider. – A physician or other health care provider licensed in this State to provide acute mental health or substance abuse care.
(b) The North Carolina Office of Rural Health and Community Care shall oversee the establishment and administration of a statewide telepsychiatry program that allows referring sites to utilize consulting providers at a consultant site to provide timely psychiatric assessment and rapid initiation of treatment for patients at the referring site experiencing an acute mental health or substance abuse crisis. Notwithstanding the provisions of Article 3 of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes or any other provision of law, the Office of Rural Health and Community Care shall contract with East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health to administer the telepsychiatry program. The contract shall include a provision requiring East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health to work toward implementing this program on a statewide basis by no later than January 1, 2014, and to report annually to the Office of Rural Health and Community Care on the following performance measures:
(1) Number of consultant sites and referring sites participating in the program.
(2) Number of psychiatric assessments conducted under the program, reported by site or region.
(3) Length of stay of patients receiving telepsychiatry services in the emergency departments of hospitals participating in the program, reported by disposition.
(4) Number of involuntary commitments recommended as a result of psychiatric assessments conducted by consulting providers under the program, reported by site or region and by year, and compared to the number of involuntary commitments recommended prior to implementation of this program.
(c) The Office of Rural Health and Community Care shall have all of the following powers and duties relative to the statewide telepsychiatry program:
(1) Ongoing oversight and monitoring of the program.
(2) Ongoing monitoring of the performance of East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health under its contract with the Department, including all of the following:
a. Review of the performance measures described in subsection (b) of this section.
b. Annual site visits to East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health.
(3) Facilitation of program linkages with critical access hospitals and small rural hospitals.
(4) Conducting visits to referring sites and consultant sites to monitor implementation of the program; and upon implementation, conducting these site visits at least once annually.
(5) Addressing barriers and concerns identified by consulting providers, consultant sites, and referring sites participating in the program.
(6) Encouraging participation in the program by all potential consultant sites, consulting providers, and referring sites throughout the State and promoting continued participation in the program by consultant sites, consulting providers, and referring sites throughout the State.
(7) Compiling a list of recommendations for future tele‑health initiatives, based on operation of the statewide telepsychiatry program.
(8) Reviewing on a quarterly basis the financial statements of East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health related to the telepsychiatry program in order to compare and monitor projected and actual program costs.
(9) Annually reporting to the Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division on or before November 1 on the operation and effectiveness of the program. The report shall include information on each of the performance measures described in subsection (b) of this section.
(d) The Department shall adopt rules necessary to ensure the health and safety of patients who receive care, diagnosis, or treatment under the telepsychiatry program authorized by this section."
SECTION 12A.2B.(c) From the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Central Management and Support, Office of Rural Health and Community Care, the sum of two million dollars ($2,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of two million dollars ($2,000,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used for the following purposes:
(1) To enter into a contract with East Carolina University Center for Telepsychiatry and e‑Behavioral Health for statewide implementation and administration of the telepsychiatry program authorized in G.S. 143B‑139.4B of the General Statutes.
(2) To purchase needed telepsychiatry equipment for the State facilities listed in G.S. 122C‑181 that participate in the statewide telepsychiatry program.
SECTION 12A.3.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services, in cooperation with the State Chief Information Officer, shall coordinate health information technology (HIT) policies and programs within the State of North Carolina. The Department's goal in coordinating State HIT policy and programs shall be to avoid duplication of efforts and to ensure that each State agency, public entity, and private entity that undertakes health information technology activities does so within the area of its greatest expertise and technical capability and in a manner that supports coordinated State and national goals, which shall include at least all of the following:
(1) Ensuring that patient health information is secure and protected, in accordance with applicable law.
(2) Improving health care quality, reducing medical errors, reducing health disparities, and advancing the delivery of patient‑centered medical care.
(3) Providing appropriate information to guide medical decisions at the time and place of care.
(4) Ensuring meaningful public input into HIT infrastructure development.
(5) Improving the coordination of information among hospitals, laboratories, physicians' offices, and other entities through an effective infrastructure for the secure and authorized exchange of health care information.
(6) Improving public health services and facilitating early identification and rapid response to public health threats and emergencies, including bioterrorist events and infectious disease outbreaks.
(7) Facilitating health and clinical research.
(8) Promoting early detection, prevention, and management of chronic diseases.
SECTION 12A.3.(b) The Department of Health and Human Services shall establish and direct an HIT management structure that is efficient and transparent and that is compatible with the Office of the National Health Coordinator for Information Technology (National Coordinator) governance mechanism. The HIT management structure shall be responsible for all of the following:
(1) Developing a State plan for implementing and ensuring compliance with national HIT standards and for the most efficient, effective, and widespread adoption of HIT.
(2) Ensuring that (i) specific populations are effectively integrated into the State plan, including aging populations, populations requiring mental health services, and populations utilizing the public health system, and (ii) unserved and underserved populations receive priority consideration for HIT support.
(3) Identifying all HIT stakeholders and soliciting feedback and participation from each stakeholder in the development of the State plan.
(4) Ensuring that existing HIT capabilities are considered and incorporated into the State plan.
(5) Identifying and eliminating conflicting HIT efforts where necessary.
(6) Identifying available resources for the implementation, operation, and maintenance of health information technology, including identifying resources and available opportunities for North Carolina institutions of higher education.
(7) Ensuring that potential State plan participants are aware of HIT policies and programs and the opportunity for improved health information technology.
(8) Monitoring HIT efforts and initiatives in other states and replicating successful efforts and initiatives in North Carolina.
(9) Monitoring the development of the National Coordinator's strategic plan and ensuring that all stakeholders are aware of and in compliance with its requirements.
(10) Monitoring the progress and recommendations of the HIT Policy and Standards Committee and ensuring that all stakeholders remain informed of the Committee's recommendations.
(11) Monitoring all studies and reports provided to the United States Congress and reporting to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the impact of report recommendations on State efforts to implement coordinated HIT.
SECTION 12A.3.(c) Section 10.24(c) of S.L. 2011‑145 reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 10.24.(c) Beginning
October 1, 2011, the Department of Health and Human Services shall provide
quarterly written reportsBy no later than January 15, 2015, the Department
of Health and Human Services shall provide a written report on the status
of HIT efforts to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and
Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division. The reports due each
January 1 and July 1 shall consist of updates to substantial initiatives or
challenges that have occurred since the most recent comprehensive report. The
reports due each October 1 and April 1report shall be comprehensive
and shall include all of the following:
(1) Current status of federal HIT initiatives.
(2) Current status of State HIT efforts and initiatives among both public and private entities.
(3) A breakdown of current public and private funding sources and dollar amounts for State HIT initiatives.
(4) Department efforts to coordinate HIT initiatives within the State and any obstacles or impediments to coordination.
(5) HIT research efforts being conducted within the State and sources of funding for research efforts.
(6) Opportunities for stakeholders to participate in HIT funding and other efforts and initiatives during the next quarter.
(7) Issues associated with the implementation of HIT in North Carolina and recommended solutions to these issues."
FUNDS FOR REPLACEMENT MEDICAID MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEM/IMPLEMENTATION OF REPLACEMENT MMIS
SECTION 12A.4.(a) The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services may utilize prior year earned revenue received for the replacement MMIS in the amount of nine million six hundred fifty‑eight thousand one hundred fifty‑two dollars ($9,658,152) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and in the amount of one million six hundred sixty‑six thousand six hundred twenty‑five dollars ($1,666,625) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year. In the event the Department does not receive prior year earned revenues in the amounts authorized by this section, or funds are insufficient to advance the project, the Department may, with prior approval from the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM), utilize overrealized receipts and funds appropriated to the Department to achieve the level of funding specified in this section for the replacement MMIS.
SECTION 12A.4.(b) The Department shall make full development of the replacement MMIS a top priority. During development and implementation of the replacement MMIS, the Department shall develop plans to ensure the timely and effective implementation of enhancements to the system to provide the following capabilities:
(1) Receiving and tracking premiums or other payments required by law.
(2) Compatibility with the Health Information System.
SECTION 12A.4.(c) The Department shall make every effort to expedite the implementation of the enhancements. The replacement MMIS shall have the capability to fully implement the administration of NC Health Choice, Ticket to Work, CAP Children's Program, all relevant Medicaid waivers, and the Medicare 646 waiver as it applies to Medicaid eligibles.
SECTION 12A.4.(d) The Office of the State Chief Information Officer (SCIO) and the Office of Information Technology Services (ITS) shall work in cooperation with the Department to ensure the timely and effective implementation of the replacement MMIS and any enhancements. The SCIO shall ensure that the replacement MMIS meets all State requirements for project management and shall immediately report any failure to meet these requirements to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Office of State Budget and Management. The SCIO shall also immediately report if any replacement MMIS project, or portion of a project, is listed as red in the project portfolio management tool.
SECTION 12A.4.(e) Notwithstanding G.S. 114‑2.3, the Department shall consult with the Office of the SCIO concerning the retention of private counsel for the replacement MMIS, and as directed by the Office of the SCIO, retain private counsel with expertise in pertinent information technology and computer law to negotiate and review contract amendments associated with the replacement MMIS. The private counsel engaged by the Department shall review the replacement MMIS contract amendments between the Department and the vendors to ensure that the requirements of subsection (c) of this section are met in their entirety and that the terms of the contract amendments are in the State's best interest.
SECTION 12A.4.(f) The Department shall immediately report any changes to the replacement MMIS implementation schedules to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Office of State Budget and Management, with a full explanation of the reason for the change and any associated costs.
SECTION 12A.4.(g) The Department shall provide the following reports on the replacement MMIS by the dates specified in this subsection to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Office of State Budget and Management:
(1) By no later than September 1, 2013, a progress report on full implementation of the replacement MMIS, which shall include at least all of the following:
a. Any issues encountered following the "go‑live" date of July 1, 2013, and how each issue was resolved.
b. Any system requirements for manual workarounds and the time line for implementing an automated solution for each manual workaround.
c. Required capabilities that are not available in the replacement MMIS on the "go‑live" date of July 1, 2013, with a date for the implementation of each.
(2) By no later than November 1, 2013, a progress report on full implementation of the replacement MMIS, which shall include at least all of the following:
a. An updated estimate of the costs associated with operating and maintaining the system during the 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 fiscal years, with an explanation for any changes from previous submissions.
b. The cost, if any, associated with the resolution of each issue encountered following the "go‑live" date of July 1, 2013, and the source of funding for the associated cost.
c. The cost, if any, associated with any system requirements for manual workarounds, the source of funding used to pay for the associated cost, the cost associated with transitioning to each automated solution, and the source of funding for each identified cost.
d. A comparison of timeliness and accuracy of payments for legacy system and replacement system transactions, using the same criteria for both.
e. The cost, if any, associated with implementation of any required capabilities that are not available in the replacement MMIS on the "go‑live" date of July 1, 2013.
(3) By no later than December 1, 2013, a plan for the elimination of the Office of Medicaid Management Information System Services (OMMISS) and the transfer of its remaining operations to other Divisions within the Department of Health and Human Services. This plan shall include at least all of the following:
a. The specific operations to be transferred to other Divisions within the Department, the specific Division to which each operation will be transferred, the State personnel that will be impacted by each transfer, costs associated with each transfer, and sources of funding to enable the identified Divisions to assume these transferred operations.
b. Any State personnel costs that will result from the dissolution of OMMISS, including the costs of any severance payments and any compensatory time earned during the course of the project, broken down by employee; and any identified sources of funding to pay for these personnel costs.
c. A plan for transitioning out of the space currently leased by the State for OMMISS, costs associated with this transition, and any savings that will result from the transition.
(4) By no later than January 15, 2014, a preliminary report on the Department's plan for achieving system certification, which shall include at least all of the following:
a. A description of the process.
b. A detailed time line.
c. Any issues that could impact the timing of system certification and plans to mitigate identified issues.
d. Any costs associated with system certification.
e. Any identified funding sources to pay for costs associated with system certification.
SECTION 12A.4.(h) The Department shall complete the Reporting and Analytics Project solution simultaneously with the implementation of the replacement MMIS.
SECTION 12A.4.(i) Notwithstanding any other provision of law and to the extent permitted by federal law, the Department shall not approve any overtime or compensatory time related to the replacement MMIS after August 1, 2013, without the prior written approval of the Office of State Personnel for each specific instance of overtime or compensatory time. Beginning August 1, 2013, the Department shall submit a monthly report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division on the total amount of approved overtime and compensatory time related to the replacement MMIS for the preceding calendar month.
SECTION 12A.4.(k) Subsection (j) of this section becomes effective July 1, 2014.
FRAUD DETECTION THROUGH NORTH CAROLINA ACCOUNTABILITY AND COMPLIANCE TECHNOLOGY SYSTEM
SECTION 12A.5. The Department of Health and Human Services shall work with the Governmental Data Analytics Center (GDAC) to develop an integration plan to leverage the North Carolina Financial Accountability and Compliance Technology System (NC FACTS), which is the State's enterprise‑level fraud detection system operated by GDAC, in an effort to detect and prevent potential fraud, waste, and improper payments.
The integration plan shall include a feasibility analysis, a proposed integration time line, and a cost estimate to integrate the following systems with NC FACTS:
(1) NCTracks, the replacement Medicaid Management Information System (MMIS).
(2) North Carolina Child Treatment Program (NC CTP) State‑funded secure database.
(3) North Carolina Families Accessing Services through Technology (NC FAST).
The integration plan shall include opportunities to leverage existing data integration and analytics contracts and licenses for the purposes of optimizing cost effectiveness and generating greater efficiencies. The integration plan shall also include proposals for how to protect medical and other private information stored in the NCTracks, NC CTP, and NC FAST.
No later than April 1, 2014, the Department shall report a plan to integrate the systems listed in this section to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services.
FUNDING FOR NORTH CAROLINA FAMILIES ACCESSING SERVICES THROUGH TECHNOLOGY (NC FAST); REPORT ON ELIGIBILITY DETERMINATIONS FOR THE EXCHANGE
SECTION 12A.6.(a) Funds appropriated in this act in the amount of eight hundred sixty‑four thousand six hundred fifty‑five dollars ($864,655) for State fiscal year 2014‑2015 along with the cash balance in Budget Code 24410 Fund 2411 for the North Carolina Families Accessing Services through Technology (NC FAST) project shall be used to match federal funds in fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 to expedite the development and implementation of the Eligibility Information System (EIS), Child Care, Low Income Energy Assistance, and Crisis Intervention Programs, and Child Service components of the NC FAST project.
SECTION 12A.6.(b) The Department of Health and Human Services shall report on NC FAST's performance in providing eligibility determinations for Medicaid applicants on the federally facilitated Health Benefit Exchange, a required function of NC FAST directed by Section 2 of S.L. 2013‑5. The report shall contain a description of the following:
(1) Funding sources, funding amounts, and expenditures for the project beginning in fiscal year 2012‑2013 through the time of the report.
(2) Any challenges with the eligibility determination project and how NC FAST solved those challenges.
(3) The number of eligibility determinations performed for applicants on the federally facilitated Health Benefit Exchange, including an analysis of on what days and for how many persons eligibility determinations were performed as well as how many applicants were determined to be eligible.
The Department shall submit a report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology three months after open enrollment begins for the federally facilitated Health Benefit Exchange.
SECTION 12A.7. Article 31 of Chapter 58 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read:
"§ 58‑31‑26. Medical liability insurance for certain physicians and dentists.
(a) The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services and the Secretary of the Department of Public Safety may provide medical liability insurance not to exceed one million dollars ($1,000,000) per incident on behalf of employees of these Departments who are licensed to practice medicine or dentistry; on behalf of all licensed physicians who are faculty members of The University of North Carolina who perform work on a contractual basis for the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services for incidents that occur in Division programs; and on behalf of physicians in all residency training programs from The University of North Carolina who are in training at institutions operated by the Department of Health and Human Services. This coverage may include commercial insurance or self‑insurance and shall cover these individuals for their acts or omissions only while they are engaged in providing medical and dental services pursuant to their State employment or training.
(b) The coverage provided pursuant to this section shall not cover any individual for any act or omission that the individual knows or reasonably should know constitutes a violation of the applicable criminal laws of any state or the United States, or that arises out of any sexual, fraudulent, criminal, or malicious act or out of any act amounting to willful or wanton negligence.
(c) The coverage provided pursuant to this section shall not require any additional appropriations and, except as provided in subsection (a) of this section, shall not apply to any individual providing contractual service to the Department of Health and Human Services or the Department of Public Safety."
ELIMINATION OF UNNECESSARY AND REDUNDANT REPORTS
SECTION 12A.8.(a) Eliminate Outcomes Evaluation Study on the Effectiveness of Substance Abuse Services Provided to Person Convicted of DWI. – G.S. 122C‑142.1(j) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.8.(b) Eliminate Evaluation of Efficiency and Effectiveness of Family Resource Center Grant Program. – G.S. 143B‑152.15(b) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.8.(c) Eliminate Annual Report on Progress of MH/DD/SAS State Plan. – G.S. 122C‑102(c) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.8.(d) Eliminate Annual Report on North Carolina State Plan on Healthcare Associated Infections. – G.S. 130A‑150(e) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.8.(e) Eliminate Annual Report on The Health Insurance Program for Children. – G.S. 108A‑70.27(b) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.8.(f) Eliminate Annual Report by State Child Fatality Review Team. – G.S. 143B‑150.20(h) is repealed.
SECTION 12A.9. G.S. 130A‑33.51(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) The Committee shall
submit a written report not later than May 1, 1994, and not later than October
1 of each subsequent year, to the Governor and to the Joint Legislative
Commission on Governmental Operations. the Secretary. The report
shall address the progress in implementation of a cancer control program. The
report shall include an accounting of funds expended and anticipated funding
needs for full implementation of recommended programs."
MEETINGS OF CANCER COORDINATION COMMITTEE
SECTION 12A.10. G.S. 130A‑33.50(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) The Committee shall have up to 34 members, including the Secretary of the Department or the Secretary's designee. The members of the Committee shall elect a chair and vice‑chair from among the Committee membership. The Committee shall meet not more than twice a year at the call of the chair. Six of the members shall be legislators, three of whom shall be appointed by the Speaker of the House of Representatives, and three of whom shall be appointed by the President Pro Tempore of the Senate. Four of the members shall be cancer survivors, two of whom shall be appointed by the Speaker of the House of Representatives, and two of whom shall be appointed by the President Pro Tempore of the Senate. The remainder of the members shall be appointed by the Governor as follows:
(1) One member from the Department of Environment and Natural Resources;
(2) Three members, one from each of the following: the Department, the Department of Public Instruction, and the North Carolina Community College System;
(3) Four members representing the cancer control programs at North Carolina medical schools, one from each of the following: the University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill School of Medicine, the Bowman Gray School of Medicine, the Duke University School of Medicine, and the East Carolina University School of Medicine;
(4) One member who is an oncology nurse representing the North Carolina Nurses Association;
(5) One member representing the Cancer Committee of the North Carolina Medical Society;
(6) One member representing the Old North State Medical Society;
(7) One member representing the American Cancer Society, North Carolina Division, Inc.;
(8) One member representing the North Carolina Hospital Association;
(9) One member representing the North Carolina Association of Local Health Directors;
(10) One member who is a primary care physician licensed to practice medicine in North Carolina;
(11) One member representing the American College of Surgeons;
(12) One member representing the North Carolina Oncology Society;
(13) One member representing the Association of North Carolina Cancer Registrars;
(14) One member representing the Medical Directors of the North Carolina Association of Health Plans; and
(15) Up to four additional members at large.
Except for the Secretary, the members shall be appointed for staggered four‑year terms and until their successors are appointed and qualify. The Governor may remove any member of the Committee from office in accordance with the provisions of G.S. 143B‑13. Members may succeed themselves for one term and may be appointed again after being off the Committee for one term."
ANNUAL REPORT OF LAPSED SALARY FUNDS
SECTION 12A.11. Section 10.20 of S.L. 2012‑142 reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 10.20. Beginning no later than
November 1, 2012, and annually thereafter, the Department of Health and
Human Services shall submit quarterly reportsa report to the
Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the
House Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate
Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, Services and
the Fiscal Research Division on the use of lapsed salary funds by each Division
within the Department. For each Division, the report shall include the
following information about the preceding calendar quarterState
fiscal year:
(1) The total amount of lapsed salary funds.
(2) The number of full‑time equivalent positions comprising the lapsed salary funds.
(3) The Fund Code for each full‑time equivalent position included in the number reported pursuant to subdivision (2) of this section.
(4) The purposes for which the Department expended lapsed salary funds."
SECTION 12A.12. G.S. 148‑19(d) reads as rewritten:
"(d) The Commission for
Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services shall
adopt standards for the delivery of mental health and mental retardation
services to inmates in the custody of the Division of Adult Correction of the
Department of Public Safety. The Commission for Mental Health, Developmental
Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services shall give the Secretary of Public
Safety an opportunity to review and comment on proposed standards prior to
promulgation of such standards; however, final authority to determine such
standards remains with the Commission. The Secretary of the Department of
Health and Human Services shall designate an agency or agencies within the
Department of Health and Human Services to monitor the implementation by the
Division of Adult Correction of the Department of Public Safety of these
standards and of substance abuse standards adopted by the Division of Adult
Correction of the Department of Public Safety. The Secretary of Health and
Human Services shall send a written report on the progress which the Division
of Adult Correction of the Department of Public Safety has made on the
implementation of such standards to the Governor, the Lieutenant Governor, and
the Speaker of the House. Such reports shall be made on an annual basis
beginning January 1, 1978."
MODIFICATIONS TO JUSTUS‑WARREN TASK FORCE
SECTION 12A.13. G.S. 143B‑216.60 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143B‑216.60. The Justus‑Warren Heart Disease and Stroke Prevention Task Force.
…
(e) The Task Force shall
meet at least quarterly or more frequently not more than twice
annually at the call of the Chair.
(f) The Task
Force Chair may establish committees for the purpose of making special studies
pursuant to its duties, and may appoint non‑Task Force members to serve
on each committee as resource persons. Resource persons shall be voting members
of the committees and shall receive subsistence and travel expenses in
accordance with G.S. 138‑5 and G.S. 138‑6. Committees may
meet with the frequency needed to accomplish the purposes of this section.
…."
MODIFICATIONS TO COMMISSION FOR THE BLIND
SECTION 12A.14.(a) Eliminate Professional Advisory Committee. – Part 8 of Article 3 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes is repealed.
SECTION 12A.14.(b) G.S. 143B‑158 reads as rewritten:
"§ 143B‑158. Commission for the Blind.
(a) The Commission for the
Blind of the Department of Health and Human Services shall consist of 1319
members as follows:
(1) One representative of the Statewide Independent Living Council.
(2) One representative of a parent training and information center established pursuant to section 631(c) of the Individuals with Disabilities Education Act, 20 U.S.C. § 1431(c).
(3) One representative of the State's Client Assistance Program.
(4) One vocational rehabilitation counselor who has knowledge of and experience in vocational rehabilitation services for the blind. A vocational rehabilitation counselor appointed pursuant to this subdivision shall serve as a nonvoting member of the Commission if the counselor is an employee of the Department of Health and Human Services.
(5) One representative of community rehabilitation program services providers.
(6) One current or former applicant for, or recipient of, vocational rehabilitation services.
(7) One representative of a disability advocacy group representing individuals who are blind.
(8) One parent, family member, guardian, advocate, or authorized representative of an individual who is blind, has multiple disabilities, and either has difficulty representing himself or herself or who is unable, due to disabilities, to represent himself or herself.
(9) One representative of business, industry, and labor.
(10) One representative of the directors of projects carried out under section 121 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, 29 U.S.C. § 741, as amended, if there are any of these projects in the State.
(11) One representative of the Department of Public Instruction.
(12) One representative of the Commission on Workforce Development.
(12a) Two licensed physicians nominated by the North Carolina Medical Society whose practice is limited to ophthalmology.
(12b) Two optometrists nominated by the North Carolina State Optometric Society.
(12c) Two opticians nominated by the North Carolina Opticians Association.
(13) The Director of the Division of Services for the Blind shall serve as an ex officio, nonvoting member.
(b) The members of the Commission for the Blind shall be appointed by the Governor. The Governor shall appoint members after soliciting recommendations from representatives of organizations representing a broad range of individuals who have disabilities and organizations interested in those individuals. In making appointments to the Commission, the Governor shall consider, to the greatest extent practicable, the extent to which minority populations are represented on the Commission.
(c) A Except for
individuals appointed to the Commission under subdivisions (12a), (12b), and
(12c) of subsection (a) of this section, a majority of Commission members
shall be persons who are blind, as defined in G.S. 111‑11. A
majority of Commission members shall be persons who are G.S. 111‑11
and who are not employed by the Division of Services for the Blind.
(d) The Commission for the Blind shall select a Chairperson from among its members.
(e) The term of office of
members of the Commission is three years. The term of members appointed under
subdivisions (1), (2), (3), and (4) (4), and (12a) of subsection
(a) of this section shall expire on June 30 of years evenly divisible by three.
The term of members appointed under subdivisions (5), (6), (7), and (8) (8),
and (12b) of subsection (a) of this section shall expire on June 30 of
years that follow by one year those years that are evenly divisible by three.
The term of members appointed under subdivisions (9), (10), (11), and (12) (12),
and (12c) of subsection (a) of this section shall expire on June 30 of
years that precede by one year those years that are evenly divisible by three.
(f) No individual may be appointed to more than two consecutive three‑year terms. Upon the expiration of a term, a member shall continue to serve until a successor is appointed, as provided by G.S. 128‑7. An appointment to fill a vacancy shall be for the unexpired balance of the term.
(g) A member of the Commission shall not vote on any issue before the Commission that would have a significant and predictable effect on the member's financial interest. The Governor shall have the power to remove any member of the Commission from office for misfeasance, malfeasance, or nonfeasance in accordance with the provisions of G.S. 143B‑13 of the Executive Organization Act of 1973.
(h) The members of the Commission shall receive per diem and necessary travel and subsistence expenses in accordance with the provisions of G.S. 138‑5.
(i) A majority of the Commission shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business.
(j) All clerical and other services required by the Commission shall be supplied by the Secretary of Health and Human Services."
SECTION 12A.14.(c) Subsection (b) of this section becomes effective August 1, 2013.
SUBPART XII‑B. DIVISION OF CHILD DEVELOPMENT AND EARLY EDUCATION
SECTION 12B.1.(a) Eligibility. – The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Child Development and Early Education, shall continue implementing the prekindergarten program (NC Pre‑K). The NC Pre‑K program shall serve children who are four years of age on or before August 31 of the program year. In determining eligibility, the Division shall establish income eligibility requirements for the program not to exceed seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income. Up to twenty percent (20%) of children enrolled may have family incomes in excess of seventy‑five percent (75%) of median income if those children have other designated risk factors. Furthermore, any age‑eligible child who is a child of either of the following shall be eligible for the program: (i) an active duty member of the Armed Forces of the United States, including the North Carolina National Guard, State military forces, or a reserve component of the Armed Forces who was ordered to active duty by the proper authority within the last 18 months or is expected to be ordered within the next 18 months or (ii) a member of the Armed Forces of the United States, including the North Carolina National Guard, State military forces, or a reserve component of the Armed Forces who was injured or killed while serving on active duty. Eligibility determinations for prekindergarten participants may continue through local education agencies and local North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., partnerships.
SECTION 12B.1.(b) Multiyear Contracts. – The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall require the NC Pre‑K contractor to issue multiyear contracts for licensed private child care centers providing NC Pre‑K classrooms.
SECTION 12B.1.(c) Programmatic Standards. – All entities operating prekindergarten classrooms shall adhere to all of the policies prescribed by the Division of Child Development and Early Education regarding programmatic standards and classroom requirements.
SECTION 12B.1.(d) NC Pre‑K Committees. – The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall establish a standard decision‑making process to be used by local NC Pre‑K committees in awarding prekindergarten classroom slots and student selection.
SECTION 12B.1.(e) SEEK. – All prekindergarten classrooms shall be required to participate in the Subsidized Early Education for Kids (SEEK) accounting system to streamline the payment function for these classrooms with a goal of eliminating duplicative systems and streamlining the accounting and payment processes among the subsidy reimbursement systems. Prekindergarten funds transferred may be used to add these programs to SEEK.
SECTION 12B.1.(f) Pilot Program. – The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall create a pilot program that provides funding for NC Pre‑K classrooms on a per classroom basis. The pilot program shall include three different NC Pre‑K contractual regions that are geographically diverse. The local NC Pre‑K administrator shall contract with the provider for operation of a classroom established pursuant to the pilot program. The Division shall provide a report on the status of the pilot program to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division no later than January 31, 2014. The report shall include the following:
(1) The number of students served.
(2) The amount of funds paid for each classroom.
(3) The amount of funds paid per student.
(4) The attendance information on students in the pilot program as compared to those students in a classroom having a traditional funding structure.
(5) Information on the number of students and students' families using the Subsidized Early Education for Kids (SEEK) system.
(6) A cost comparison of the classroom pilots to the average cost per student through the per student funding methodology.
SECTION 12B.1.(g) Reporting. – The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall submit an annual report no later than March 15 of each year to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall include the following:
(1) The number of children participating in the NC Pre‑K program by county.
(2) The number of children participating in the NC Pre‑K program who have never been served in other early education programs such as child care, public or private preschool, Head Start, Early Head Start, or early intervention programs.
(3) The expected NC Pre‑K expenditures for the programs and the source of the local contributions.
(4) The results of an annual evaluation of the NC Pre‑K program.
SECTION 12B.1.(h) Child Care Commission. – G.S. 143B‑168.4(b) reads as rewritten:
"(b) Members shall be appointed as follows:
(1) Of the Governor's
initial appointees, four shall be appointed for terms expiring June 30, 1986,2015,
and three shall be appointed for terms expiring June 30, 1987;2016;
(2) Of the General Assembly's
initial appointees appointed upon recommendation of the President of the
Senate, two shall be appointed for terms expiring June 30, 1986,2015,
and two shall be appointed for terms expiring June 30, 1987;2016;
(3) Of the General
Assembly's initial appointees appointed upon recommendation of the Speaker of
the House of Representatives, two shall be appointed for terms expiring June
30, 1986,2015, and two shall be appointed for terms expiring June
30, 1987.2016.
Appointments by the General Assembly shall be made in accordance with G.S. 120‑121. After the initial appointees' terms have expired, all members shall be appointed to serve two‑year terms. Any appointment to fill a vacancy on the Commission created by the resignation, dismissal, death, or disability of a member shall be for the balance of the unexpired term."
SECTION 12B.1.(i) The terms of all members currently serving on the Child Care Commission shall expire on the effective date of this act. A new Commission of 17 members shall be appointed in the manner provided by G.S. 143B‑168.4(a) and (b), as amended in subsection (h) of this section. Members appointed pursuant to subsection (h) of this section shall be appointed no later than October 1, 2013.
SECTION 12B.3.(a) The maximum gross annual income for initial eligibility, adjusted biennially, for subsidized child care services shall be seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income, adjusted for family size.
SECTION 12B.3.(b) Fees for families who are required to share in the cost of care shall be established based on a percent of gross family income and adjusted for family size. Fees shall be determined as follows:
PERCENT OF GROSS
FAMILY SIZE FAMILY INCOME
1‑3 10%
4‑5 9%
6 or more 8%
SECTION 12B.3.(c) Payments for the purchase of child care services for low‑income children shall be in accordance with the following requirements:
(1) Religious‑sponsored child care facilities operating pursuant to G.S. 110‑106 and licensed child care centers and homes that meet the minimum licensing standards that are participating in the subsidized child care program shall be paid the one‑star county market rate or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower, unless prohibited by subsection (f) of this section.
(2) Licensed child care centers and homes with two or more stars shall receive the market rate for that rated license level for that age group or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower, unless prohibited by subsection (f) of this section.
(3) Nonlicensed homes shall receive fifty percent (50%) of the county market rate or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower.
(4) No payments shall be made for transportation services or registration fees charged by child care facilities.
(5) Payments for subsidized child care services for postsecondary education shall be limited to a maximum of 20 months of enrollment.
(6) The Department of Health and Human Services shall implement necessary rule changes to restructure services, including, but not limited to, targeting benefits to employment.
SECTION 12B.3.(d) Provisions of payment rates for child care providers in counties that do not have at least 50 children in each age group for center‑based and home‑based care are as follows:
(1) Except as applicable in subdivision (2) of this subsection, payment rates shall be set at the statewide or regional market rate for licensed child care centers and homes.
(2) If it can be demonstrated that the application of the statewide or regional market rate to a county with fewer than 50 children in each age group is lower than the county market rate and would inhibit the ability of the county to purchase child care for low‑income children, then the county market rate may be applied.
SECTION 12B.3.(e) A market rate shall be calculated for child care centers and homes at each rated license level for each county and for each age group or age category of enrollees and shall be representative of fees charged to parents for each age group of enrollees within the county. The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall also calculate a statewide rate and regional market rate for each rated license level for each age category.
SECTION 12B.3.(f) The Division of Child Development and Early Education shall continue implementing policies that improve the quality of child care for subsidized children, including a policy in which child care subsidies are paid, to the extent possible, for child care in the higher quality centers and homes only. The Division shall define higher quality, and subsidy funds shall not be paid for one‑ or two‑star rated facilities. For those counties with an inadequate number of four‑ and five‑star rated facilities, the Division shall continue a transition period that allows the facilities to continue to receive subsidy funds while the facilities work on the increased star ratings. The Division may allow exemptions in counties where there is an inadequate number of four‑ and five‑star rated facilities for nonstar rated programs, such as religious programs.
SECTION 12B.3.(g) Facilities licensed pursuant to Article 7 of Chapter 110 of the General Statutes and facilities operated pursuant to G.S. 110‑106 may participate in the program that provides for the purchase of care in child care facilities for minor children of needy families. Except as authorized by subsection (f) of this section, no separate licensing requirements shall be used to select facilities to participate. In addition, child care facilities shall be required to meet any additional applicable requirements of federal law or regulations. Child care arrangements exempt from State regulation pursuant to Article 7 of Chapter 110 of the General Statutes shall meet the requirements established by other State law and by the Social Services Commission.
County departments of social services or other local contracting agencies shall not use a provider's failure to comply with requirements in addition to those specified in this subsection as a condition for reducing the provider's subsidized child care rate.
SECTION 12B.3.(h) Payment for subsidized child care services provided with Work First Block Grant funds shall comply with all regulations and policies issued by the Division of Child Development for the subsidized child care program.
SECTION 12B.3.(i) Noncitizen families who reside in this State legally shall be eligible for child care subsidies if all other conditions of eligibility are met. If all other conditions of eligibility are met, noncitizen families who reside in this State illegally shall be eligible for child care subsidies only if at least one of the following conditions is met:
(1) The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is receiving child protective services or foster care services.
(2) The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is developmentally delayed or at risk of being developmentally delayed.
(3) The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is a citizen of the United States.
SECTION 12B.3.(j) Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Child Development and Early Education, shall require all county departments of social services to include on any forms used to determine eligibility for child care subsidy whether the family waiting for subsidy is receiving assistance through the NC Pre‑K Program or Head Start.
SECTION 12B.4.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services shall allocate child care subsidy voucher funds to pay the costs of necessary child care for minor children of needy families. The mandatory thirty percent (30%) North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., subsidy allocation under G.S. 143B‑168.15(g) shall constitute the base amount for each county's child care subsidy allocation. The Department of Health and Human Services shall use the following method when allocating federal and State child care funds, not including the aggregate mandatory thirty percent (30%) North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., subsidy allocation:
(1) Funds shall be allocated to a county based upon the projected cost of serving children under age 11 in families with all parents working who earn less than seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income.
(2) No county's allocation shall be less than ninety percent (90%) of its State fiscal year 2001‑2002 initial child care subsidy allocation.
(3) For fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015, the Division of Child Development and Early Education shall base the formula identified in subdivision (1) of this subsection on the same data source used for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.
(4) The Department of Health and Human Services shall allocate to counties all State funds appropriated for child care subsidy and shall not withhold funds during the 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 fiscal years.
SECTION 12B.4.(b) The Department of Health and Human Services may reallocate unused child care subsidy voucher funds in order to meet the child care needs of low‑income families. Any reallocation of funds shall be based upon the expenditures of all child care subsidy voucher funding, including North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., funds within a county.
CHILD CARE FUNDS MATCHING REQUIREMENTS
SECTION 12B.5. No local matching funds may be required by the Department of Health and Human Services as a condition of any locality's receiving its initial allocation of child care funds appropriated by this act unless federal law requires a match. If the Department reallocates additional funds above twenty‑five thousand dollars ($25,000) to local purchasing agencies beyond their initial allocation, local purchasing agencies must provide a twenty percent (20%) local match to receive the reallocated funds. Matching requirements shall not apply when funds are allocated because of a disaster as defined in G.S. 166A‑19.3(6).
SECTION 12B.6. Notwithstanding any law to the contrary, funds budgeted for the Child Care Revolving Loan Fund may be transferred to and invested by the financial institution contracted to operate the Fund. The principal and any income to the Fund may be used to make loans, reduce loan interest to borrowers, serve as collateral for borrowers, pay the contractor's cost of operating the Fund, or pay the Department's cost of administering the program.
ADMINISTRATIVE ALLOWANCE FOR COUNTY DEPARTMENTS OF SOCIAL SERVICES/USE OF SUBSIDY FUNDS FOR FRAUD DETECTION
SECTION 12B.7.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Child Development and Early Education, shall fund the allowance that county departments of social services may use for administrative costs at four percent (4%) of the county's total child care subsidy funds allocated in the Child Care Development Fund Block Grant plan or eighty thousand dollars ($80,000), whichever is greater.
SECTION 12B.7.(b) Each county department of social services may use up to two percent (2%) of child care subsidy funds allocated to the county for fraud detection and investigation initiatives.
SECTION 12B.7.(c) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Child Development and Early Education, shall submit a progress report on the use of child care subsidy funds under subsection (b) of this section to the Joint Legislative Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division no later than May 1, 2014, and submit a follow-up report on the use of those funds no later than January 1, 2015.
STUDY USE OF UNIQUE STUDENT IDENTIFIER/CHILD CARE SUBSIDY
SECTION 12B.8.(a) In coordination with the Department of Public Instruction (DPI), the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Child Development and Early Education (DCDEE), shall study assigning a unique student identifier to monitor, throughout their education, the performance levels of children receiving child care subsidies. The study shall be designed to provide data on the efficacy of child care facilities participating in the child care subsidy program or the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc. The study shall define the requirements for the following:
(1) Establishing the unique identifier.
(2) Collecting, maintaining, and analyzing data.
(3) Recommending a solution that will allow for the cost‑effective acquisition and maintenance of data from child care facilities.
(4) Recommending an interface with DPI applications that monitors and analyzes student performance.
(5) Estimating the cost for developing an interface and implementing the requirements identified in the study.
SECTION 12B.8.(b) DCDEE shall report the results of the study to the Joint Legislative Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division no later than April 1, 2014.
EARLY CHILDHOOD EDUCATION AND DEVELOPMENT INITIATIVES ENHANCEMENTS/SALARY SCHEDULE/MATCH REQUIREMENT ADJUSTMENTS
SECTION 12B.9.(a) Policies. – The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and its Board shall establish policies that focus the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc.'s mission on improving child care quality in North Carolina for children from birth to five years of age. North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc.‑funded activities shall include assisting child care facilities with (i) improving quality, including helping one‑, two‑, and three‑star rated facilities increase their star ratings and (ii) implementing prekindergarten programs. State funding for local partnerships shall also be used for evidence‑based or evidence‑informed programs for children from birth to five years of age that do the following:
(1) Increase children's literacy.
(2) Increase the parents' ability to raise healthy, successful children.
(3) Improve children's health.
(4) Assist four‑ and five‑star rated facilities in improving and maintaining quality.
SECTION 12B.9.(b) Administration. – Administrative costs shall be equivalent to, on an average statewide basis for all local partnerships, not more than eight percent (8%) of the total statewide allocation to all local partnerships. For purposes of this subsection, administrative costs shall include costs associated with partnership oversight, business and financial management, general accounting, human resources, budgeting, purchasing, contracting, and information systems management. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall develop a single statewide contract management system that incorporates features of the required standard fiscal accountability plan described in G.S. 143B‑168.12(a)(4). All local partnerships shall be required to participate in the contract management system and shall be directed by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., to collaborate, to the fullest extent possible, with other local partnerships to increase efficiency and effectiveness.
SECTION 12B.9.(c) Salaries. – The salary schedule developed and implemented by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall set the maximum amount of State funds that may be used for the salary of the Executive Director of the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and the directors of the local partnerships. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall base the schedule on the following criteria:
(1) The population of the area serviced by a local partnership.
(2) The amount of State funds administered.
(3) The amount of total funds administered.
(4) The professional experience of the individual to be compensated.
(5) Any other relevant factors pertaining to salary, as determined by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc.
The salary schedule shall be used only to determine the maximum amount of State funds that may be used for compensation. Nothing in this subsection shall be construed to prohibit a local partnership from using non‑State funds to supplement an individual's salary in excess of the amount set by the salary schedule established under this subsection.
SECTION 12B.9.(d) Match Requirements. – It is the intent of the General Assembly to continue to increase the percentage of the match of cash and in‑kind contributions required of the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and the local partnerships. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and all local partnerships shall, in the aggregate, be required to match one hundred percent (100%) of the total amount budgeted for the program in each fiscal year of the biennium. Of the funds the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and the local partnerships are required to match, contributions of cash shall be equal to at least eleven percent (11%), and in‑kind donated resources shall be equal to no more than three percent (3%) for a total match requirement of fourteen percent (14%) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year; and contributions of cash shall be equal to at least eleven percent (11%), and in‑kind donated resources shall be equal to no more than four percent (4%) for a total match requirement of fifteen percent (15%) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., may carry forward any amount in excess of the required match for a fiscal year in order to meet the match requirement of the succeeding fiscal year. Only in‑kind contributions that are quantifiable shall be applied to the in‑kind match requirement. Volunteer services may be treated as an in‑kind contribution for the purpose of the match requirement of this subsection. Volunteer services that qualify as professional services shall be valued at the fair market value of those services. All other volunteer service hours shall be valued at the statewide average wage rate as calculated from data compiled by the Employment Security Commission in the Employment and Wages in North Carolina Annual Report for the most recent period for which data are available. Expenses, including both those paid by cash and in‑kind contributions, incurred by other participating non‑State entities contracting with the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnerships, also may be considered resources available to meet the required private match. In order to qualify to meet the required private match, the expenses shall:
(1) Be verifiable from the contractor's records.
(2) If in‑kind, other than volunteer services, be quantifiable in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for nonprofit organizations.
(3) Not include expenses funded by State funds.
(4) Be supplemental to and not supplant preexisting resources for related program activities.
(5) Be incurred as a direct result of the Early Childhood Initiatives Program and be necessary and reasonable for the proper and efficient accomplishment of the Program's objectives.
(6) Be otherwise allowable under federal or State law.
(7) Be required and described in the contractual agreements approved by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnership.
(8) Be reported to the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnership by the contractor in the same manner as reimbursable expenses.
SECTION 12B.9.(e) Bidding. – The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and all local partnerships shall use competitive bidding practices in contracting for goods and services on contract amounts as follows:
(1) For amounts of five thousand dollars ($5,000) or less, the procedures specified by a written policy to be developed by the Board of Directors of the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc.
(2) For amounts greater than five thousand dollars ($5,000), but less than fifteen thousand dollars ($15,000), three written quotes.
(3) For amounts of fifteen thousand dollars ($15,000) or more, but less than forty thousand dollars ($40,000), a request for proposal process.
(4) For amounts of forty thousand dollars ($40,000) or more, a request for proposal process and advertising in a major newspaper.
SECTION 12B.9.(f) Allocations. – The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall not reduce the allocation for counties with less than 35,000 in population below the 2012‑2013 funding level.
SECTION 12B.9.(g) Performance‑Based Evaluation. – The Department of Health and Human Services shall continue to implement the performance‑based evaluation system.
SECTION 12B.9.(h) Expenditure Restrictions. – The Department of Health and Human Services and the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall ensure that the allocation of funds for Early Childhood Education and Development Initiatives for State fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015 shall be administered and distributed in the following manner:
(1) Capital expenditures are prohibited for fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015. For the purposes of this section, "capital expenditures" means expenditures for capital improvements as defined in G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(5).
(2) Expenditures of State funds for advertising and promotional activities are prohibited for fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015.
For fiscal years 2013‑2014 and 2014‑2015, local partnerships shall not spend any State funds on marketing campaigns, advertising, or any associated materials. Local partnerships may spend any private funds the local partnerships receive on those activities.
SUBPART XII‑C. DIVISION OF SOCIAL SERVICES
REVISE DATES/TANF BENEFIT IMPLEMENTATION
SECTION 12C.1.(a) The General Assembly approves the plan titled "North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan 2012‑2015," prepared by the Department of Health and Human Services and presented to the General Assembly. The North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan covers the period October 1, 2012, through September 30, 2015. The Department shall submit the State Plan, as revised in accordance with subsection (b) of this section and as amended by this act or any other act of the 2013 General Assembly, to the United States Department of Health and Human Services.
SECTION 12C.1.(b) The counties approved as Electing Counties in the North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan 2012‑2015, as approved by this section are Beaufort, Caldwell, Catawba, Lenoir, Lincoln, Macon, and Wilson.
SECTION 12C.1.(c) Counties that submitted the letter of intent to remain as an Electing County or to be redesignated as an Electing County and the accompanying county plan for years 2012 through 2015 pursuant to G.S. 108A‑27(e) shall operate under the Electing County budget requirements effective July 1, 2012. For programmatic purposes, all counties referred to in this subsection shall remain under their current county designation through September 30, 2015.
SECTION 12C.1.(d) For each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, Electing Counties shall be held harmless to their Work First Family Assistance allocations for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year, provided that remaining funds allocated for Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance are sufficient for payments made by the Department on behalf of Standard Counties pursuant to G.S. 108A‑27.11(b).
SECTION 12C.1.(e) In the event that departmental projections of Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year or the 2014‑2015 fiscal year indicate that remaining funds are insufficient for Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance payments to be made on behalf of Standard Counties, the Department is authorized to deallocate funds, of those allocated to Electing Counties for Work First Family Assistance in excess of the sums set forth in G.S. 108A‑27.11, up to the requisite amount for payments in Standard Counties. Prior to deallocation, the Department shall obtain approval by the Office of State Budget and Management. If the Department adjusts the allocation set forth in subsection (d) of this section, then a report shall be made to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.
INTENSIVE FAMILY PRESERVATION SERVICES FUNDING AND PERFORMANCE ENHANCEMENTS
SECTION 12C.2.(a) Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 143B‑150.6, the Intensive Family Preservation Services (IFPS) Program shall provide intensive services to children and families in cases of abuse, neglect, and dependency where a child is at imminent risk of removal from the home and to children and families in cases of abuse where a child is not at imminent risk of removal. The Program shall be developed and implemented statewide on a regional basis. The IFPS shall ensure the application of standardized assessment criteria for determining imminent risk and clear criteria for determining out‑of‑home placement.
SECTION 12C.2.(b) The Department of Health and Human Services shall require that any program or entity that receives State, federal, or other funding for the purpose of IFPS shall provide information and data that allows for the following:
(1) An established follow‑up system with a minimum of six months of follow‑up services.
(2) Detailed information on the specific interventions applied, including utilization indicators and performance measurement.
(3) Cost‑benefit data.
(4) Data on long‑term benefits associated with IFPS. This data shall be obtained by tracking families through the intervention process.
(5) The number of families remaining intact and the associated interventions while in IFPS and 12 months thereafter.
(6) The number and percentage, by race, of children who received IFPS compared to the ratio of their distribution in the general population involved with Child Protective Services.
SECTION 12C.2.(c) The Department shall establish a performance‑based funding protocol and shall only provide funding to those programs and entities providing the required information specified in subsection (b) of this section. The amount of funding shall be based on the individual performance of each program.
SECTION 12C.3. Until the Social Services Commission adopts rules setting standardized rates for child caring institutions as authorized under G.S. 143B‑153(8), the maximum reimbursement for child caring institutions shall not exceed the rate established for the specific child caring institution by the Department of Health and Human Services, Office of the Controller. In determining the maximum reimbursement, the State shall include county and IV‑E reimbursements.
USE OF FOSTER CARE BUDGET FOR GUARDIANSHIP ASSISTANCE PROGRAM
SECTION 12C.4. Of the funds available for the provision of foster care services, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, may provide for the financial support of children who are deemed to be (i) in a permanent family placement setting, (ii) eligible for legal guardianship, and (iii) otherwise unlikely to receive permanency. The Division of Social Services shall design the Guardianship Assistance Program (GAP) in such a manner that no additional expenses are incurred beyond the funds budgeted for foster care. The Guardianship Assistance Program rates shall reimburse the legal guardian for room and board and be set at the same rate as the foster care room and board rates in accordance with rates established under G.S. 108A‑49.1. The Social Services Board shall adopt rules establishing a Guardianship Assistance Program to implement this section, including defining the phrase "legal guardian" as used in this section.
CHILD WELFARE POSTSECONDARY SUPPORT PROGRAM (NC REACH)
SECTION 12C.5.(a) Additional funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services for the child welfare postsecondary support program in the amount of two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and four hundred thousand dollars ($400,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used for the expansion of the child welfare postsecondary support program. The funds shall be used to continue providing assistance with the "cost of attendance" as that term is defined in 20 U.S.C. § 108711 for the educational needs of foster youth aging out of the foster care system and special needs children adopted from foster care after age 12. These funds shall be allocated by the State Education Assistance Authority.
SECTION 12C.5.(b) Of the funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services, the sum of fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be allocated to the North Carolina State Education Assistance Authority (SEAA). The SEAA shall use these funds only to perform administrative functions necessary to manage and distribute scholarship funds under the child welfare postsecondary support program.
SECTION 12C.5.(c) Of the funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services, the sum of three hundred thirty‑nine thousand four hundred ninety‑three dollars ($339,493) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of three hundred thirty‑nine thousand four hundred ninety‑three dollars ($339,493) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used to contract with an entity to administer the child welfare postsecondary support program described under subsection (a) of this section, which administration shall include the performance of case management services.
SECTION 12C.5.(d) Funds appropriated to the Department of Health and Human Services for the child welfare postsecondary support program shall be used only for students attending public institutions of higher education in this State.
DSS STUDY/PROCEDURES FOR REPORTING CHILD ABUSE
SECTION 12C.7.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, shall study the policies and procedures in place for reporting child abuse. In conducting the study, the Division shall review the following:
(1) Reports of child abuse in child care facilities.
(2) How reports of child abuse are received.
(3) The number of inaccurate reports of child abuse the Division receives annually.
(4) The number of children the Division has placed in child protective services pursuant to a report of child abuse.
(5) The reasons a child is placed in child protective services pursuant to a report of child abuse.
(6) The procedures the Division follows after determining child abuse has occurred as well as the procedures the Division follows after determining child abuse has not occurred.
(7) The number of reports the Division has determined to be false and a summary of actions taken in response to false reports.
(8) Procedures and actions the Division follows in removing or redacting reports or other information made available to the public regarding an individual accused of child abuse or a child care facility where the alleged abuse occurred when there is a determination that no abuse has occurred.
(9) Any recommendations the Division has for improving the process for reporting instances of child abuse.
SECTION 12C.7.(b) The Division of Social Services shall report the results of the study and any recommendations to the Joint Legislative Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division no later than April 1, 2014.
CODIFY WORK FIRST FAMILY ASSISTANCE ELIGIBILITY AND PAYMENT LEVELS
SECTION 12C.8. Part 2 of Article 2 of Chapter 108A of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read as follows:
"§ 108A‑27A. Income eligibility and payment level for Work First Family Assistance.
The maximum net family annual income eligibility standards for Work First Family Assistance are the same standards of need for eligibility for the categorically needy under the Medicaid Program. The payment level for Work First Family Assistance shall be fifty percent (50%) of the standard of need."
A FAMILY FOR EVERY CHILD/PROVISION OF FOSTER CARE
SECTION 12C.10.(a) Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, the sum of one million five hundred thousand dollars ($1,500,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of one million five hundred thousand dollars ($1,500,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used to restore funding to the Adoption Promotion Fund to (i) reimburse private nonprofit organizations pursuant to performance‑based contracts to support adoption programs and (ii) provide a financial incentive to public county departments of social services to complete adoptions above an established baseline.
SECTION 12C.10.(b) Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, the sum of one million dollars ($1,000,000) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of two million seven hundred fifty thousand dollars ($2,750,000) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used solely for the Permanency Innovation Initiative Fund for services provided by the Children's Home Society of North Carolina as established by G.S. 131D‑10.9B, enacted in subsection (e) of this section.
SECTION 12C.10.(c) G.S. 108A‑50.2 reads as rewritten:
"§
108A‑50.2. Special Children Adoption Promotion Fund.
(a) Funds appropriated by
the General Assembly to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division
of Social Services, for the Special Children Adoption Promotion Fund
shall be used as provided in this section. The Division of Social Services of
the Department of Health and Human Services, in consultation with the North
Carolina Association of County Directors of Social Services and representatives
of licensed private adoption agencies, shall develop guidelines for the
awarding of funds to licensed public and private adoption agencies upon the
adoption of children described in G.S. 108A‑50 and in foster care.
Payments received from the Special Children Adoption Promotion Fund
by participating agencies shall be used exclusively to enhance the adoption
services. No local match shall be required as a condition for receipt of these
funds. In accordance with State rules for allowable costs, the Special
Children Adoption Promotion Fund may be used for post‑adoption
services for families whose income exceeds two hundred percent (200%) of the
federal poverty level.
(b) Of the total funds
appropriated for the Special Children Adoption Promotion Fund
each year, twenty percent (20%) of the total funds available shall be reserved
for payment to participating private adoption agencies. If the funds reserved
in this subsection for payments to private agencies have not been spent on or
before March 31 of each State fiscal year, the Division of Social Services may
reallocate those funds, in accordance with this section, to other participating
adoption agencies.
(c) The Division of Social
Services shall monitor the total expenditures in the Special Children
Adoption Promotion Fund and redistribute unspent funds to ensure that
the funds are used in accordance with the guidelines established in subsection
(a) of this section."
SECTION 12C.10.(d) G.S. 131D‑10.1 through G.S. 131D‑10.9 are recodified as Part 1 of Article 1A of Chapter 131D of the General Statutes.
SECTION 12C.10.(e) Article 1A of Chapter 131D of the General Statutes is amended by adding the following new Part to read:
"Part 2. A Family for Every Child Initiative.
"§ 131D‑10.9A. Permanency Innovation Initiative Oversight Committee created.
(a) Creation and Membership. – The Permanency Innovation Initiative Oversight Committee is established. The Committee shall be located administratively in the General Assembly. The Committee shall consist of 11 members serving staggered terms. In making appointments, each appointing authority shall select members who have appropriate experience and knowledge of the issues to be examined by the Committee and shall strive to ensure racial, gender, and geographical diversity among the membership. The initial Committee members shall be appointed on or after July 1, 2013, as follows:
(1) Four members shall be appointed by the General Assembly upon recommendation of the Speaker of the House of Representatives. Of the members appointed under this subdivision, at least one shall be a member of the judiciary who shall serve for a term of two years and at least one shall be a representative from the Children's Home Society of North Carolina who shall serve for a term of three years. One member of the House shall be appointed for a one‑year term. The remaining appointee shall serve a one‑year term.
(2) Four members shall be appointed by the General Assembly upon the recommendation of the President Pro Tempore of the Senate. Of the members appointed under this subdivision, at least one shall be a representative from the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, who shall serve for a term of two years and at least one shall be a representative from The Duke Endowment who shall serve for a term of three years. One member of the Senate shall be appointed for a one‑year term. The remaining appointee shall serve a one‑year term.
(3) Three members shall be appointed by the Governor. Of the members appointed under this subdivision, at least one shall be a representative from a county department of social services who shall serve for a term of three years and at least one shall be a representative from the University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill who shall serve for a term of two years. The remaining member shall serve a one‑year term.
(b) Terms. – Upon the expiration of the terms of the initial Committee members, each member shall be appointed for a term of three years and shall serve until a successor is appointed. No member may serve more than two consecutive full terms. A vacancy shall be filled within 30 days by the authority making the initial appointment.
(c) Purpose and Powers. – The Committee shall:
(1) Design and implement a data tracking methodology to collect and analyze information to gauge the success of the initiative.
(2) Develop a methodology to identify short‑ and long‑term cost‑savings in the provision of foster care and any potential reinvestment strategies.
(3) Oversee program implementation to ensure fidelity to the program models identified under subdivisions (1) and (2) of G.S. 131D‑10.9B(a).
(4) Study, review, and recommend other policies and services that may positively impact permanency and well‑being outcomes.
(d) Reports. – The Committee shall report its analysis and any findings and recommendations to the General Assembly by September 15 of each year.
(e) Organization. – The President Pro Tempore of the Senate and the Speaker of the House of Representatives shall each designate a cochair of the Committee. The Committee shall meet at least once a quarter upon the joint call of the cochairs. A quorum of the Committee is seven members. No action may be taken except by a majority vote at a meeting at which a quorum is present.
(f) Funding. – From funds available to the General Assembly, the Legislative Services Commission shall allocate monies to fund the work of the Committee. Members of the Committee shall receive subsistence and travel expenses as provided in G.S. 120‑3.1 and G.S. 138‑5.
(g) Staff. – The Legislative Services Commission, through the Legislative Services Officer, shall assign professional staff to assist the Committee in its work. Upon the direction of the Legislative Services Commission, the Director of Legislative Assistants of the Senate and of the House of Representatives shall assign clerical staff to the Committee. The expenses for clerical employees shall be borne by the Committee.
"§ 131D‑10.9B. Permanency Innovation Initiative Fund.
(a) There is created the Permanency Innovation Initiative Fund that will support a demonstration project with services provided by Children's Home Society of North Carolina to (i) improve permanency outcomes for children living in foster care through reunification with parents, providing placement or guardianship with other relatives, or adoption, (ii) improve engagement with biological relatives of children in or at risk of entering foster care, and (iii) reduce costs associated with maintaining children in foster care. In implementing these goals, the Permanency Innovation Initiative Fund shall support the following strategies:
(1) Family Finding, which is a program that uses intensive biological family engagement services to discover and engage biological relatives of children living in public foster care to provide permanent emotional and relational support, including adoption, legal guardianship, or legal custody.
(2) Child Specific Adoption Recruitment Services, which is a program that follows the Wendy's Wonderful Kids Model as developed by The Dave Thomas Foundation for Adoption and works with children in public foster care to develop and execute adoption recruitment plans tailored to the needs of the individual child.
(3) Permanency Training Services, which are services delivered by Children's Home Society of North Carolina to assess the readiness of county departments of social services to implement the permanency strategies under subdivisions (1) and (2) of this subsection and provide training services to support the delivery of the services.
(b) This program shall not constitute an entitlement and is subject to the availability of funds.
(c) The Social Services Commission shall adopt rules to implement the provisions of this section."
SUBPART XII‑D. DIVISION OF AGING AND ADULT SERVICES
TIERED STATE‑COUNTY SPECIAL ASSISTANCE PILOT
SECTION 12D.2.(a) As used in this section, the term "group home" means any facility that (i) is licensed under Chapter 122C of the General Statutes, (ii) meets the definition of a supervised living facility under 10A NCAC 27G .5601(c)(1) or 10A NCAC 27G .5601(c)(3), and (iii) serves adults whose primary diagnosis is mental illness or a developmental disability but may also have other diagnoses.
SECTION 12D.2.(b) It is the intent of the General Assembly to create a State‑County Special Assistance program that allows counties greater flexibility in serving individual needs within their communities and greater control over how county funds are used to support this program in light of the fact that counties are required to pay for fifty percent (50%) of the costs of this program. To that end, the General Assembly directs the Department of Health and Human Services to establish a pilot program in accordance with subsection (c) of this section.
SECTION 12D.2.(c) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Aging and Adult Services (Department), shall establish a pilot program to implement a tiered rate structure within the State‑County Special Assistance program for individuals residing in group homes, in‑home living arrangements, and assisted living residences as defined in G.S. 131D‑2.1. The purposes of the pilot program are to (i) determine the best way to implement a block grant for this program statewide and (ii) test the feasibility and effectiveness of implementing a tiered rate structure to address program participants' intensity of need, including medication management. The Department shall select a minimum of four and a maximum of six counties to participate in the pilot program, at least two of which shall be rural counties and at least two of which shall be urban counties. The pilot program shall (i) be implemented during the 2013‑2014 fiscal year, (ii) operate for at least a 12‑month period, and (iii) comply with any agreements in effect between the State of North Carolina and the United States government.
SECTION 12D.2.(d) The Department shall implement the pilot program in collaboration with the local departments of social services in the counties selected for participation. As part of the pilot program, the selected counties shall receive a State General Fund allocation as a block grant to be equally matched with county general funds. The General Fund allocation provided to each county participating in the pilot program shall be calculated based upon the average annual Special Assistance expenditures for that county during the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium, adjusted for the amount of projected annual growth in the number of Special Assistance recipients in that county during the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium. These funds may be used to pay for room, board, and personal care services, including medication management, for individuals eligible to receive State‑County Special Assistance, subject to the following limitations and requirements:
(1) These funds shall not be used to cover any portion of the cost of providing services for which an individual receives Medicaid coverage.
(2) The pilot program shall comply with all federal and State requirements governing the existing State‑County Special Assistance program, except that Section 12D.3 does not apply to the pilot program.
(3) The tiered rate structure shall be based upon intensity of need, and an individual's placement within a tier shall be based upon an independent assessment of the individual's need for room, board, and assistance with activities of daily living, including medication management.
SECTION 12D.2.(e) By February 1, 2014, the Department shall submit a progress report on the implementation and operation of the pilot program, including any obstacles to implementation; and by February 1, 2015, the Department shall submit a final report on the results of the pilot program, along with any recommendations based on these results, to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division. The report due by February 1, 2015, shall include information from all participating counties on at least all of the following:
(1) The amount of the tiered rates implemented as part of the pilot program.
(2) The cost methodology for determining these tiered rates.
(3) The number of individuals participating in the pilot program while residing in a group home.
(4) The number of individuals participating in the pilot program while residing in an in‑home living arrangement.
(5) The number of individuals participating in the pilot program while residing in an assisted living residence as defined by G.S. 131D‑2.1, broken down by facility type.
(6) A comparison of the number of recipients of State‑County Special Assistance prior to and during the pilot program, broken down by county and living arrangement.
(7) Any other information the Department deems relevant for determining the best way to implement a block grant statewide for the State‑County Special Assistance program.
STATE‑COUNTY SPECIAL ASSISTANCE
SECTION 12D.3.(a) For each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the maximum monthly rate for residents in adult care home facilities shall be one thousand one hundred eighty‑two dollars ($1,182) per month per resident.
SECTION 12D.3.(b) For each year of the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium, the maximum monthly rate for residents in Alzheimer's/Dementia special care units shall be one thousand five hundred fifteen dollars ($1,515) per month per resident.
SUBPART XII‑E. DIVISION OF PUBLIC HEALTH
INCREASE PERMIT FEES FOR CERTAIN FOOD AND LODGING ESTABLISHMENTS
SECTION 12E.1.(a) G.S. 130A‑247 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(8) "Temporary food establishment" means an establishment not otherwise exempted from this part pursuant to G.S. 130A‑250 that (i) prepares or serves food, (ii) operates for a period of time not to exceed 21 days in one location, and (iii) is affiliated with and endorsed by a transitory fair, carnival, circus, festival, or public exhibition."
SECTION 12E.1.(b) G.S. 130A‑248(d) reads as rewritten:
"(d) The Department
shall charge each establishment subject to this section, except nutrition
programs for the elderly administered by the Division of Aging and Adult
Services of the Department of Health and Human Services, establishments that
prepare and sell meat food products or poultry products, temporary food
establishments, limited food services establishments, and public school
cafeterias, a fee of seventy‑fiveone hundred twenty dollars
($75.00)($120.00) for each permit issued. This fee shall be
reassessed annually for permits that do not expire. The Commission shall adopt
rules to implement this subsection. Fees collected under this subsection shall
be used for State and local food, lodging, and institution sanitation programs
and activities. No more than thirty‑three and one‑third percent
(33 1/3%) of the feesfifty dollars ($50.00) of each fee collected
under this subsection may be used to support State health programs and
activities."
SECTION 12E.1.(c) G.S. 130A‑248(d1) reads as rewritten:
"(d1) The Department shall charge a twenty‑five dollar ($25.00) late payment fee to any establishment subject to this section, except nutrition programs for the elderly administered by the Division of Aging of the Department of Health and Human Services, establishments that prepare and sell meat food products or poultry products, temporary food establishments, limited food services establishments, and public school cafeterias, that fails to pay the fee required by subsection (d) of this section within 45 days after billing by the Department. The Department may, in accordance with G.S. 130A‑23, suspend the permit of an establishment that fails to pay the required fee within 60 days after billing by the Department. The Department shall charge a reinstatement fee of one hundred fifty dollars ($150.00) to any establishment that requests reinstatement of its permit after the permit has been suspended. The Commission shall adopt rules to implement this subsection.
The clear proceeds of civil penalties collected pursuant to this subsection shall be remitted to the Civil Penalty and Forfeiture Fund in accordance with G.S. 115C‑457.2."
SECTION 12E.1.(d) G.S. 130A‑248 is amended by adding a new subsection to read:
"(d2) A local health department shall charge each temporary food establishment and each limited food services establishment a fee of seventy‑five dollars ($75.00) for each permit issued. A local health department shall use all fees collected under this subsection for local food, lodging, and institution sanitation programs and activities."
SECTION 12E.1.(e) Subsections (a) through (d) of this section become effective on August 1, 2013, and apply to food and lodging permits effective or reassessed on or after August 1, 2013.
SECTION 12E.1.(f) Section 31.11A of S.L. 2011‑145, as amended by Section 61A of S.L. 2011‑391 and Section 10.15 of S.L. 2012‑142, is repealed.
MODIFICATIONS TO ORAL HEALTH STRATEGY
SECTION 12E.2.(a) The General Assembly encourages local health departments to increase access to direct clinical care and preventive oral health services in the dental clinics operated or sponsored by local health departments.
SECTION 12E.2.(b) Effective October 1, 2013, the Secretary of Health and Human Services shall eliminate at least 15 full‑time equivalent positions within the Oral Health Section of the Division of Public Health in order to achieve a savings of at least six hundred thirty‑seven five hundred thousand dollars ($637,500) during the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and at least eight hundred fifty thousand dollars ($850,000) during the 2014‑2015 fiscal year.
SECTION 12E.2.(c) By no later than February 1, 2014, the Department shall submit a revised statewide oral health strategic plan to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division. The plan shall include at least all of the following:
(1) Recommendations for reorganizing the Department's Oral Health Section.
(2) Strategies for reducing oral diseases through prevention, education, and health promotion services.
(3) Strategies for monitoring public oral health.
(4) Strategies for increasing access to dental care.
SECTION 12E.3.(a) All funds appropriated in this act for the School Nurse Funding Initiative shall be used to supplement and not supplant other State, local, or federal funds appropriated or allocated for this purpose. Communities shall maintain their current level of effort and funding for school nurses. These funds shall not be used to fund nurses for State agencies. These funds shall be distributed to local health departments according to a formula that includes all of the following:
(1) School nurse‑to‑student ratio.
(2) Percentage of students eligible for free or reduced meals.
(3) Percentage of children in poverty.
(4) Per capita income.
(5) Eligibility as a low‑wealth county.
(6) Mortality rates for children between one and 19 years of age.
(7) Percentage of students with chronic illnesses.
(8) Percentage of county population consisting of minority persons.
SECTION 12E.3.(b) The Division of Public Health shall ensure that school nurses funded with State funds (i) do not assist in any instructional or administrative duties associated with a school's curriculum and (ii) perform all of the following with respect to school health programs:
(1) Serve as the coordinator of the health services program and provide nursing care.
(2) Provide health education to students, staff, and parents.
(3) Identify health and safety concerns in the school environment and promote a nurturing school environment.
(4) Support healthy food services programs.
(5) Promote healthy physical education, sports policies, and practices.
(6) Provide health counseling, assess mental health needs, provide interventions, and refer students to appropriate school staff or community agencies.
(7) Promote community involvement in assuring a healthy school and serve as school liaison to a health advisory committee.
(8) Provide health education and counseling and promote healthy activities and a healthy environment for school staff.
(9) Be available to assist the county health department during a public health emergency.
SECTION 12E.3.(c) Section 6.9(b) of S.L. 2011‑145, as amended by Section 6.2 of S.L. 2012‑142, is repealed.
CHILDREN'S DEVELOPMENTAL SERVICE AGENCIES
SECTION 12E.4. In order to achieve the reduced amount of State funds appropriated in this act for the Children's Developmental Service Agencies (CDSAs) program, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Public Health, may close up to four CDSAs, effective July 1, 2014. The Department shall retain the CDSA located in the City of Morganton and the CDSAs with the highest caseloads of children residing in rural and medically underserved areas. If the Department elects to close one or more CDSAs pursuant to this section, it shall submit a report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division no later than March 1, 2014, identifying the CDSAs selected for closure.
SECTION 12E.5.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services shall work with the Department of Public Safety (DPS) to use DPS funds to purchase pharmaceuticals for the treatment of individuals in the custody of DPS who have been diagnosed with Human Immunodeficiency Virus or Acquired Immune Deficiency Syndrome (HIV/AIDS) in a manner that allows these funds to be accounted for as State matching funds in the Department of Health and Human Services drawdown of federal Ryan White funds earmarked for the AIDS Drug Assistance Program (ADAP).
SECTION 12E.5.(b) By no later than April 1, 2014, and by no later than April 1, 2015, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Public Health, shall submit a report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division on alternative options for serving individuals diagnosed with HIV/AIDS who are eligible to receive services under ADAP, including the State Medicaid program and the federally facilitated Health Benefit Exchange that will operate in this State.
COMMUNITY‑FOCUSED ELIMINATING HEALTH DISPARITIES INITIATIVE
SECTION 12E.6.(a) Funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Public Health, for the Community‑Focused Eliminating Health Disparities Initiative (CFEHDI) shall be used to provide a maximum of 12 grants‑in‑aid to close the gap in the health status of African‑Americans, Hispanics/Latinos, and American Indians as compared to the health status of white persons. These grants‑in‑aid shall focus on the use of measures to eliminate or reduce health disparities among minority populations in this State with respect to heart disease, stroke, diabetes, obesity, asthma, HIV/AIDS, and cancer. The Office of Minority Health shall coordinate and implement the grants‑in‑aid program authorized by this section.
SECTION 12E.6.(b) In implementing the grants‑in‑aid program authorized by subsection (a) of this section, the Department shall ensure all of the following:
(1) The amount of any grant‑in‑aid is limited to three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000).
(2) Only community‑based organizations, faith‑based organizations, local health departments, hospitals, and CCNC networks located in urban and rural areas of the western, eastern, and Piedmont areas of this State are eligible to apply for these grants‑in‑aid. No more than four grants‑in‑aid shall be awarded to applicants located in any one of the three areas specified in this subdivision.
(3) Each eligible applicant shall be required to demonstrate substantial participation and involvement with all other categories of eligible applicants, in order to ensure an evidence‑based medical home model that will affect change in health and geographic disparities.
(4) Eligible applicants shall select one or more of the following chronic illnesses or conditions specific to the applicant's geographic area as the basis for applying for a grant‑in‑aid under this section to affect change in the health status of African‑Americans, Hispanics/Latinos, or American Indians:
a. Heart Disease.
b. Stroke.
c. Diabetes.
d. Obesity.
e. Asthma.
f. HIV/AIDS.
g. Cancer.
(5) The minimum duration of the grant period for any grant‑in‑aid is two years.
(6) The maximum duration of the grant period for any grant‑in‑aid is three years.
(7) If approved for a grant‑in‑aid, the grantee (i) shall not use more than eight percent (8%) of the grant funds for overhead costs and (ii) shall be required at the end of the grant period to demonstrate significant gains in addressing one or more of the health disparity focus areas identified in subsection (a) of this section.
(8) An independent panel with expertise in the delivery of services to minority populations, health disparities, chronic illnesses and conditions, and HIV/AIDS shall conduct the review of applications for grants‑in‑aid. The Department shall establish the independent panel required by this section.
SECTION 12E.6.(c) The grants‑in‑aid awarded under this section shall be awarded in honor of the memory of the following deceased members of the General Assembly: Bernard Allen, Pete Cunningham, John Hall, Robert Holloman, Howard Hunter, Ed Jones, Jeanne Lucas, Vernon Malone, William Martin, and William Wainwright. These funds shall be used for concerted efforts to address large gaps in health status among North Carolinians who are African‑American, as well as disparities among other minority populations in North Carolina.
SECTION 12E.6.(d) Section 10.21(d) of S.L. 2011‑145 reads as rewritten:
"SECTION 10.21.(d) By
October 1, 2012, and annually thereafter,October 1, 2013, the
Department shall submit a report to the House of Representatives
Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate
Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint
Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal
Research Division on funds appropriated to the CFEHDI. The report shall include
specific activities undertaken pursuant to subsection (a) of this section to
address large gaps in health status among North Carolinians who are African‑American
and other minority populations in this State, and shall also address all of the
following:
(1) Which community‑based organizations, faith‑based organizations, local health departments, hospitals, and CCNC networks received CFEHDI grants‑in‑aid.
(2) The amount of funding awarded to each grantee.
(3) Which of the minority populations were served by each grantee.
(4) Which community‑based organizations, faith‑based organizations, local health departments, hospitals, and CCNC networks were involved in fulfilling the goals and activities of each grant‑in‑aid awarded under this section and what activities were planned and implemented by the grantee to fulfill the community focus of the CFEHDI program.
(5) How the activities implemented by the grantee fulfilled the goal of reducing health disparities among minority populations, and the specific success in reducing particular incidences."
STRATEGIES FOR IMPROVING MEN'S HEALTH
SECTION 12E.7. Article 7 of Chapter 130A of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new Part to read:
"Part 5A. Men's Health.
"§ 130A‑223.1. Department to establish strategies for improving men's health.
The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Public Health, Chronic Disease and Injury Prevention Section, shall work to expand the State's attention and focus on the prevention of disease and improvement in the quality of life for men over their entire lifespan. The Department shall develop strategies for achieving these goals, which shall include, but not be limited to, all of the following:
(1) Developing a strategic plan to improve health care services.
(2) Building public health awareness.
(3) Developing initiatives within existing programs.
(4) Pursuing federal and State funding for the screening, early detection, and treatment of prostate cancer and other diseases affecting men's health."
INCREASE NORTH CAROLINA MEDICAL EXAMINER AUTOPSY FEES
SECTION 12E.8.(a) G.S. 130A‑389(a) reads as rewritten:
"(a) If, in the opinion
of the medical examiner investigating the case or of the Chief Medical
Examiner, it is advisable and in the public interest that an autopsy or other
study be made; or, if an autopsy or other study is requested by the district
attorney of the county or by any superior court judge, an autopsy or other
study shall be made by the Chief Medical Examiner or by a competent pathologist
designated by the Chief Medical Examiner. A complete autopsy report of findings
and interpretations, prepared on forms designated for the purpose, shall be
submitted promptly to the Chief Medical Examiner. Subject to the limitations of
G.S. 130A‑389.1 relating to photographs and video or audio
recordings of an autopsy, a copy of the report shall be furnished to any person
upon request. A fee for the autopsy or other study shall be paid by the State.
However, if the deceased is a resident of the county in which the death or
fatal injury occurred, that county shall pay the fee. The fee shall be one
thousand two hundred fifty dollars ($1,000).($1,250)."
SECTION 12E.8.(b) This section becomes effective August 1, 2013, and applies to fees imposed for autopsies performed on or after that date.
SUBPART XII‑F. DIVISION OF MH/DD/SAS AND STATE OPERATED HEALTHCARE FACILITIES
FUNDS FOR LOCAL INPATIENT PSYCHIATRIC BEDS OR BED DAYS
SECTION 12F.2.(a) Use of Funds. – Of the funds appropriated in Section 2.1 of this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, for crisis services, the sum of thirty‑eight million one hundred twenty‑one thousand six hundred forty‑four dollars ($38,121,644) for the 2013‑2014 fiscal year and the sum of thirty‑eight million one hundred twenty‑one thousand six hundred forty‑four dollars ($38,121,644) for the 2014‑2015 fiscal year shall be used to purchase additional local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days not currently funded by or though LME/MCOs. The Department shall develop and implement a two‑tiered system of payment for purchasing these local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days based on acuity level, with an enhanced rate of payment for inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days for individuals with higher acuity levels, as defined by the Department. The enhanced rate of payment for inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days for individuals with higher acuity levels shall not exceed the lowest average cost per patient bed day among the State psychiatric hospitals. In addition, at the discretion of the Secretary of Health and Human Services, existing funds allocated to LME/MCOs for community‑based mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services may be used to purchase additional local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days. Funds designated in this subsection for the purchase of local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days shall not be used to supplant other funds appropriated or otherwise available to the Department for the purchase of inpatient psychiatric services through contracts with local hospitals.
SECTION 12F.2.(b) Distribution and Management of Beds or Bed Days. – The Department shall work to ensure that any local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days purchased in accordance with this section are distributed across the State in LME/MCO catchment areas and according to need as determined by the Department. The Department shall ensure that beds or bed days for individuals with higher acuity levels are distributed across the State in LME catchment areas, including any catchment areas served by managed care organizations, and according to greatest need based on hospital bed utilization data. The Department shall enter into contracts with LME/MCOs and local hospitals for the management of these beds or bed days. The Department shall work to ensure that these contracts are awarded equitably around all regions of the State. LME/MCOs shall manage and control these local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days, including the determination of the specific local hospital or State psychiatric hospital to which an individual should be admitted pursuant to an involuntary commitment order.
SECTION 12F.2.(c) Funds to be Held in Statewide Reserve. – Funds appropriated to the Department for the purchase of local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days shall not be allocated to LME/MCOs but shall be held in a statewide reserve at the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services to pay for services authorized by the LME/MCOs and billed by the hospitals through the LME/MCOs. LME/MCOs shall remit claims for payment to the Department within 15 working days after receipt of a clean claim from the hospital and shall pay the hospital within 30 working days after receipt of payment from the Department.
SECTION 12F.2.(d) Ineffective LME/MCO Management of Beds or Bed Days. – If the Department determines that (i) an LME/MCO is not effectively managing the beds or bed days for which it has responsibility, as evidenced by beds or bed days in the local hospital not being utilized while demand for services at the State psychiatric hospitals has not reduced, or (ii) the LME/MCO has failed to comply with the prompt payment provisions of subsection (c) of this section, the Department may contract with another LME/MCO to manage the beds or bed days or, notwithstanding any other provision of law to the contrary, may pay the hospital directly.
SECTION 12F.2.(e) Reporting by LME/MCOs. – The Department shall establish reporting requirements for LME/MCOs regarding the utilization of these beds or bed days.
SECTION 12F.2.(f) Reporting by Department. – By no later than March 1, 2014, the Department shall report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division on all of the following:
(1) A uniform system for beds or bed days purchased during the fiscal year ending June 30, 2013, from (i) funds appropriated in this act that are designated for this purpose in subsection (a) of this section, (ii) existing State appropriations, and (iii) local funds.
(2) Other Department initiatives funded by State appropriations to reduce State psychiatric hospital use.
SECTION 12F.2.(g) Repeal of Hospital Utilization Pilot. – Sections 10.49(s1) through 10.49(s5) of S.L. 2007‑323 are repealed.
FUNDS FOR THE NORTH CAROLINA CHILD TREATMENT PROGRAM
SECTION 12F.3.(a) Recurring funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium for the North Carolina Child Treatment Program (NC CTP) shall be used for the following purposes:
(1) To provide clinical training and coaching to licensed Medicaid clinicians on an array of evidence‑based treatments and to provide a statewide platform to assure accountability and outcomes.
(2) To maintain and manage a public roster of program graduates, linking high‑quality clinicians with children, families, and professionals.
(3) To partner with State, LME/MCO, and private sector leadership to bring effective mental health treatment to children in juvenile justice and mental health facilities.
SECTION 12F.3.(b) Nonrecurring funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, for the 2013‑2015 fiscal biennium for the North Carolina Child Treatment Program (NC CTP) shall be used to pay for the cost of developing a secure database for the NC CTP to track individual‑level and aggregate‑level data with interface capability to work with existing networks within State agencies. The data, including any entered or stored in the database, is and remains the sole property of the State.
SINGLE STREAM FUNDING FOR MH/DD/SAS COMMUNITY SERVICES
SECTION 12F.4.(a) For the purpose of mitigating cash flow problems that many LME/MCOs experience at the beginning of each fiscal year relative to single stream funding, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, shall distribute not less than one‑twelfth of each LME/MCO's continuation allocation at the beginning of the fiscal year and subtract the amount of that distribution from the LME/MCO's total reimbursements for the fiscal year.
SECTION 12F.4.(b) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, shall periodically review and, as deemed necessary by the Department, update the set of standardized covered benefits developed and implemented by the Department pursuant to Section 10.11(b) of S.L. 2011‑145 for recipients of LME/MCO community service funds; provided, however, the Department shall not implement any updates that increase the overall cost of these standardized covered benefits.
BEHAVIORAL HEALTH CLINICAL INTEGRATION AND PERFORMANCE MONITORING
SECTION 12F.4A.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services shall require local management entities, including local management entities that have been approved to operate the 1915(b)/(c) Medicaid Waiver (LME/MCOs), to implement clinical integration activities with Community Care of North Carolina (CCNC) through Total Care, a collaborative initiative designed to improve and minimize the cost of care for patients who suffer from comorbid mental health or substance abuse and primary care or other chronic conditions.
SECTION 12F.4A.(b) The Department shall ensure that, by no later than January 1, 2014, all LME/MCOs submit claims data, including to the extent practical, retrospective claims data and integrated payment and reporting system (IPRS) data, to the CCNC Informatics Center and to the Medicaid Management Information System. Upon receipt of this claims data, CCNC shall provide access to clinical data and care management information within the CCNC Informatics Center to LME/MCOs and authorized behavioral health providers to support (i) treatment, quality assessment, and improvement activities or (ii) coordination of appropriate and effective patient care, treatment, or habilitation.
SECTION 12F.4A.(c) The Department, in consultation with CCNC and the LME/MCOs, shall develop quality and performance statistics on the status of mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services, including, but not limited to, variations in total cost of care, clinical outcomes, and access to and utilization of services.
SECTION 12F.4A.(d) The Department shall, within available appropriations and as deemed necessary by the Department, expand or alter existing contracts by mutual agreement of all parties to the contract in order to implement the provisions of this section.
SECTION 12F.4A.(e) By no later than March 1, 2014, and semiannually thereafter, the Department shall submit a report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division on the progress, outcomes, and savings associated with the implementation of clinical integration activities with CCNC pursuant to this section.
MH/DD/SAS HEALTH CARE INFORMATION SYSTEM PROJECT
SECTION 12F.5. The Department of Health and Human Services shall not take any further action or expend any funds appropriated or available to the Department to develop and implement the health care information system for State facilities operated by the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services until each of the following conditions has been met:
(1) By no later than March 1, 2014, the Department shall submit a detailed plan of this system to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services, the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, and the Fiscal Research Division. The plan shall include an explanation of at least all of the following:
a. The process the Department used to select the Veterans Health Information Systems and Technology Architecture (VisTA), whether or not the selection process was competitive, and if not, why it was not.
b. Requirements for vendor services to support system implementation and operation and the costs associated with this support.
c. Governance structure for the system.
d. Modules to be implemented in each facility and the reason for each.
e. Assignment of responsibility for system maintenance, codes fixes, application upgrades, and hardware upgrades.
f. Whether the application and database will be implemented at each facility or centrally managed by the Department and the reasons for the decision.
g. Identification of additional hardware that will be required to support a statewide rollout and the location at which the Department plans to host it.
h. Assignment of responsibility for backup and recovery.
i. If there will be redundant failover between facilities.
j. Plans, time lines, and costs for implementing any other modules currently offered by the United State Department of Veterans Affairs.
k. A process for ensuring that the system software is upgraded whenever the United States Department of Veterans Affairs upgrades its system.
l. Technology constraints for VisTA and State‑supported facilities and how they will be addressed, by facility.
m. Facility on‑boarding plan for the State psychiatric hospitals and other State facilities operated by the Division.
n. Costs and sources of funding for planning, development, and implementation at each facility and five years of costs and sources of funding for operations and maintenance at each facility.
o. Any other costs associated with system planning, development, implementation, operation, and maintenance.
p. Any issues associated with the planning, development, and implementation, identified by the Department, the Office of the State Chief Information Officer, the Office of Information Technology Services, or the Office of State Budget and Management, with a solution for each identified issue.
(2) Upon submission of the plan required by subdivision (1) of this section, the Department shall obtain prior approval from the State Chief Information Officer in order to take any further action or expend any funds appropriated or available to the Department to develop and implement the health care information system for State facilities operated by the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services.
LME/MCO FUNDS FOR SUBSTANCE ABUSE SERVICES
SECTION 12F.6.(a) LME/MCOs shall use a portion of their allocated funds for substance abuse treatment services to support prevention and education activities at a level at least equivalent to the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.
SECTION 12F.6.(b) In providing treatment and services for adult offenders and increasing the number of Treatment Accountability for Safer Communities (TASC) case managers, local management entities shall consult with TASC to improve offender access to substance abuse treatment and match evidence‑based interventions to individual needs at each stage of substance abuse treatment. Special emphasis should be placed on intermediate punishment offenders, community punishment offenders at risk for revocation, and Department of Correction releases who have completed substance abuse treatment while in custody.
The Department shall allocate up to three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000) of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, to provide substance abuse services for adult offenders and to increase the number of TASC case managers. These funds shall be allocated to TASC before funds are allocated to LMEs for mental health services, substance abuse services, and crisis services.
STUDY WAYS TO IMPROVE OUTCOMES AND EFFICIENCIES IN ALCOHOL & DRUG ABUSE TREATMENT PROGRAMS
SECTION 12F.7.(a) By no later than April 1, 2014, the Department of Health and Human Services shall study and report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division on ways to improve outcomes and reduce operating costs associated with inpatient treatment at the alcohol and drug abuse treatment centers operated by the Division of State‑Operated Healthcare Facilities.
SECTION 12F.7.(b) The Joint Legislative Program Evaluation Oversight Committee shall consider including in the 2014 Work Plan for the Program Evaluation Division of the General Assembly a study of the most effective and efficient ways to operate inpatient alcohol and drug abuse treatment programs, including, but not limited to, (i) an examination and comparison of the practices, costs, and outcomes of private and State‑operated programs in North Carolina, (ii) an examination of the practices, costs, and outcomes of private and state‑operated programs in other states, and (iii) recommendations for best practices to achieve greater program efficiencies and outcomes in North Carolina.
SUBPART XII‑G. DIVISION OF HEALTH SERVICE REGULATION
THREE‑YEAR MORATORIUM ON SPECIAL CARE UNIT LICENSES AND REVIEW OF CURRENT SPECIAL CARE UNIT STAFFING REQUIREMENTS
SECTION 12G.1.(a) For the period beginning July 31, 2013, and ending July 1, 2016, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Health Service Regulation (Department), shall not issue any licenses for special care units as defined in G.S. 131D‑4.6 and G.S. 131E‑114. This prohibition shall not restrict the Department from doing any of the following:
(1) Issuing a license to a facility that is acquiring an existing special care unit.
(2) Issuing a license for a special care unit in any area of the State upon a determination by the Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services that increased access to this type of care is necessary in that area during the three‑year moratorium imposed by this section.
(3) Processing all completed applications for special care unit licenses received by the Division of Health Service Regulation along with the applicable license fee prior to June 1, 2013.
SECTION 12G.1.(b) By no later than April 1, 2014, the Department shall review the laws pertaining to staff ratios and other staffing requirements of special care units and report the results of its review to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall compare special care unit staff ratios and staffing requirements in North Carolina to those of other states, including those states that border North Carolina. The report shall contain all of the following specific information:
(1) The rationale and justification for establishing the existing special care unit staff ratios and staffing requirements.
(2) Recommendations for changes to existing staff ratios and staffing requirements based on findings of the Department's review.
ELIMINATE COMPREHENSIVE REPORT ON MEDICATION‑RELATED ERRORS IN NURSING HOMES
SECTION 12G.2.(a) G.S. 131E‑128.1(e) reads as rewritten:
"(e) Confidentiality. –
The meetings or proceedings of the advisory committee, the records and
materials it produces, and the materials it considers, including analyses and
reports pertaining to medication‑related error reporting under
G.S. 131E‑128.2 and G.S. 131E‑128.5 and pharmacy
reports on drug defects and adverse reactions under G.S. 131E‑128.4,
shall be confidential and not be considered public records within the meaning
of G.S. 132‑1. The meetings or proceedings and records and materials
also shall not be subject to discovery or introduction into evidence in any
civil action against a nursing home or a provider of professional health
services resulting from matters that are the subject of evaluation and review
by the committee. No person who was in attendance at a meeting of the committee
shall testify in any civil action as to any evidence or other matters produced
or presented during the meetings or proceedings of the committee or as to any
findings, recommendations, evaluations, opinions, or other actions of the
committee or its members. Notwithstanding the foregoing:
(1) Information, documents, or records otherwise available, including any deficiencies found in the course of an inspection conducted under G.S. 131E‑105, shall not be immune from discovery or use in a civil action merely because they were presented during meetings or proceedings of the advisory committee. A member of the advisory committee or a person who testifies before the committee may testify in a civil action but cannot be asked about that person's testimony before the committee or any opinion formed as a result of the committee meetings or proceedings.
(2) Information that is confidential and not subject to discovery or use in civil actions under this subsection may be released to a professional standards review organization that performs any accreditation or certification function. Information released to the professional standards review organization shall be limited to information reasonably necessary and relevant to the standards review organization's determination to grant or continue accreditation or certification. Information released to the standards review organization retains its confidentiality and is not subject to discovery or use in any civil action as provided under this subsection. The standards review organization shall keep the information confidential subject to this subsection.
(3) Information that is confidential and not subject to discovery or use in civil actions under this subsection may be released to the Department of Health and Human Services pursuant to its investigative authority under G.S. 131E‑105. Information released to the Department shall be limited to information reasonably necessary and relevant to the Department's investigation of compliance with Part 1 of Article 6 of this Chapter. Information released to the Department retains its confidentiality and is not subject to discovery or use in any civil action as provided in this subsection. The Department shall keep the information confidential subject to this subsection.
(4) Information that is confidential and is not subject to discovery or use in civil actions under this subsection may be released to an occupational licensing board having jurisdiction over the license of an individual involved in an incident that is under review or investigation by the advisory committee. Information released to the occupational licensing board shall be limited to information reasonably necessary and relevant to an investigation being conducted by the licensing board pertaining to the individual's involvement in the incident under review by the advisory committee. Information released to an occupational licensing board retains its confidentiality and is not subject to discovery or use in any civil action as provided in this subsection. The occupational licensing board shall keep the information confidential subject to this subsection."
SECTION 12G.2.(b) G.S. 131E‑128.1(g) reads as rewritten:
"(g) Penalty. – The
Department may take adverse action against the license of a nursing home upon a
finding that the nursing home has failed to comply with this section,
G.S. 131E‑128.2, 131E‑128.3, 131E‑128.4, or 131E‑128.5.or
131E‑128.4."
SECTION 12G.2.(c) G.S. 131E‑128.5 is repealed.
CERTIFICATE OF NEED EXEMPTION FOR REPLACEMENT OF PREVIOUSLY APPROVED EQUIPMENT & FACILITIES LOCATED ON THE MAIN CAMPUS OF A LICENSED HEALTH SERVICE FACILITY
SECTION 12G.3.(a) G.S. 131E‑176 is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:
"(14n) "Main campus" means all of the following for the purposes of G.S. 131E‑184(f) and (g) only:
a. The site of the main building from which a licensed health service facility provides clinical patient services and exercises financial and administrative control over the entire facility, including the buildings and grounds adjacent to that main building.
b. Other areas and structures that are not strictly contiguous to the main building but are located within 250 yards of the main building."
SECTION 12G.3.(b) G.S. 131E‑184 is amended by adding new subsections to read:
"(f) The Department shall exempt from certificate of need review the purchase of any replacement equipment that exceeds the two million dollar ($2,000,000) threshold set forth in G.S. 131E‑176(22) if all of the following conditions are met:
(1) The equipment being replaced is located on the main campus.
(2) The Department has previously issued a certificate of need for the equipment being replaced.
(3) The licensed health service facility proposing to purchase the replacement equipment shall provide prior written notice to the Department, along with supporting documentation to demonstrate that it meets the exemption criteria of this subsection.
(g) The Department shall exempt from certificate of need review any capital expenditure that exceeds the two million dollar ($2,000,000) threshold set forth in G.S. 131E‑176(16)b. if all of the following conditions are met:
(1) The sole purpose of the capital expenditure is to renovate, replace on the same site, or expand the entirety or a portion of an existing health service facility that is located on the main campus.
(2) The capital expenditure does not result in (i) a change in bed capacity as defined in G.S. 131E‑176(5) or (ii) the addition of a health service facility or any other new institutional health service other than that allowed in G.S. 131E‑176(16)b.
(3) The licensed health service facility proposing to incur the capital expenditure shall provide prior written notice to the Department, along with supporting documentation to demonstrate that it meets the exemption criteria of this subsection."
SECTION 12G.3.(b) This section applies to replacement equipment purchased, and capital expenditures for replacement facilities incurred, on or after the date this act becomes law.
SUBPART XII‑H. DIVISION OF MEDICAL ASSISTANCE (MEDICAID)
DETAILED MEDICAID REFORM PROPOSAL TO BE PREPARED BY DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES; MEDICAID REFORM ADVISORY GROUP ESTABLISHED
SECTION 12H.1.(a) The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, (Department), in consultation with the Medicaid Reform Advisory Group created by subsection (e) of this section, shall create a detailed plan for, but not implement, significant reforms to the State's Medicaid Program that shall accomplish the following:
(1) Create a predictable and sustainable Medicaid program for North Carolina taxpayers.
(2) Increase administrative ease and efficiency for North Carolina Medicaid providers.
(3) Provide care for the whole person by uniting physical and behavioral health care.
SECTION 12H.1.(b) The Department shall submit its detailed proposal of how to reform the State's Medicaid Program to the General Assembly. The report shall contain the following:
(1) The details of the reform plan, including how the plan would accomplish the goals set out in subsection (a) of this section.
(2) The Department's methodology for selecting the reform plan over alternatives.
(3) Forecasts of the reform plan's potential to slow the growth of the costs of the Medicaid Program, including the assumptions and methodology used for the forecast, as well as an explanation of how the Department's forecast methodology has been improved to produce more accurate forecasting than in prior years.
(4) The reform plan's impact, as compared to the existing Medicaid Program, on both providers and recipients in areas such as enrollment within the Medicaid system, access to services, quality of care, and payment methodologies, and any other areas of comparison to help the General Assembly evaluate the reform plan.
(5) If regional demonstration projects, pilot projects, or similar projects will be used to test a proposal, how the Department will ensure that the test methodology is scientifically valid and consistent with social science research methods.
(6) How financial risks will be allocated under the reform plan.
(7) The mechanisms through which the Department and any contractors under the reform plan would be held accountable for the implementation and performance of the plan.
(8) Short‑term costs to implement the plan and expected long‑term savings in future years from slowing the growth of costs.
(9) A realistic time line for implementation.
(10) Draft Medicaid State Plan Amendments, Medicaid waivers, amendments to State law, or other changes necessary to legally allow the Department to implement its reform plan.
(11) Any other detailed information that would assist the General Assembly in evaluating the strength of the reform plan and the plan's ability to accomplish the goals set out in subsection (a) of this section.
SECTION 12H.1.(c) The Department is encouraged to and may submit draft Medicaid State Plan amendments, draft waiver applications, or other documents to the federal government to solicit feedback on the Department's proposal prior to reporting to the General Assembly. The Department shall not, however, submit any documents to the federal government to implement the reform plan without legislation authorizing the Department to implement the Department's reform plan.
SECTION 12H.1.(d) The Department shall submit its reform plan to the General Assembly no later than March 17, 2014, but is encouraged to submit its plan as early as it responsibly can.
SECTION 12H.1.(e) Advisory Group. – There is established the North Carolina Medicaid Reform Advisory Group (Advisory Group) in order to advise the Department of Health and Human Services in its development of its detailed plan to reform Medicaid. The Advisory Group shall meet in order to (i) provide stakeholder input in a public forum and (ii) ensure the transparency of the process of developing the reform proposal. The Advisory Group shall meet at the call of the chair.
The Advisory Group shall consist of the following five members, and the appointing officer shall fill vacancies:
(1) A Representative appointed by the Speaker of the House of Representatives.
(2) A Senator appointed by the President Pro Tempore of the Senate.
(3) Three persons appointed by the Governor, one of whom shall be designated as the chair.
Legislative members of the Advisory Group shall receive per diem, subsistence, and travel expenses as provided in G.S. 120‑3.1. Non‑legislative members of the Advisory Group shall receive per diem, subsistence, and travel expenses as allowed under G.S. 138‑5 or, if the member is a State employee, lodging and travel expenses as allowed under G.S. 138‑6.
The Secretary of Health and Human Services shall ensure adequate staff representation and support from the Department of Health and Human Services.
The Advisory Group shall terminate on July 1, 2014.
SECTION 12H.1.(f) Eligibility of Legislation. – Legislation based on the Department's reform proposal and recommended by the Advisory Group shall be eligible for consideration when the 2013 General Assembly reconvenes in 2014, and G.S. 143C‑5‑2 does not apply to such legislation.
CLARIFY STATE PLAN AMENDMENT PROCEDURES
SECTION 12H.2.(a) Part 6 of Article 2 of Chapter 108A of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read as follows:
"§ 108A‑54.1A. Amendments to Medicaid State Plan and Medicaid Waivers.
(a) No provision in the Medicaid State Plan or in a Medicaid Waiver may expand or otherwise alter the scope or purpose of the Medicaid program from that authorized by law enacted by the General Assembly. For purposes of this section, the term "amendments to the State Plan" includes State Plan amendments, Waivers, and Waiver amendments.
(b) The Department may submit amendments to the State Plan only as required under any of the following circumstances:
(1) A law enacted by the General Assembly directs the Department to submit an amendment to the State Plan.
(2) A law enacted by the General Assembly makes a change to the Medicaid Program that requires approval by the federal government.
(3) A change in federal law, including regulatory law, or a change in the interpretation of federal law by the federal government requires an amendment to the State Plan.
(4) A change made by the Department to the Medicaid Program requires an amendment to the State Plan, if the change was within the authority granted to the Department by State law.
(5) An amendment to the State Plan is required in response to an order of a court of competent jurisdiction.
(6) An amendment to the State Plan is required to ensure continued federal financial participation.
(c) Amendments to the State Plan submitted to the federal government for approval shall contain only those changes that are allowed by the authority for submitting an amendment to the State Plan in subsection (b) of this section.
(d) No fewer than 10 days prior to submitting an amendment to the State Plan to the federal government, the Department shall post the amendment on its Web site and notify the members of the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division that the amendment has been posted. This requirement shall not apply to draft or proposed amendments submitted to the federal government for comments but not submitted for approval. If the authority for submitting the amendment to the State Plan is pursuant to subdivision (3), (4), (5), or (6) of subsection (b) of this section, then, prior to submitting an amendment to the federal government, the Department shall submit to the General Assembly members receiving notice under this subsection and to the Fiscal Research Division an explanation of the amendment, the need for the amendment, and the federal time limits required for implementation of the amendment.
(e) The Department shall submit an amendment to the State Plan to the federal government by a date sufficient to provide the federal government adequate time to review and approve the amendment so the amendment may be effective by the date required by the directing authority in subsection (b) of this section."
SECTION 12H.2.(b) G.S. 108A‑70.25 reads as rewritten:
"§ 108A‑70.25. State Plan for Health Insurance Program for Children.
The Department shall develop
and submit a State Plan to implement "The Health Insurance Program for
Children" authorized under this Part to the federal government as
application for federal funds under Title XXI. The State Plan submitted under
this Part shall be developed by the Department only as authorized by and in
accordance with this Part. No provision in the State Plan submitted under this
Part may expand or otherwise alter the scope or purpose of the Program from
that authorized under this Part. The Department shall include in the State Plan
submitted only those items required by this Part and required by the federal
government to qualify for federal funds under Title XXI and necessary to secure
the State's federal fund allotment for the applicable fiscal period. Except as
otherwise provided in this section, the Department shall not amend the State
Plan nor submit any amendments thereto to the federal government for review or
approval without the specific approval of the General Assembly. In the event
federal law requires that an amendment be made to the State Plan and further
requires that the amendment be submitted or implemented within a time period
when the General Assembly is not and will not be in session to approve the
amendment, then the Department may submit the amendment to the federal
government for review and approval without the approval of the General
Assembly. Prior to submitting an amendment to the federal government without
General Assembly approval as authorized in this section, the Department shall
report the proposed amendment to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on
Health and Human Services and to members of the Joint Appropriations
Subcommittee on Health and Human Services. The report shall include an
explanation of the amendment, the necessity therefor, and the federal time
limits required for implementation of the amendment.
(a) The NC Health Choice program shall be administered and operated in accordance with this Part and the NC Health Choice State Plan, as periodically amended by the Department of Health and Human Services and approved by the federal government.
(b) The requirements in G.S. 108A‑54.1A shall apply to NC Health Choice State Plan amendments in the same manner in which they apply to Medicaid State Plan amendments."
SECTION 12H.2.(c) The Department of Health and Human Services shall take any and all action necessary to amend the Medicaid State Plan, Attachment 4.19‑B, Section 5, Page 2, which pertains to supplemental payments that increase reimbursement to the average commercial rate for certain eligible medical professional providers, in order to limit the definition of eligible medical professional providers to only physicians employed by the East Carolina University School of Medicine or the University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill School of Medicine as academic faculty. The supplemental payments shall be made only for services provided at these schools of medicine.
SECTION 12H.2.(d) This section is effective when it becomes law.
SECTION 12H.3. G.S. 108A‑54 reads as rewritten:
"§ 108A‑54. Authorization of Medical Assistance Program.
(a) The Department is authorized to establish a Medicaid Program in accordance with Title XIX of the federal Social Security Act. The Department may adopt rules to implement the Program. The State is responsible for the nonfederal share of the costs of medical services provided under the Program. In addition, the State shall pay one hundred percent (100%) of the federal Medicare Part D clawback payments under the Medicare Modernization Act of 2004, P.L. 108‑173, as amended. A county is responsible for the county's cost of administering the Program in that county.
…
(c) The Medicaid Program shall be administered and operated in accordance with this Part and the North Carolina Medicaid State Plan and Waivers, as periodically amended by the Department of Health and Human Services in accordance with G.S. 108A‑54.1A and approved by the federal government.
(d) The Department shall not take any actions that the Department determines would jeopardize the State's qualification to receive federal funds through the Medicaid Program."
CODIFY MEDICAID AS SECONDARY PAYOR
SECTION 12H.4. G.S. 108A‑55 is amended by adding a new subsection to read as follows:
"§ 108A‑55. Payments.
…
(e) Medicaid is a secondary payor of claims. The Department shall apply Medicaid medical policy to recipients who have primary insurance other than Medicare, Medicare Advantage, and Medicaid. For recipients who have primary insurance other than Medicare, Medicare Advantage, or Medicaid, the Department shall pay the lesser of the Medicaid Allowable Amount or an amount up to the actual coinsurance or deductible or both of the primary payor, in accordance with the State Plan, as approved by the Department of Health and Human Services. The Department may disregard application of this policy in cases where application of the policy would adversely affect patient care."
CODIFY COUNTIES SHARING IN FRAUD RECOVERY
SECTION 12H.5. Part 6 of Article 2 of Chapter 108A of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read as follows:
"§ 108A‑64.1. Incentives to counties to recover fraudulent Medicaid expenditures.
The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall provide incentives to counties that successfully recover fraudulently spent Medicaid funds by sharing State savings with counties responsible for the recovery of the fraudulently spent funds."
CODIFY CHANGES TO MEDICAL POLICY
SECTION 12H.6.(a) G.S. 108A‑54.2 reads as rewritten:
"§ 108A‑54.2. Procedures for changing medical policy.
(a) The Department shall adopt rules to develop, amend, and adopt medical coverage policy for Medicaid and NC Health Choice in accordance with this section.
(b) Medical coverage policy is defined as those policies, definitions, or guidelines utilized to evaluate, treat, or support the health or developmental conditions of a recipient so as to determine eligibility, authorization or continued authorization, medical necessity, course of treatment and supports, clinical outcomes, and clinical supports treatment practices for a covered procedure, product, or service. Medical coverage policy is subject to the following:
(1) During the development of new medical coverage policy or amendment to existing medical coverage policy, the Department shall consult with and seek the advice of the Physician Advisory Group and other organizations the Secretary deems appropriate. The Secretary shall also consult with and seek the advice of officials of the professional societies or associations representing providers who are affected by the new medical coverage policy or amendments to existing medical coverage policy.
(2) At least 45 days prior to the adoption of new or amended medical coverage policy, the Department shall:
a. Publish the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy on the Department's Web site;
b. Notify all Medicaid and NC Health Choice providers of the proposed, new, or amended policy; and
c. Upon request, provide persons copies of the proposed medical coverage policy.
(3) During the 45‑day period immediately following publication of the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy, the Department shall accept oral and written comments on the proposed new or amended policy.
(4) If, following the comment period, the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy is modified, then the Department shall, at least 15 days prior to its adoption:
a. Notify all Medicaid and NC Health Choice providers of the proposed policy;
b. Upon request, provide persons notice of amendments to the proposed policy; and
c. Accept additional oral or written comments during this 15‑day period.
(c) If the adoption of new or amended medical coverage policies is necessitated by an act of the General Assembly or a change in federal law, then the 45‑ and 15‑day time periods specified in subsection (b) of this section shall instead be 30‑ and 10‑day time periods.
(d) Unless directed to do so by the General Assembly, the Department shall not change medical policy affecting the amount, sufficiency, duration, and scope of health care services and who may provide services until the Division of Medical Assistance has prepared a five‑year fiscal analysis documenting the increased cost of the proposed change in medical policy and submitted it for departmental review. Changes to medical policy affecting the amount, sufficiency, duration, and scope of health care services and who may provide services are subject to the following:
(1) If the fiscal impact indicated by the fiscal analysis for any proposed medical policy change exceeds five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000) in total requirements for Medicaid or fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) in total requirements for NC Health Choice for a given fiscal year, then the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy change to the fiscal analysis to the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division. The Department shall not implement the proposed medical policy change unless the source of State funding is identified and approved by the Office of State Budget and Management.
(2) If the medical policy change meets the requirement thresholds specified in subdivision (1) of this subsection but is required for compliance with federal law, then the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy or policy interpretation change